You are on page 1of 340

SIMOCODE pro

System Manual Version 10/2004


sirius
Totally
I ntegrated
Automation

Important Notes,
Table of Contents
System Description
1
Short Instructions for Con-
figuring a Reversing Starter
2
Motor Protection
3
Motor Control
4
Monitoring Functions
5
Outputs
6
Inputs
7
Standard Function Blocks
8
Logic Modules
9
Communication
10
Mounting, Wiring and Inter-
faces
11
Commissioning and Servicing
12
Tables
A
Data Formats and Data
Records
B
Dimension Drawings
C
Technical Data
D
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual
Edition 10/2004
Order Number: 3UF7970-0AA00-0
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02



Safety Guidelines
This manual contains notices which you should observe to ensure your own personal safety as well as to avoid
property damage. The notices referring to your personal safety are highlighted in the manual by a safety alert
symbol, notices referring to property damage only have no safety alert symbol.

Danger
indicates an imminently hazardous situation which, if not avoided, will result in death or serious injury.

Warning
indicates a potentially hazardous situation which, if not avoided, could result in death or serious injury.

Caution
used with the safety alert symbol indicates a potentially hazardous situation which, if not avoided, may
result in minor or moderate injury.
Caution
used without safety alert symbol indicates a potentially hazardous situation which, if not avoided, may
result in property damage.
Notice
used without the safety alert symbol indicates a potential situation which, if not avoided, may result in
an undesirable result or state.
When several danger levels apply, the notices of the highest level (lower number) are always displayed. If a
notice refers to personal damages with the safety alert symbol, then another notice may be added warning of
property damage.
Qualified Personnel
The device/system may only be set up and operated in conjunction with this documentation. Only qualified
personnel should be allowed to install and work on the equipment. Qualified persons are defined as persons who
are authorized to commission, to earth, and to tag circuits, equipment and systems in accordance with
established safety practices and standards.
Intended Use
Please note the following:

Warning
This device and its components may only be used for the applications described in the catalog or
technical description, and only in connection with devices or components from other manufacturers
approved or recommended by Siemens.
This product can only function correctly and safely if it is transported, stored, set up and installed
correctly, and operated and maintained as recommended.
Trademarks
All designations marked with ! are registered trademarks of Siemens AG. Other designations in this
documentation might be trademarks which, if used by third parties for their purposes, might infringe upon the
rights of the proprietors.
Copyright Siemens AG, 2004. All rights reserved
Reproduction, transmission or use of this document or its contents is not permitted without
express written authority. Offenders will be liable for damages. All rights, including rights
created by patent grant or registration of a utility model or design, are reserved.

Disclaimer of Liability
We have checked the contents of this manual for agreement with the hardware and
software described. Since deviations cannot be precluded entirely, we cannot guarantee
full agreement. However, the data in the manual are reviewed regularly, and any
necessary corrections will be included in subsequent editions. Suggestions for
improvement are welcomed.
Siemens AG
Automation and Drives Group
P.O. Box 4848, D-90327 Nuremberg (Germany)
Siemens AG 2004
Technical data subject to change


Siemens Aktiengesellschaft A5E00248055-02
SIMOCODE pro
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 i
Table of Contents
Important Notes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . vii
System Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-1
1.1 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-2
1.2 Simplify configuration with SIMOCODE pro . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-4
1.3 Application example. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-6
1.4 Checklist for selecting the device series . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-8
1.5 Function overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-10
1.5.1 Protecting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-10
1.5.2 Monitoring . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-10
1.5.3 Communication. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-13
1.5.4 Standard function modules . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-13
1.5.5 Operating, service and diagnostic data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-14
1.5.6 Additional signal processing with freely programmable logic modules . . . 1-15
1.6 Overview of system components . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-16
1.7 Description of the system components . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-19
1.7.1 Basic units . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-19
1.7.2 Operator panel (OP) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-20
1.7.3 Current measurement modules (IM) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-21
1.7.4 Current/voltage measurement modules (UM)
for the SIMOCODE pro V device series . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-22
1.7.5 Expansion modules for the SIMOCODE pro V device series . . . . . . . . . 1-23
1.7.6 Accessories . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-25
1.7.7 Software . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-26
1.8 Structural configuration of SIMOCODE pro . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-27
1.8.1 Function blocks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-27
2 Short Instructions for Configuring a Reversing Starter . . . . . . . . . . . 2-1
2.1 Introduction and target of the example . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-2
2.2 Reversing starter with motor feeder and local control station . . . . . . . . . 2-3
2.3 Parameterization . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-6
2.4 Extending the reversing starter with a control station via PROFIBUS DP . . 2-10
3 Motor Protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-1
3.1 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-2
3.2 Overload protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-4
3.3 Asymmetry monitoring . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-9
3.4 Blocking protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-10
3.5 Temperature monitoring . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-11
4 Motor Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-1
4.1 Control stations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-2
4.1.1 Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-2
4.1.2 Modes of operation and mode selectors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-5
Table of Contents
SIMOCODE pro
ii GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
4.1.3 Enables and enabled control command . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-8
4.1.4 Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-9
4.2 Control functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-10
4.2.1 Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-10
4.2.2 General settings and definitions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-13
4.2.3 Overload relay . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-16
4.2.4 Direct starters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-17
4.2.5 Reversing starters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-19
4.2.6 Circuit breaker . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-22
4.2.7 Star-delta starters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-25
4.2.8 Star-delta starters with reversal of the direction of rotation . . . . . . . . . . 4-28
4.2.9 Dahlander . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-32
4.2.10 Dahlander with reversal of the direction of rotation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-35
4.2.11 Pole-changing switches. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-38
4.2.12 Pole-changing switch with reversal of the direction of rotation . . . . . . . . 4-41
4.2.13 Valve . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-44
4.2.14 Slider . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-46
4.2.15 Soft starters. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-51
4.2.16 Soft reversing starter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-53
4.3 Active control stations, contactor & lamp controls and status signal
of the control functions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-56
5 Monitoring Functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-1
5.1 Earth-fault monitoring via current/voltage measurement module . . . . . . . 5-2
5.1.1 Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-2
5.1.2 Internal earth fault . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-2
5.2 Current limit monitoring . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-3
5.2.1 Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-3
5.2.2 I> (upper limit) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-5
5.2.3 I< (lower limit) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-6
5.3 Operation monitoring . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-7
5.3.1 Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-7
5.3.2 Operating hours monitoring . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-8
5.3.3 Stop time monitoring . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-8
5.3.4 Monitoring the number of starts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-9
6 Outputs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-1
6.1 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-2
6.2 Basic unit (BU) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-4
6.3 Operator panel (OP) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-6
6.4 Digital modules (DM) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-8
6.5 Cyclic signaling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-10
6.6 Acyclic signaling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-12
7 Inputs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-1
7.1 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-2
7.2 Basic unit (BU) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-4
7.3 Digital modules (DM) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-6
7.4 Cyclic controlling. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-8
Table of Contents
SIMOCODE pro
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 iii
7.5 Acyclic controlling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-9
8 Standard Function Blocks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-1
8.1 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-2
8.2 Test/reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-3
8.3 Test position feedback (TPF) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-7
8.4 External fault . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-9
8.5 Operational protection OFF (OPO) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-11
8.5.1 Response for slider control function . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-11
8.5.2 Response to other control functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-12
8.6 Power failure monitoring (UVO . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-13
8.7 Emergency start . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-15
8.8 Watchdog (bus monitoring, PLC/DCS monitoring) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-16
8.9 Timestamping . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-18
8.9.1 Time stamping in the fault memory . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-18
9 Logic Modules. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-1
9.1 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-2
9.2 Truth table for 3I/1O. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-3
9.3 Truth table for 2I/1O. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-6
9.4 Truth table for 5I/2O. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-7
9.5 Counters. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-8
9.6 Timer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-10
9.7 Signal conditioner . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-13
9.8 Non-volatile elements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-16
9.9 Flashing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-19
9.10 Flickering . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-20
9.11 Limit monitor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-21
10 Communication. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-1
10.1 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-2
10.1.1 Definitions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-2
10.2 Transmitting data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-4
10.3 Configuring SIMOCODE pro . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-6
10.3.1 Configuring with a GSD file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-6
10.3.2 Configuring with the SIMOCODE ES software. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-8
10.3.3 Configuring with SIMATIC PDM. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-8
10.4 Telegram description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-9
10.5 Process image (cyclic data) and data records (acyclic data) . . . . . . . . . . 10-10
10.6 Diagnostics with STEP 7 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-11
10.6.1 Reading out the diagnostics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-11
10.6.2 Configuring the slave diagnostics. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-12
10.6.3 Station status 1 to 3 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-13
10.6.4 Master PROFIBUS address . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-15
10.6.5 Manufacturer's identification . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-15
10.6.6 Identification-related diagnostics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-16
10.6.7 Status messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-17
10.6.8 Channel-related diagnostics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-18
10.6.9 Alarms . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-19
10.6.10Data records - overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-20
Table of Contents
SIMOCODE pro
iv GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
11 Mounting, Wiring and Interfaces . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-1
11.1 General information about mounting and wiring . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-2
11.2 Mounting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-3
11.2.1 Mounting the basic units and expansion modules. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-3
11.2.2 Mounting the current measurement modules . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-4
11.2.3 Mounting the operator panel. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-5
11.3 Wiring . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-6
11.3.1 Detachable terminals for basic units and expansion modules . . . . . . . . . 11-6
11.3.2 Current measurement with current measurement modules . . . . . . . . . . 11-9
11.4 System interfaces . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-10
11.4.1 General . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-10
11.4.2 Basic units, expansion modules and current measurement modules . . . . 11-12
11.4.3 Operator panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-14
11.4.4 PROFIBUS DP on a 9-pole SUB-D socket . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-16
11.5 Installation guidelines for the PROFIBUS DP . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-17
12 Commissioning and Servicing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-1
12.1 General information about commissioning and servicing. . . . . . . . . . . . 12-2
12.2 Commissioning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-3
12.2.1 Sequence of steps. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-3
12.2.2 Setting the PROFIBUS DP address . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-4
12.2.3 Diagnostics via LED display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-5
12.3 Servicing. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-6
12.3.1 Preventive maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-6
12.3.2 Saving the parameters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-7
12.3.3 Replace SIMOCODE pro components . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-9
12.3.4 Configuring the basic factory default setting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-10
A Tables . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . A-1
A.1 Active control stations, contactor/lamp controls and
status signals/messages for the control functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . A-2
A.2 Abbreviations and Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . A-3
A.3 Socket assignment table - digital . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . A-4
A.4 Socket assignment table - analog. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . A-11
A.5 Detailled signals of the slave diagnosis . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . A-13
B Data Formats and Data Records . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B-1
B.1 Handling data records . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B-2
B.1.1 Writing/reading data records . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B-2
B.1.2 Abbreviations. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B-3
B.1.3 Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B-3
B.2 Data record 67 - process image of the outputs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B-4
B.3 Data record 69 - process image of the inputs. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B-5
B.4 Data record 92 - device diagnostics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B-6
B.5 Data record 94 - measured values . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B-14
B.6 Data record 95 - Service/statistics data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B-15
B.7 Data record 130 - base device parameter 1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B-16
B.8 Data record 131 - base device parameter 2 (plug) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B-22
Table of Contents
SIMOCODE pro
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 v
B.9 Data record DS132 - extended device parameter 1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B-26
B.10 Data record 133 - extended device parameter 2 (plug) . . . . . . . . . . . . . B-34
B.11 Data record 139 - labeling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B-37
B.12 Data record 160 - communication parameters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B-38
B.13 Data record 165 - comment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B-38
B.14 Data record 202 - Acyclic controlling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B-39
B.15 Data record 203 - Acyclic signaling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B-40
B.16 Data record 224 - password protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B-41
C Dimension Drawings. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . C-1
C.1 3UF70 basic unit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . C-2
C.1.1 SIMOCODE pro C 3UF7 000 basic unit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . C-2
C.1.2 SIMOCODE pro V 3UF7 010 basic unit. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . C-2
C.2 3UF710 current measurement module. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . C-3
C.2.1 Current measurement module (push-through converter)
3UF7 100, 0.3 A to 3 A, 3UF7 101, 2.4 A up to 25 A. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . C-3
C.2.2 Current measurement module (push-through converter)
3UF7 102, 10 A to 100 A . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . C-4
C.2.3 Current measurement module (push-through converter)
3UF7 103, 20 A to 200 A . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . C-5
C.2.4 Current measurement module (rail connection)
3UF7 103, 20 A to 200 A . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . C-6
C.2.5 Current measurement module (rail connection)
3UF7 104, 63 A to 630 A . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . C-7
C.3 3UF7 200 operator panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . C-8
C.4 3UF7 3 digital module. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . C-9
C.5 Accessories . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . C-10
C.5.1 Door adapter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . C-10
D Technical Data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . D-1
D.1 Common technical data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . D-2
D.2 Basic units . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . D-3
D.3 Current measurement modules . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . D-5
D.4 Expansion modules (digital modules) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . D-6
D.5 Operator panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . D-7
D.6 Short-circuit protection with fuses for motor feeders
for short-circuit currents up to 50 kA and 690 V . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . D-8
Index
Table of Contents
SIMOCODE pro
vi GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
SIMOCODE pro
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 vii
Important Notes
Purpose of the manual
The SIMOCODE pro system manual describes in detail the motor manage-
ment system and its functions. It contains information about configuring,
commissioning, service and maintenance. The user is introduced to the
system quickly and practically using a typical reversing-motor application as
an example.
This manual contains information specific to service and maintenance per-
sonnel in addition to assistance in fault detecting and elimination when a
fault occurs.
The manual contains circuit diagrams, dimension drawings, and technical
data about the system components to help with the configuration.
Required basic knowledge
A basic knowledge in the areas of low-voltage controls and distribution, digi-
tal circuit engineering and automisation technology is required in order to be
able to understand this manual.
Topics
The manual consists of chapters that can be consulted and the following
table contains a list of the relevant topics. The topics with a gray background
represent the contents of the SIMOCODE ES parameterization and ser-
vice software.
Topic Target group
System Description Configurators, planers
Short Instructions for Configuring a Rever-
sing Starter
Configurators, technicians and commissio-
ners
Motor Protection Configurators, commissioners
Motor Control Configurators
Monitoring Functions Configurators, commissioners, service
personnel
Inputs Configurators
Outputs Configurators
Standard Function Blocks Configurators
Logic Modules Configurators
Communication Configurators, PLC programmers
Mounting, Wiring and Interfaces Technicians, electricians, maintenance and
service personnel
Commissioning and Servicing Commissioners, electricians, maintenance
and service personnel
SIMOCODE pro
viii GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
Scope of application
This manual is applicable for the components included in the
SIMOCODE pro system. It contains a description of the components that
are applicable at the time of printing the document. We reserve the right to
include information about new components or new versions of components
in an additional document.
Further documentation
Please read the operating manuals of the corresponding components.
The DP-Master manual is also required in addition to this system manual.
Definitions
If SIMOCODE pro is referred to, then both the SIMOCODE pro C and
the SIMOCODE pro V series are meant.
Tables for the response of SIMOCODE pro
Using SIMOCODE, specific responses (deactivated, signal, warn, switch off)
can be parameterized for various functions (e.g. overload). They are also dis-
played in the following table:
X = applicable
- = not applicable
d = default
Short description of the response
Deactivated: The corresponding function is switched off, no signals are gene-
rated.
Signal: Only a device-internal signal is generated, which can be further pro-
cessed in any way.
Warn: A warning signal, which is available as a diagnostic for PROFIBUS DP, is
generated in addition to the device-internal signal.
Switch off: The contactor controls QE* are switched off. An error message is
generated which is available as a diagnostic for PROFIBUS DP. The error mes-
sage and the device-internal signal remain on until the corresponding time
has elapsed or the cause of the error has been eliminated and acknowledged.
A delay time can also be specified for specific responses.
Response Function 1 Function 2 Function 3
Switch off - X (d) X
Warn X (d) X -
Signal X X -
Not active X X X (d)
Delay 25 s - -
SIMOCODE pro
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 ix
Correction sheet
A correction sheet is included at the end of this manual. Please use it to fill
in suggestions for improvements, additions and corrections and send it back
to us. This helps us to improve the next edition.
Exclusion of liability
The products described here were developed to carry out protection tasks
as part of a complete plant or machine. In general, a complete safety
system consists of sensors, evaluation units, signaling devices and methods
for safe switching off. It is the responsibility of the customer to ensure the
safe functioning of the complete plant or machine.
Siemens AG, its subsiduries and associated companies (hereon referred to
as "Siemens") is not in the position to guarantee every characteristic of a
complete plant or machine that is not designed by Siemens.
Siemens also denies all responsibility for any recommendations that are
given or implied in the following description. No new guarantee, warranty or
liability above those standard to Siemens can be derived from the following
description.
SIMOCODE
x GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
SIMOCODE pro
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 1-1
System Description 1
In this chapter
In this chapter you will find an introduction and general information about
the SIMOCODE pro system including e.g.
characteristics of both the SIMOCODE pro C and the
SIMOCODE pro V device series
simplifications of circuits with SIMOCODE pro
a function overview
an overview of the system components.
Target groups
This chapter is addressed to the following target groups:
planners and configurators
people who are now using SIMOCODE DP and in the future want to use
SIMOCODE pro as a replacement or as an additional system
optional for commissioners, maintenance and service personnel as additional
information about SIMOCODE pro
system integrators/process technology.
Necessary knowledge
You need the following knowledge:
basic knowledge about load feeders
basic knowledge about motor protection
basic knowledge of control engineering
basic knowledge of industrial bus technology.
System Description
SIMOCODE pro
1-2 GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
1.1 Introduction
Description
SIMOCODE pro (SIRIUS Motor Management and Control Devices) is a
system of motor management and control devices with a PROFIBUS DP
interface. SIMOCODE pro is the further development of the SIMOCODE DP
system.
SIMOCODE pro is a flexible, modular motor management system which
combines all functions necessary for a motor feeder. Only the switching and
protection mechanisms of the main circuit (contactors, circuit breakers,
fuses) are additionally needed. The system protects and monitors the motor
feeder independently of the automation system.
SIMOCODE pro makes the motor feeder controllable in an easy way and
also automatically implements all the necessary interlockings. It provides a
lot of operating, service and diagnostic data making the functionality of the
motor feeder more transparent. It integrates the motor feeder completely
into a main automation system via PROFIBUS DP.
Device series
SIMOCODE pro can be subdivided into two device series with different
functions:
SIMOCODE pro C - the compact system for direct and reversing starters
and
SIMOCODE pro V - the variable system which also offers many other additio-
nal functions in addition to the SIMOCODE pro C functions
Additional control programs are integrated in SIMOCODE pro V for star-delta
starters, Dahlanders, pole-changing switches, soft starters - each also in combi-
nation with reversal of the direction of rotation, as well as valves and sliders.
SIMOCODE pro V is also especially versatile. Its functionality can be extended if
required, e.g.
the number of binary inputs and outputs can be increased in stages and are
adjustable, new types can be added
a current/voltage measurement module can be used for additional voltage
measuring and for monitoring power-related measured values (power mana-
gement)
a temperature module enables the evaluation of several analog temperature
sensors
another earth-fault detection system can be integrated together with a sum-
mation current transformer
an analog module extends the system by an additional analog input and out-
put, for example, for fill-level or flow-rate monitoring
SIMOCODE pro C is upwards-compatible to SIMOCODE pro V. This means
that you can use both ranges simultaneously in your plant.
System Description
SIMOCODE pro
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 1-3
Independent operation
SIMOCODE pro C and pro V protect and control the motor feeder indepen-
dently of the automation system. Thus, if the automation system (PLC) fails
or if communication is disrupted, the motor feeder can still be operated.
SIMOCODE pro can be used without being connected to PROFIBUS DP.
This can, for example, be connected later.
Typical configuration
The following schematic shows a typical configuration of SIMOCODE pro C
and SIMOCODE pro V:
Figure 1-1: Typical configurations of SIMOCODE pro
U
F
-
0
1
1
2
9
Current measurement
module (IM)
Basic unit (BU1)
Operator panel (OP)
SIMOCODE pro C
Maximum configuration
U
F
-
0
1
1
3
0
SIMOCODE pro V
Basic unit (BU2)
Current measurement
module (IM)
Operator panel (OP)
Digital module (DM)
Analog module (AM)
Additional optional expansions are possible
System Description
SIMOCODE pro
1-4 GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
1.2 Simplify configuration with SIMOCODE pro
Conventional configuration without SIMOCODE pro
Individual components are used for all the control, monitoring and signal
pre-processing. The following components must be used and the following
wiring must be carried out:
inserting and wiring up the overload relays, thermistor evaluation devices,
current transformers, analog/digital converters
wiring up the control circuit
connecting the control devices for start/stop
bringing the contactor into locking mode via auxiliary switches
wiring up the interlocks
The following figure shows the conventional configuration of a direct starter:
Figure 1-2: Conventional configuration of a motor feeder (direct starter)
PLC
Start/stop
Thermistor
evaluation
Local start
Local stop
Automatic Manual
-K11
1
-X3
-K1
-K1 S2
S1
-X2
-X1
-F3
-F2-
3/N/PE ~ 50/60Hz 400/230V
L1
L2
L3
N
PE
Q1
- K1
1 3 5
2 4 6
1 3 5
2 4 6
- F2
1 3 5
2 4 6
M
3~
1
PE
2
4...20 mA
1N
2
D
A
-K1 -K1 -F2 -F3
Switchgear
O
N
O
F
F
O
v
e
r
l
o
a
d
T
h
e
r
m
i
s
t
o
r
Automation level / I/O module
-F3
W V U
C
u
r
r
e
n
t
-
Q
1

o
p
e
n
-Q1
N
-K11 -K12
Feedback Control commands
M
a
n
.

/

a
u
t
.

O
N

/

O
F
F

-F4
1L1
-Q1
-K12
System Description
SIMOCODE pro
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 1-5
Configuration with SIMOCODE pro
Only SIMOCODE pro is used for complete control, monitoring and signal
pre-processing.
This offers the following advantages:
additional overload relays, thermistor evaluation devices, current transfor-
mers, analog/digital converters are not necessary
wiring up the control circuit (interlocking) is simplified
the start and stop switches are wired directly to the inputs of the basic unit
the contactor coil is activated via the output of the basic unit. The auxiliary
contact for locking is no longer necessary
The following figure shows the configuration with SIMOCODE pro:
Figure 1-3: Configuration of a motor feeder (direct starter) with SIMOCODE pro
3/N/PE ~ 50/60Hz 400/230V
L1
L2
L3
N
PE
Q1
- K1
1 3 5
2 4 6
1 3 5
M
3~

PE
W V U
2 4 6
Current measurment
module (IM)
L1/L+
F11
K1
N/L
S0 S1
A1 A2
T1 T2
T1
T2
L+
PROFIBUS DP
Thermistor
Control station -
local control [LC]
Basic unit (BU)
IN1 IN2 24 V
OUT 1 1
System Description
SIMOCODE pro
1-6 GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
1.3 Application example
Description
The fill level is monitored in a liquid container. A pump keeps the liquid level
(reference value) almost constant by pumping more liquid into the container.
The fill level (actual value) is measured by the fill-level indicator and output-
ted as an analog signal. If the fill level sinks below a certain level, the pump
is switched on by SIMOCODE. Liquid is pumped in until the reference value
is again reached. Then the pump is switched off.
Controlling the pump
The pump can be controlled as follows:
locally: control station - local control [LC] for manual switching on and off (by
visual inspection)
in the switchgear cabinet door: control station operator panel [OP] for swit-
ching on and off manually
in the automation level: control station PLC/DCS [DP] for remote-controlled
switching on and off (automatic operation)
via SIMOCODE, by means of internal logic modules
Schematic
Figure 1-4: Schematic of a typical application example
3/N/PE ~ 50/60Hz 400/230V
L1
L2
L3
N
PE
Q1
- K1
1 3 5
2 4 6
1 3 5
M
3~

PE
W V U
2 4 6
System
interface
Current measurement
module (IM)
Pump
L1/L+
F11
K1
N/L
Connecting cable
S0 S1
A1 A2
T1 T2
Analog module (AM)
In+ In
Out+ Out
Fill-level indicator
T1
T2
L+
PLC/DCS
PROFIBUS DP
Thermistor
Liquid container
Control station -
local control [LC]
Control station
PLC/DCS [DP]
Control station -
Operator panel
Optional:
Laptop with
SIMOCODE ES
Display
Basic unit (BU 2)
Motor current
IN1 IN2 24 V
OUT 1 1

System Description
SIMOCODE pro
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 1-7
Record, display and evaluate the measured values
The following measured values are required for monitoring the process:
pump motor current, which is measured by the current measurement module
analog value of the fill-level indicator, which is measured by the analog
module
The measured values are evaluated directly by SIMOCODE pro or transfer-
red via PROFIBUS DP to the PLC/DCS and are evaluated there.
Optionally, e.g. a laptop can be connected to the operator panel with the
SIMOCODE ES software in order to evaluate further process data locally.
System Description
SIMOCODE pro
1-8 GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
1.4 Checklist for selecting the device series
The following checklist should help you decide on the best device series for
your requirements:

SIMOCODE pro
Requirement pro C
(BU1)
pro V
(BU2)
Standard motor feeders (4 inputs, 3 outputs)
with control functions for direct starters,
reversing starters, intelligent overload relays
1)
Monitoring of blocking, asymmetry, phase
failure 1)
Current measurement, current limit monito-
ring, overload protection 1)
Earth-fault monitoring via current measure-
ment module (internal) 1)
Thermistor motor protection with PTC (binary)

Motor feeder with control function:
star-delta starters, Dahlanders, pole-changing
switches, soft starters each also possible in
combination with reversal of the direction of
rotation , valves, sliders
1)
Measuring, processing and outputting analog
values e.g. flow rate, fill level, etc. 2)
Current measurement and voltage measure-
ment 3)
Voltage monitoring for undervoltage
3)
Power management, implementing power
considerations (power, power factor), power
monitoring
3)
More than 4 digital inputs required
(maximum 12) 2)
Table 1-1: Checklist for selecting the device series
1) via current measurement module
2) with expansion modules
3) via current/voltage measurement modules
System Description
SIMOCODE pro
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 1-9
More than 3 relay outputs required
(maximum 7) 2)
Earth-fault monitoring with a summation cur-
rent transformer 2)
Binary inputs for 110 ... 240 V AC/DC
(max. 8) 2)
Bistable relay outputs (max. 4)
2)
Analog temperature monitoring with PTC,
NTC, PT100, PT1000 and KTY sensor types 2)
SIMOCODE pro
Requirement pro C
(BU1)
pro V
(BU2)
Table 1-1: Checklist for selecting the device series (cont.)
1) via current measurement module
2) with expansion modules
3) via current/voltage measurement modules
System Description
SIMOCODE pro
1-10 GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
1.5 Function overview
1.5.1 Protecting
For a more detailed description, please see chapter 3 Motor Protection
Electronic overload protection
The basic unit has several protection mechanisms for current-dependent
motor protection:
overload protection
phase asymmetry
phase failure
Blocking protection
Please see chapter 3 "Motor Protection"
Thermistor motor protection
The basic units (BU1 and BU2) also make it possible to connect thermistor
sensors (binary PTC) for monitoring the motor temperature.
1.5.2 Monitoring
Earth-fault monitoring
The basic units have
Internal earth-fault monitoring:
For motors with a 3-cable connection, the basic unit evaluates a possible
fault current/earth-fault current from the total current. Internal earth-fault
monitoring is only possible for motors with a 3-phase connection in networks
which are either grounded directly or grounded with a low impedance.
The internal earth-fault monitoring can be activated through parameterization.
It covers 2 operating cases:
normal operating case up to 2 x I
e
. The effective operating current must
be smaller than twice the set current I
e
. Fault currents > 30% of the set
current I
e
will be detected.
start-up or overload operation from 2 x I
e
. The effective operating cur-
rent is larger than twice the set current I
e
. Fault currents > 15% of the
effective motor current will be detected.
Note
If you use the internal earth-fault detection for star-delta circuits, this can
lead to false trippings. For delta operation, the summation current is non-
zero due to harmonics.
System Description
SIMOCODE pro
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 1-11
External earth-fault monitoring with SIMOCODE pro V:
the earth-fault module (EM) is needed to connect an external summation cur-
rent transformer (e.g 3UL22). Rated fault currents of 0.3 A / 0.5 A / 1 A are
evaluated by the 3UL22 summation current transformer.
A warning is triggered if the earth-fault limit is exceeded. You can set additio-
nal trippings through parameterization.
If the rated fault currents are exceeded,
SIMOCODE pro reacts either
by turning off the contactor controls QE* or
with a warning
depending on which configuration you set.
Current limit monitoring
The current limit monitoring function is used for process monitoring. Impen-
ding irregularities in the system can be detected in good time: Exceeding a
current limit which is still below the overload limit can e.g. indicate a dirty fil-
ter on a pump or a motor mounting which is running more and more sluggis-
hly. Falling below a current limit can be the first hint that a drive motor belt is
worn-out.
Voltage monitoring
SIMOCODE pro V offers the option of voltage monitoring. A three-phase
current network or a one-phase network can be monitored for undervoltage,
direction of rotation (for three-phase current) or availability.
Temperature monitoring
The temperature module from SIMOCODE pro V offers the option of imple-
menting an analog temperature monitoring of up to 3 sensor measuring cir-
cuits.
Monitoring active power
SIMOCODE pro V offers the option of monitoring the active power,
where not only the current, but also the power factor (cos phi) is taken into
account.
Monitoring the power factor (cos phi)
For monitoring the operating status of the motor
For detecting no-load operation for motors with low power (load rejection)
Monitoring analog signals
SIMOCODE pro V offers the option of reading, processing and monitoring
analog signals. The analog values can be transmitted to the automation
system or processed/evaluated in SIMOCODE. Any analog signal can be
outputted via the analog output.
System Description
SIMOCODE pro
1-12 GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
Monitoring operating hours, stop time and number of start-ups
SIMOCODE pro can monitor the operating hours and the stop times of a
motor in order to avoid plant down times due to failed motors because they
were either running too long (wear out) or they were stopped too long a
period of time.
For example, if an adjustable limit value is exceeded, a signal can be issued
which can indicate that maintenance on the relevant motor is necessary or
even that the motor should be replaced. After replacing the motor, the ope-
rating hours and stop times can be reset. In order to avoid excessive ther-
mal strain on a motor and its premature aging, the number of motor start-
ups in a selected time frame can be limited. The limited number of possible
starts can be indicated by pre-warnings.
All signals can be processed internally (limits) and/or registered by the
bus.
Control functions
Depending on the device series, the following parameterizable control
functions are available:
All the necessary protection functions and interlocks are already available
and can be flexibly adapted and extended.
SIMOCODE
Control function pro C
(BU1)
pro V
(BU2)
Overload relays 1)
Direct starters 1)
Reversing starters 1)
Circuit breakers 1)
Star-delta starters,
can be combined with reversal of the direction
of rotation

Dahlander,
can be combined with reversal of the direction
of rotation

Pole-changing switches,
can be combined with reversal of the direction
of rotation

Valves
Sliders
Soft starters,
can be combined with reversal of the direction
of rotation

1) Due to of additional requirements (e.g. power measurement), it may be necessary to
select the BU2 device version.
Table 1-2: Control functions
System Description
SIMOCODE pro
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 1-13
1.5.3 Communication
PROFIBUS DP
SIMOCODE pro has an integrated PROFIBUS DP interface (SUB-D socket or
terminal connection on the basic units).
SIMOCODE pro supports, for example, the following services:
1.5.4 Standard function modules
Standard function modules are predefined functions which can simply be
activated, e.g. time-staggered restart of the drives after a power failure.
SIMOCODE pro has the following standard function modules:
Table 1-4: Standard function modules
SIMOCODE
Service pro C
(BU1)
pro V
(BU2)
Baud rates up to 12 MBit/s
Automatic baud rate recognition
Cyclic services (DPV0) and acyclic ser-
vices (DPV1)

Warnings according to DPV1
Time synchronization via PROFIBUS DP
Table 1-3: PROFIBUS DP services
SIMOCODE
Standard function modules pro C
(BU1)
Number
pro V
(BU2)
Number
Test 2 2
Reset 3 3
Test position feedback (TPF) 1 1
External fault 4 6
Operational protection off (OPO) 1
Power failure monitoring (UVO) 1
Emergency start 1 1
Watchdog (monitoring PLC/DCS) 1 1
Timestamping 1
System Description
SIMOCODE pro
1-14 GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
1.5.5 Operating, service and diagnostic data
SIMOCODE pro supplies a lot of operating, service and diagnostic data:
Operating data
motor switching state
all phase currents
all phase voltages
phase asymmetry
phase cycle
motor power/cos phi
time to trip
motor temperature
remaining cooling down time
etc.
Service data
Among other things, SIMOCODE pro yields the following information for
maintaining relevant data:
motor operating hours
motor stop times
number of motor starts
number of overload trippings
internal comments saved in the device
reason for switching off
signals
warnings
faults
etc.
Diagnostic data
numerous detailed early warning signals and fault signals
device-internal error protocolling with timestamp
etc.
System Description
SIMOCODE pro
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 1-15
1.5.6 Additional signal processing with freely programmable logic modules
If you need any other additional functions for your application, you can use
the logic modules which can be programmed freely. These can be used, for
example, to implement logical functions, time relay functions and counter
functions.
Depending on the device series, the system offers several logic modules
which can be parameterized freely:
SIMOCODE
Logic module pro C
(BU1)
Number
pro V
(BU2)
Number
Truth tables 3 inputs/ 1 output 3 6
Truth tables 2 inputs/ 1 output 2
Truth tables 5 inputs/ 2 outputs 1
Timers 2 4
Counters 2 4
Signal conditioners 2 4
Non-volatile elements 2 4
Flashing 3 3
Flickering 3 3
Limit monitor 4
Table 1-5: Logic modules which can be programmed freely
System Description
SIMOCODE pro
1-16 GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
1.6 Overview of system components
Devices
SIMOCODE pro
Connectable
system components
pro C
(BU1)
pro V
(BU2)
Application
Operator panel (OP) Installation in the cabi-
net door. Additional
control station and
display. With system
interface for connec-
ting a PC
Current measurement modules (IM)
0.3 A up to 3 A
2.4 A up to 25 A
Current measure-
ment with push-
through system. Basic
unit can be snapped
open
Current measurement modules (IM)
10 A up to 100 A
Current measurement modules (IM)
20 A up to 200 A
Current measure-
ment with push-
through system or a
rail connection system
Current measurement modules (IM)
63 A up to 630 A
Current measure-
ment with a rail con-
nection system
Current/voltage measurement
modules (UM)
*
0.3 A up to 3 A
2.4 A up to 25 A

Mounting only next to


the basic unit, other-
wise similar to the
current measurement
modules, also:
- voltage
measurement
- power measurement
- power factor (cos
phi) measurement
- phase cycle
Current/voltage measurement
modules (UM)
*
10 A up to 100 A

Current/voltage measurement
modules (UM)
*
20 A up to 200 A

Current/voltage measurement
modules (UM)
*
63 A up to 630 A

Table 1-6: System components, devices


System Description
SIMOCODE pro
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 1-17
Digital modules (DM)
24 V DC monostable
110 V up to 240 V AC/DC monosta-
ble
24 V DC bistable
110 V up to 240 V AC/DC bistable
Additional binary
inputs and outputs.
Maximum 2 DMs pos-
sible
Analog module (AM)
*

Additional inputting
and outputting as well
as monitoring of ana-
log values
Earth-fault module (EM)
*

For connecting a
3UL22 external sum-
mation current trans-
former for earth-fault
monitoring
Temperature module (TM)
*

For monitoring tempe-


rature via additional
Pt100, PT1000, KTY...
sensors
*
Available from the middle of 2005
SIMOCODE pro
Connectable
system components
pro C
(BU1)
pro V
(BU2)
Application
Table 1-6: System components, devices (cont.)
System Description
SIMOCODE pro
1-18 GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
Accessories
Software
For parameterization, control, diagnostics and testing
SIMOCODE basic unit
Connectable
system components
pro C pro V Application
Connecting cable in 4 different
lengths ranging from 0.025 m up to
2 m
For connecting
system components
via system interfaces
System interface cover For covering system
interfaces not in use
Memory module For saving the device
parameters. In the
case of device repla-
cement, parameteriza-
tion without a PC
Addressing plug For configuring the
PROFIBUS DP
address without a PC
PC cable For connecting
SIMOCODE pro to a
PC
Door adapter For leading out the
system interface
e.g. from a switchgear
cabinet
Table 1-7: System components, accessories
SIMOCODE basic unit
Software components pro C pro V Application
SIMOCODE ES Smart Access via the system
interface on the
device
SIMOCODE ES Professional
with Object Manager
OM SIMOCODE pro
Access via the system
interface on the
device and PROFI-
BUS DP
SIMOCODE ES Graphic
*
Graphical parameteri-
zation per
Drag&Drop
*
Available from the middle of 2005
Table 1-8: System components, software
System Description
SIMOCODE pro
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 1-19
1.7 Description of the system components
1.7.1 Basic units
The basic units are the fundamental components of the SIMOCODE pro
system. Basic units are always required when using SIMOCODE pro. They
have the same enclosure width of 45 mm and are equipped with detachable
terminals:
Figure 1-5: Basic units
Basic unit 1 (BU1)
Basic unit 1 is the fundamental component of the
SIMOCODE pro C device series. The following motor control functions are
supported:
direct starters and reversing starters
circuit breaker activation
Basic unit 2 (BU2)
Basic unit 2 is the fundamental component of the
SIMOCODE pro V device series. The following motor control functions are
supported:
direct starters and reversing starters
star-delta starters, also with reversal of the direction of rotation
2 speeds, motors with separate windings (pole-changing switches), also with
reversal of the direction of rotation
2 speeds, motors with separate Dahlander windings, also with reversal of the
direction of rotation
slide control
valve control
circuit breaker control
soft starter control, also with reversal of the direction of rotation
Basic unit 1 (BU1) Basic unit 2 (BU2)
SIMOCODE pro C device series SIMOCODE pro V device series
System Description
SIMOCODE pro
1-20 GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
Basic unit 2 offers the following options:
increasing the device functionality if necessary using expansion modules of
22.5 mm width
using a current/voltage measurement module instead of the current measure-
ment module used
additional inputs and outputs if necessary
1.7.2 Operator panel (OP)
The operator panel is often integrated into the front panels of motor control
centers. It can be used with the SIMOCODE pro C device series as well as
with the SIMOCODE pro V device series. It contains all the status LEDs
which are on the basic units, the test/reset button and makes the system
interface externally available.
It also offers the option of controlling the motor feeder from the cabinet. For
this, the operator panel is equipped with
5 buttons, of which 4 can be parameterized freely
10 LEDs, of which 7 can be parameterized freely
The following figure shows an operator panel:
Figure 1-6: Operator panel
The operator panel can be connected to the basic unit or to the expansion
module via the system interface on the back. The voltage is supplied by the
basic unit.
A PC with SIMOCODE ES or the memory module and the addressing plug
can be connected using the PC cable via the system interface on the front
(with a cover for IP54).
The power is supplied by the basic unit.
Operator panel
SIMOCODE pro C
SIMOCODE pro V
Device series
System Description
SIMOCODE pro
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 1-21
1.7.3 Current measurement modules (IM)
Current measurement modules are used with the basic units of the
SIMOCODE pro C and SIMOCODE pro V device series.
The current measurement module must be selected according to the set
current to be monitored (rated operating current of the motor). The current
measurement modules cover current ranges between 0.3 A and 630 A, with
interposing transformers up to 820 A.
The following figure shows the different current measurement modules:
Figure 1-7: Current measurement modules

The current measurement module is connected to the basic unit via a con-
necting cable which also supplies the power. Current measurement modu-
les up to 100 A are suitable for standard rail mounting or can be fixed
directly to the mounting plate using additional push-in lugs. The basic units
can be snapped directly onto the current measurement modules. The cur-
rent measurement modules up to 200 A can also be mounted on the stan-
dard rail or, optionally, they can be fixed directly to the mounting plate with
the screw attachments which are integrated into the enclosure. The current
measurement module up to 630 A can only be mounted using the integra-
ted screw attachments.
Current measurement modules
SIMOCODE pro C
SIMOCODE pro V
Device series
0.3A - 3A
2.4A - 25A
10A - 100A
20A - 200A 63A - 630A
System Description
SIMOCODE pro
1-22 GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
1.7.4 Current/voltage measurement modules (UM) for the SIMOCODE pro V
device series
The SIMOCODE pro V device series offers the option of using a current/
voltage measurement module instead of a current measurement module.
As well as the motor current, current/voltage measurement modules can
also
monitor voltages up to 690 V
evaluate and monitor the power and power factor (cos phi)
monitor the phase cycle
The following figure shows the different current/voltage measurement
modules:
Figure 1-8: Current/voltage measurement modules
The current/voltage measurement module is connected to the basic device
via a connecting cable which also supplies the power. Current/voltage mea-
surement modules up to 100 A are suitable for standard rail mounting or can
be fixed directly to the mounting plate using additional push-in lugs. The cur-
rent/voltage measurement modules up to 200 A can also be mounted on the
standard rail or, optionally, they can be fixed directly to the mounting plate
with the screw attachments which are integrated into the enclosure. Moun-
ting is only possible via the internal screw attachments for the current/
voltage measurement modules up to 630 A. Basic units can only be moun-
ted separately next to the current/voltage measurement modules.
Current/ voltage measurement modules
SIMOCODE pro V
Device series
0.3A - 3A
2.4A - 25A
10A - 100A
20A - 200A 63A - 630A
Monitoring voltages up to 690 V
System Description
SIMOCODE pro
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 1-23
1.7.5 Expansion modules for the SIMOCODE pro V device series
Expansion modules are intended as optional additions for the
SIMOCODE pro V device series. The following expansion modules are
available:
digital modules (DM)
analog module (AM)
earth-fault module (EM)
temperature module (TM)
All expansion modules have the same design with an enclosure width of
22.5 mm. They are equipped with 2 system interfaces (incoming/outgoing)
and detachable terminals.
The following figure shows an expansion module:
Figure 1-9: Expansion module
Digital modules (DM)
Digital modules offer the option of further increasing the types and number
of binary inputs and outputs on basic unit 2, if required.
For basic unit 2, the following digital modules are available:
Table 1-9: Variations of the digital modules
A maximum of two digital modules can be connected to basic unit 2, whe-
reby all versions listed here can be combined with each other.
SIMOCODE pro V can thus be extended to a maximum of 12 binary inputs
and 7 relay outputs.
Inputs Supply Outputs
4 inputs 24 V DC, external 2 monostable relay
outputs
4 inputs 110 ... 240 V AC/DC, external 2 monostable relay
outputs
4 inputs 24 V DC, external 2 bistable relay outputs
4 inputs 110 ... 240 V AC/DC, external 2 bistable relay outputs
Expansion module
SIMOCODE pro V
Device series
System Description
SIMOCODE pro
1-24 GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
Analog module (AM)
The analog module offers the option of expanding basic unit 2 by an analog
input (0/4-20 mA) and one analog output (0/4-20 mA). This makes it possible
to read, process and monitor analog signals. The analog values can be pro-
cessed internally and transmitted to the automation system. Any analog
signal of 0/4-20 mA can be outputted via the analog output.
1 analog module can be connected to BU2
Analog input signal 0/4 to 20 mA
Analog output signal 0/4 to 20 mA
Earth-fault modules (EM)
The earth-fault module offers the option of implementing powerful external
earth-fault monitoring in connection with the 3UL22 summation current
transformer (makes it possible to evaluate rated fault currents of 0.3 A, 0.5
A and 1 A). In addition to the internal earth-fault monitoring function, which
is supported by both device series, SIMOCODE pro V can be expanded by
an additional and more exact external earth-fault monitoring system.
1 earth-fault module can be connected to BU2
Temperature module (TM)
The temperature module offers the option of expanding the thermistor
motor protection for the SIMOCODE pro V device series by an analog tem-
perature monitoring system. With this, up to 3 analog sensor measuring cir-
cuits (three-wire system) can be evaluated. SIMOCODE pro V supports,
among others, the PTC, NTC, KTY sensor types as well as PT100 and
PT1000.
1 temperature module can be connected to BU2
Note:
All modules can be used/connected in any sequence.
System Description
SIMOCODE pro
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 1-25
1.7.6 Accessories
The following figure shows accessories which are independent of the device
series:
Figure 1-10: Accessories
PC cable
for the device parameterization, for connecting a PC to the system interface
of a basic unit via its serial interface.
Memory module
for plugging onto the system interface and for fast reading in or out of the
entire SIMOCODE pro parameterization, e.g. in the case of a unit replace-
ment (for this, see chapter "Replace SIMOCODE pro components" on page
12-9).
Addressing plug
for the hardware transfer of the PROFIBUS DP address to a basic unit wit-
hout a PC/programming device.
Connecting cable
in different lengths (0.025 m, 0.1 m, 0.5 m, 2.0 m) which are required for
connecting the individual basic units with their current modules and, if
necessary, with their expansion modules or operator panel. The total length
of all connecting cables must not exceed 3 m per system!
Door adapter
for making the system interface of a basic unit available at an easily accessi-
ble location (e.g. front panel), thus guaranteeing fast parameterization.
System interface cover
to protect the system interfaces from dirt or to seal them. In normal opera-
tion, system interfaces which are not used must be closed.
PC cable
Memory module
Addressing plug
Connecting cable
System interface
cover
SIMOCODE pro C
SIMOCODE pro V
Device series
Door adapter
System Description
SIMOCODE pro
1-26 GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
1.7.7 Software
SIMOCODE pro offers different software tools for thorough, time-saving
parameterization, configuration and diagnostics:
SIMOCODE ES
SIMOCODE ES is the standard parameterization software for
SIMOCODE pro, which is runnable on a PC/programming device under Win-
dows 2000 or Windows XP. It is available in 2 versions:
SIMOCODE ES Smart, for directly connecting the PC/programming device
(serial interface) to SIMOCODE pro with a PC cable via the system interface
on the device (point to point)
SIMOCODE ES Professional, for connecting one or more devices via
PROFIBUS DP and/or with PC cable via the system interface on the device
Object Manager OM SIMOCODE pro
Part of SIMOCODE ES Professional. When SIMOCODE ES Professional and
the OM SIMOCODE pro are installed on a PC/programming device,
SIMOCODE ES Professional can be called directly from Step7 HW configu-
ration. Thus, a simple and thorough SIMATIC-S7 configuration is made pos-
sible.
PCS 7 library SIMOCODE pro
With the PCS-7 library SIMOCODE pro, SIMOCODE pro can be connected
easily and conveniently to the SIMATIC PCS 7 process control system.
The PCS-7 library SIMOCODE pro contains
the corresponding diagnostic and driver blocks with the diagnostic and driver
concept of SIMATIC PCS 7
the elements necessary for operator control and process monitoring (sym-
bols and faceplate)
Attention!
Please observe the respective system versions!
GSD File
for the integration into SIMATIC S7 or into any DP standard master system
(automation system). The GSD file is on the SIMOCODE ES CD ROM in the
GSD directory. You will find the current German version on the Internet
under
http://www.ad.siemens.de/csi_d/gsd (under Schaltgerte, i.e. switchgear).
You will find further information on the integration of DP slaves in the docu-
mentation for the automation system.
Win SIMOCODE DP Converter
is a software tool for converting old Win SIMOCODE DP parameter files
(3UF5 device series) into SIMOCODE ES parameter files for
SIMOCODE pro.
System Description
SIMOCODE pro
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 1-27
1.8 Structural configuration of SIMOCODE pro
1.8.1 Function blocks
Characteristics
In the SIMOCODE pro system, there are internal function blocks e.g. for
control stations, control functions and motor protection.
Every function block has a name and is equipped with inputs and outputs.
The following table shows the possible inputs/outputs:
Table 1-10: Possible inputs/outputs
Input Symbol Example
Plugs (digital) Function blocks in the basic unit can have digital
plugs. These are connected via software to digital
sockets. They are relevant for the parameterization
e.g. with SIMOCODE ES.
Plugs (analog) Function blocks in the basic unit can have analog
plugs. These are connected via software to analog
sockets. They are relevant for the parameterization
e.g. with SIMOCODE ES.
Example: 2-byte word for cyclic signaling data.
Screw terminals Screw terminals are outside e.g. function block BU -
input. Control devices and auxiliary switches are
usually connected there.
Control data from
PROFIBUS DP
From the DP master to SIMOCODE pro e.g. function
block cyclic control data.
Output Symbol Example
Sockets (digital) Function blocks in the basic devices can have digital
sockets. These are assigned via software to digital
plugs. They are relevant for the parameterization e.g.
with SIMOCODE ES.
Sockets (analog) Function blocks in the basic devices can have sok-
kets. Sockets are assigned via software to analog
plugs. They are relevant for the parameterization e.g.
with SIMOCODE ES.
Example: 2-byte word max. current I_max.
Screw terminals Screw terminals are outside e.g. function block BU -
output. Contactors, for example, are connected
there.
Signaling data to
PROFIBUS DP
From SIMOCODE pro to the DP master e.g. function
block cyclic signaling data.
DP
DP
System Description
SIMOCODE pro
1-28 GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
Schematic of principle structural configuration
The following function block diagram shows the principal configuration of a
SIMOCODE pro basic unit:
Figure 1-11: Principal configuration of a SIMOCODE-pro basic unit
Connecting plugs with sockets
Note
The plugs and sockets of the function blocks have not already been connec-
ted at the factory with the binary inputs and the relay outputs of the basic
unit.
The internal wiring (connecting the plugs and sockets) is determined by the user
according to his respective application. *)
Attention!
If external wiring has already been carried out, but SIMOCODE pro was not
yet parameterized:
If you now press a button, the contactors will not be activated!
*) If you select an application in SIMOCODE ES, e.g. reversing starter, all
links and interlocks for the reversing starter are created in the basic unit.
1
2
3
1
2
Bit 0.0
Bit 0.1
Bit 0.2
Bit 0.0
Bit 0.1
Bit 0.2
IN1
IN2
IN3
IN4
4
OUT1
OUT2
OUT3
BU input
Cyclic
signaling data
Cyclic
control data
BU output
3
DP
DP
From the DP
Master
To the DP
Master
PROFIBUS DP
BU
PROFIBUS DP
Function block A
Function block C
Function block B
Inputs
(terminals)
Outputs
(sockets)
Inputs
(plugs)
Outputs
(sockets)
4
Outputs
(terminals)
Inputs
(plugs)
external
BU internal
Standard function
Control function
Logic function
Standard function
Function block D
SIMOCODE pro
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 2-1
Short Instructions for Configuring
a Reversing Starter 2
In this chapter
In this chapter you will find short instructions for configuring a reversing
starter including an example. Most of the parameters are appropriately set
as factory defaults for most of the applications. Only a few parameters have
to be set.
Target groups
This chapter is addressed to the following target groups:
planners
configurators
mechanics
electricians
commissioners.
Necessary knowledge
You need the following knowledge:
basic knowledge about SIMOCODE pro (see chapter 1 System Description)
basic knowledge of the SIMOCODE ES parameterization software.
Short Instructions for Configuring a Reversing Starter
SIMOCODE pro
2-2 GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
2.1 Introduction and target of the example
Introduction
The following simple example of a reversing starter demonstrates step-by-
step how to work with SIMOCODE pro. In this context, the reversing starter
will be equipped with
a local control station
and then with a second control station with PROFIBUS DP
The SIMOCODE ES software is used for parameterization.
The PC/programming device is connected to the basic unit via PC cable.
Target of the example
This example is intended to
1. Show you how to implement a standard switching operation of a reversing
starter with SIMOCODE pro in only a few steps
2. Help you modify this example for your respective application
3. Help you easily implement other applications
Important steps
The two important steps with SIMOCODE are always:
implementation of the external wiring (for control and feedback of main cur-
rent switching devices and control and signaling devices)
implementation/activation of internal SIMOCODE functions, with control and
analysis of the SIMOCODE inputs/outputs (internal SIMOCODE wiring).
Conditions
Load feeder/motor present
PLC/DCS control with PROFIBUS DP interface is present
The main circuit for the reversing circuit including the current measurement
module is already wired. In this case, the 3 cables leading to the motor must
be led through the push-through system openings of the current measure-
ment module.
PC/programming device is present
The SIMOCODE ES software is installed
The basic unit has the basic factory default settings. In chapter "Configuring
the basic factory default setting" on page 12-10 you will learn how to imple-
ment the basic factory default settings.
Short Instructions for Configuring a Reversing Starter
SIMOCODE pro
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 2-3
2.2 Reversing starter with motor feeder and local control
station
Necessary components
The following table shows the components that are required for
this example:
Table 2-1: Components needed for the example
Item Ordering data Order number
1 SIMOCODE pro C basic unit
(SIMOCODE pro V also possible)
3UF7000-1AU00-0
(3UF7000-1AU00-0)
2 Current measurement module 0.3 A up to 3 A 3UF7000-1AU00-0
3 Connecting cable for connecting the basic unit and
the current measurement module, depending on
the length
3UF7000-1AU00-0
4 SIMOCODE ES Smart or
SIMOCODE ES Professional software for parame-
terization via the system interface
(also SIMOCODE ES Professional software
for parameterization via PROFIBUS and the system
interface, including STEP-7 Object Manager possible)
3ZS1 312-1CC10-0YA0
(3ZS1 312-2CC10-0YA0)
5 PC cable for connecting the basic device to a PC/ pro-
gramming device
3UF7000-1AU00-0
6 PROFIBUS DP cable
Short Instructions for Configuring a Reversing Starter
SIMOCODE pro
2-4 GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
Circuitry of the reversing starter with SIMOCODE pro
The following schematic shows the circuitry of the main circuit and the con-
trol circuit:
Figure 2-1: Circuitry of the main circuit and the control circuit with SIMOCODE pro
Main circuit Control circuit
3/N/PE ~ 50/60 Hz 400/230 V
L1
L2
L3
N
PE
Q1
- K1
1 3 5
2 4 6
1 3 5
M
3~

PE
W V U
2 4 6
Current measurement
module (IM)
L1/L+
F11
K1
N/L
S0 S1
A1 A2
Motor, motor rated current e.g. 3 A
Basic unit (BU)
3 push-through
system openings
System
interface
Connecting cable
System
interface
S2
K2
CLASS 10
Optional: thermistor
1 3 5
2 4 6
- K2
IN1 IN2 IN3 24 V
OUT1 OUT2 1
Short Instructions for Configuring a Reversing Starter
SIMOCODE pro
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 2-5
Circuit diagram of the control circuit of a reversing starter
The following schematic shows the circuit diagram of the control circuit with
a local control station for the commands
LEFT
OFF
RIGHT.
Displays, signals, etc. are not taken into account.
Figure 2-2: Circuit diagram of the control circuit of a reversing starter
The necessary interlocks and links are carried out via the software in the
basic unit.
Standard reversing starter Reversing starter w. SIMOCODE pro
Necessary interlocks
and links
S0: LEFT button
S1: OFF button
S2: RIGHT button
K1: contactor clockwise rotation
K2: contactor counterclockwise rotation
L1/L+
F11
K1
N/L
S0 S1
A1 A2
Basic unit (BU)
K2
S2
L1/L+
N/L
K2
K2
K1
S2
S1
K1
K2
S0
K1
IN1 IN2 IN3 24 V
OUT1 OUT2 1
Short Instructions for Configuring a Reversing Starter
SIMOCODE pro
2-6 GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
2.3 Parameterization
The basics of parameterization
After the external connections have been carried out (contactor coils con-
nected, current measurement module integrated in the main circuit), the
second step is the parameterization of SIMOCODE pro.
For this you need to know the following points:
Figure 2-3: Schematic of the different function blocks in SIMOCODE pro
Point Description
1 Function blocks are stored internally in the SIMOCODE pro system, e.g. for
control stations and control functions with motor protection.
2 Function blocks have names.
3 Function blocks can have settings, e.g. the control function and the set cur-
rent. In the example: control function reversing starter and set current 3 A.
4 Function blocks have inputs and outputs. These are clearly designated.
5 You have to do the following in order to achieve the desired functionality:
connect the function blocks by connecting specific plugs to specific sockets
(i.e put the plugs in the sockets)
if required, set the values in the function blocks, e.g. the set current,
type of control function
6 The inputs of the function blocks in the basic device are designated and labe-
led as plugs:
7 The outputs of the function blocks in the basic device are designated and
labeled as sockets:
8 Plugs and sockets of the inputs and outputs of the devices are not connected
as factory defaults. If you press a button now, the contactors are not activa-
ted.
Short Instructions for Configuring a Reversing Starter
SIMOCODE pro
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 2-7
General procedure for parameterizing a reversing starter
Parameterization means:
1. Setting values
2. Linking function blocks
In the example, this means the following:
you must choose the control function reversing starter to implement all
interlocks and links in the basic device for the reversing starter.
you have to determine the set current Ie in the function block Motor Protec-
tion. In this case, the set current corresponds to the motor rated current,
here 3 A.
the BU - output function block must be connected to the sockets of the
control/contactor function block via the software. This means
connect BU - output 1 to socket contactor control QE1 (right)
connect BU - output 2 to socket contactor control QE2 (left)
the plugs of the control/contactors function block must be connected to
the sockets of the BU - input function block via the software. This means
connect local control station [LC] ON< to socket BU - input 1
connect local control station [LC] OFF to socket BU - input 2
connect local control station [LC] ON> to socket BU - input 3
Figure 2-4: Schematic of parameterization in the example
The assignment of the contactor controls QE* depends on the parameteri-
zed control function. See chapter 4 "Active control stations, contactor &
lamp controls and status signal of the control functions"
SIMOCODE pro
Connect
relay outputs
1
2
1
2
3
BU - inputs
Local control station [LC] Contactor controls
Choose a reversing starter
Determine Ie
Connect
digital inputs
BU - outputs
QE1
QE2
ON<
OFF
ON>
Control/contactors
I
e
= 3 A
Right
Left

Short Instructions for Configuring a Reversing Starter
SIMOCODE pro
2-8 GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
Concrete procedure for parameterization with SIMOCODE ES
Carry out the following steps:
Table 2-2: Parameterization with SIMOCODE ES
Step Description
1 Start SIMOCODE ES on your PC/programming device.
2 Choose the control function reversing starter as the application. When you
select this application, a range of presettings will be automatically carried out
that you will have to check later.
3 Under Device configuration, select either SIMOCODE pro C or
SIMOCODE pro V. Deactivate the operator panel if not present.
4 Open the dialog Device parameters > Motor protection > Overload/ asymmetry/
blocking. Set the set current Ie1 to 3A.
5 Open the dialog Further function blocks > Outputs > Basic device and check the
following settings:
contactor control > contactor control QE1.
contactor control > contactor control QE2.
6 Open the dialog Device parameters> Motor control > Control stations and check
the following settings:
local control [LC] ON<: BU - input 1
local control [LC] OFF: BU - input 2
local control [LC] ON>: BU - input 3
Check if the releases for ON and OFF for the operating mode local2
are set.
7 Parameterization is finished. Store the parameter file on your PC/ pro-
gramming device using Switchgear > Save.
The relay outputs are connected
to the contactor controls. QE1
QE2
1
2
BU - output
Control/contactors
Note:
By choosing a preset application (step 2), other presettings might be made
when assigning the BU outputs to the contactor controls.
The control station
is now connected locally with
the digital inputs. 1
2
3
BU - input
ON<
Off
ON>
Control/contactors
Short Instructions for Configuring a Reversing Starter
SIMOCODE pro
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 2-9
Transferring the parameters to the basic device and commissioning
After creating the parameter file, you can transfer it to SIMOCODE pro and
start up the reversing starter. To do this, execute the following steps:
Table 2-3: Transferring the parameters to the basic unit and commissioning
Attention
In this example, switching between right and left is only possible via
OFF and after expiration of the preset interlocking time of 5 seconds.
Configuration with local control station is finished
The configuration with SIMOCODE pro is now finished. You now have a
functional reversing starter with a local control station.
If the wiring and parameterization is correct, the contactors for clockwise
and counterclockwise rotation are activated when the corresponding but-
tons are pushed.
Step Description
1 Switch on the voltage supply of the basic device.
2 Connect the serial interface of the PC/programming device and the system
interface of the basic unit with the PC cable.
3 Observe the status LEDs on the basic unit. The Device LED must light up
green. SIMOCODE pro can be started up.
4 Transfer the parameter file to the basic unit via the menu e.g. using
Target system > Load in switchgear. Choose the RS232 interface with which
SIMOCODE pro is connected to the PC via the PC cable.
5 After having transferred the data to the basic device, you will receive the
message Download to the switchgear finished successfully.
Short Instructions for Configuring a Reversing Starter
SIMOCODE pro
2-10 GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
2.4 Extending the reversing starter with a control station
via PROFIBUS DP
In this section
In this section you will find out how the previously configured example can
be extended by one control station via PROFIBUS DP. You have the option of
using either the local control stations (local control) or PLC/ DCS (remote
control). This enables SIMOCODE pro to be controlled locally via buttons as
well as via PLC/ DCS.
The necessary connections are preset as factory defaults in
SIMOCODE pro. For this reason, you only have to set the PROFIBUS DP
address for SIMOCODE pro so that it can be recognized correctly as a DP
slave on the PROFIBUS DP.
Conditions
The following conditions must be fulfilled:
the motor is switched off
the supply voltage for the basic device is switched on. The Device LED
must light up green
you connected the basic unit to the PROFIBUS DP. The PROFIBUS DP inter-
face is on the front side (9-pole SUB-D socket)
you have integrated SIMOCODE pro in your automatization system.
You will find further information on the integration of DP slaves in the docu-
mentation for the automation system.
Setting the PROFIBUS DP address
First you have to set the PROFIBUS DP address of the basic unit. The follo-
wing option are available:
via the addressing plug
via SIMOCODE ES.
Short Instructions for Configuring a Reversing Starter
SIMOCODE pro
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 2-11
Setting the PROFIBUS DP address via SIMOCODE ES
Carry out the following steps:
Table 2-4: Setting the PROFIBUS DP address via SIMOCODE ES
Setting the PROFIBUS DP address via the addressing plug
Carry out the following steps:
Table 2-5: Setting the PROFIBUS DP address via the addressing plug
Step Description
1 Plug the PC cable into the system interface.
2 Start SIMOCODE ES.
3 Open the menu Switchgear > Open online.
4 Select RS232 and the corresponding COM interface.
Press OK to confirm.
5 Open the dialog Device parameters> Bus parameters.
6 Select the DP address.
7 Save the data in the basic unit with
Target system > Load to switchgear. The address is set. Confirm the
change of the address.
Step Description
1 Set the desired valid address on the DIP switch.
The switches are numbered.
Example address 21: Put the switches 16+4+1 in the ON position.
2 If necessary, pull the PC cable out of the system interface.
3 Plug the addressing plug in the system interface.
The Device LED lights up yellow.
4 Briefly press the test/ reset button. The set address is accepted. The
Device LED blinks yellow for approx. 3 seconds.
5 Pull the addressing plug from the system interface.
Short Instructions for Configuring a Reversing Starter
SIMOCODE pro
2-12 GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
Additional internal components of the basic unit
The control local control station [LC] is already wired, the external compon-
ents are connected and the required internal connections have been carried
out.
The following additional internal components that are already connected as
factory defaults and do not have to be parameterized are required:
PROFIBUS DP bit 0.0, bit 0.1 and bit 0.2 for the commands LEFT, OFF
and RIGHT
PROFIBUS DP bit 0.5 for the switching between the control stations (local)
and the PLC/DCS (remotely)
Bit0.5=0: local control station [LC] active
Bit0.5=0: PLC/ DCS [DP] control station active.
The PLC/DCS [DP] control station and the switch-over (plug) are already con-
nected with the bits (sockets) as factory defaults. The assignments can be
found in SIMOCODE ES under
Device parameters > Motor control > Control stations.
Figure 2-5: Schematic of internal components of the basic unit for the example
All pre-assigned cyclic signaling data is not shown.
The assignments can be found in SIMOCODE ES under
Additional function blocks > Outputs > Cyclic signaling data
Configuration with PLC/ DCS [DP] control station is finished
The configuration with SIMOCODE pro is now finished. You now have a
reversing starter with an additional control station via PROFIBUS DP.
The contactors for clockwise and counterclockwise rotation are controlled
by setting the corresponding bits.
SIMOCODEpro
1
2
3
1
2
Bit0.1
Bit0.2
PROFIBUS DP
Bit0.5
LEFT
OFF
RIGHT
LEFT
OFF
RIGHT
Status
ON<
OFF
ON>
QE1
QE2
Bit0.0
Bit0.1
Bit0.2
BU - input BU - output
Bit0.0
DP
Cyclic
control data
DP
Cyclic
signaling data
Control stations
Right
Left
S1
SIMOCODE pro
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 3-1
Motor Protection 3
In this chapter
In this chapter you will find information on motor protection.
Motor protection includes
overload protection
asymmetry protection
blocking protection
thermistor protection.
Unlike motor control, motor protection functions in the background. All
parameters of the motor protection are explained. They can be active or not
depending on the chosen control function.
Target groups
This chapter is addressed to the following target groups:
configurators
commissioners.
Necessary knowledge
You need the following knowledge:
good knowledge about SIMOCODE pro
the principle of connecting plugs to sockets
knowledge of electrical drive engineering.
Navigation in SIMOCODE ES
You will find the dialogs in SIMOCODE ES under:
Device parameters > Motor protection.
Motor Protection
SIMOCODE pro
3-2 GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
3.1 Introduction
Description
The motor protection functions overload protection, asymmetry protec-
tion, blocking protection and thermistor protection are explained in the
chapters 3.2 to 3.4.
Schematic diagram
The following schematic diagram shows the function circuit diagram of the
motor protection functions overload protection, asymmetry protection
and blocking protection with optional parameter settings and signals.
Figure 3-1: Motor protection functions
Overload protection
Set current Ie1
Set current Ie2
Class 5,10, ... 40
Response at pre-warning level
Reset (manual, automatic)
Load type (3-ph., 1-ph.)
Pause time
Cooling down time
Asymmetry protection
Blocking protection
Extended parameters:
Asymmetry protection level
Blocking protection level
Control function/motor protection
Signal:
- Cooling down time active
- Pause time active
- Emergency start active
- Time to switching off (analog)
- Heating up motor model (analog)
- Remaining cooling down time (analog)
- Last tripping current (analog)
- Pre-warning overload
- Overload + phase failure
- Overload
QE1
QE2
QE3
QE4
QE5
Switching
off
- Asymmetry
- Blocking
Current
Response at trip level
See
table 3-1
See
table 3-1
See
table 3-1
See
table 3-1
Motor Protection
SIMOCODE pro
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 3-3
Adjustable responses Overload protection, Asymmetry protection and Blocking
protection
Table 3-1: Adjustable responses Overload protection, Asymmetry protection and Blocking
protection
Response At pre-warning
level
At trip
level
At asymme-
try
level
At blocking
protection
level
Deactivated X X X X
Signal X X X X
Warn X (d) X X (d) X
Switch off - X (d) X X (d)
Delay 0 ... 25.5 s - 0 ... 25.5 s 0 ... 25.5 s
Motor Protection
SIMOCODE pro
3-4 GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
3.2 Overload protection
Description
SIMOCODE pro protects three-phase and AC motors in compliance with
IEC 60947-4-1. The tripping class can be set to 8 different settings ranging
from class 5 to class 40. Therefore, the switch off time can be adjusted very
precisely to the start-up time of the motor which allows the motor to be bet-
ter used to capacity. The interval up to the overload tripping is also calcula-
ted and can be put at the disposal of the control system. After an overload
tripping, the remaining cooling down time can be displayed.
Set current Ie1
The motor rated current is usually set with the set current Ie1. This value is
listed on the type plate of the motor. It is the basis for calculating the over-
load tripping characteristic curve.
Range: depends on the desired current measurement module
Set current Ie2
The current setting Ie2 is only necessary for motors with 2 speeds in order
to also guarantee suitable overload protection for the second speed as well.
Range: depends on the desired current measurement module
Attention
Please make sure that both current settings are in the same range. Other-
wise, you should use an additional 3U18 current transformer.
Set current Ie1 0.3 A up to 3 A
2.4 A up to 25 A
10 A up to 100 A
20 A up to 200 A
63 A up to 630 A
Set current Ie2: 0.3 A up to 3 A
2.4 A up to 25 A
10 A up to 100 A
20 A up to 200 A
63 A up to 630 A
Motor Protection
SIMOCODE pro
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 3-5
Class
The class (tripping class) indicates the maximum tripping time in which
SIMOCODE must trip cold with the 7.2-fold set current Ie (motor protection
according to IEC 60947). Please take into account that with start-ups >
Class 10, the admissible AC3 current of the contactor must be reduced
(derating), which means that a larger contactor must be used.
The following diagram shows the tripping classes 5, 10, 15, 20, 25, 30, 35
and 40 for a 3-pole symmetric load:
Figure 3-2: Switch-off classes for 3-pole symmetric loads
Range:
Class: 5, 10, 15, 20, 25, 30, 35, 40
1,15
Motor Protection
SIMOCODE pro
3-6 GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
The following diagram shows the tripping classes 5, 10, 15, 20, 25, 30, 35
and 40 for a 2-pole load:
Figure 3-3: Switch-off classes for 2-pole load
Range:
Response in case of overload
The response of SIMOCODE pro can be additionally adjusted in case of
overload:
Further information: see Tables of Responses of SIMOCODE pro in chapter
"Important Notes" and the table Responses in chapter 3.1 "Introduction".
Attention
With motors for EEx e applications the response must remain set to switch
off!
Class: 5, 10, 15, 20, 25, 30, 35, 40
0,85
Motor Protection
SIMOCODE pro
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 3-7
Cooling time
The cooling down time is the specified time after which an overload tripping
can be reset. It is usually five minutes.
Supply voltage failures of SIMOCODE during this time correspondingly
extend the specified time.
Range:
Pause time
The pause time is the specified time for the cooling response of the motor
when switching off under normal operating conditions (not in the case of
overload tripping!). After this interval, the thermal memory in
SIMOCODE pro is deleted and a new cold start is possible. Due to this, fre-
quent start-ups within a short period of time are possible.
The following schematic shows the cooling off response with and without a
pause time:
Figure 3-4: Cooling down response with and without pause time
Attention
The motor and the switchgear must be dimensioned specifically for this
load!
Range:
Cooling down time: 60 up to 6553.5 seconds
Pause time: 0 up to 6553.5 seconds
Trip limit
ON
t
t
t

Overload tripping
Without pause time
With pause time
Motor
OFF
No overload tripping
Pause time
Thermal memory will be deleted after the pause time
Trip limit
Motor Protection
SIMOCODE pro
3-8 GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
Load type
You can choose whether SIMOCODE pro is to protect a 1-phase or 3-phase
load. The internal earth-fault detection must be deactivated. The phase
failure monitoring is deactivated automatically.
Range:
Delay pre-warning
The delay parameter is used to determine the interval during which the
pre-warning level (1.15 x Ie) must be constantly exceeded before
SIMOCODE pro executes the desired response. Otherwise, there is no
reaction.
In case of phase failure or asymmetry > 50%, this pre-warning is already
issued at approx. 0.85 x Ie.
Reset
If the reset parameter is set to automatic, the overload, overload +
asymmetry and thermistor faults are acknowledged automatically
if the cooling down time has expired
if the thermistor value has decreased to the resetting value according to spe-
cification
If the reset parameter is set to automatic, the errors must be acknow-
ledged by a reset signal:
reset button on the basic unit
reset button on the operator panel
reset standard function modules.
For this reason, the reset - input inputs (plugs) must be connected to the
corresponding sockets, e.g. using reset via the bus.
Range:
Load type: 1-phase, 3-phase
Reset: Manual, automatic
Motor Protection
SIMOCODE pro
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 3-9
3.3 Asymmetry monitoring
Description
The extent of the phase asymmetry can be monitored and transmitted to
the control system. A definable and delayable response can be tripped
when an adjustable limit is exceeded. If the phase asymmetry is greater
than 50%, a reduction of the tripping time according to the overload charac-
teristic curve takes place automatically since the heat development in
motors increases with asymmetric conditions.
Limit
The limit of the asymmetry to which SIMOCODE pro is to react when overs-
hot is set here.
Range:
Response
Here you can choose the response of SIMOCODE pro in case of phase
asymmetry:
See Tables of Responses of SIMOCODE pro in chapter "Important Notes"
and the table Responses in chapter 3.1 "Introduction".
Asymmetry protection - delay
The asymmetry limit must be exceeded for the period of the set delay time
before SIMOCODE pro executes the desired response. Otherwise, there is
no reaction.
Limit: 0 to 100%
Motor Protection
SIMOCODE pro
3-10 GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
3.4 Blocking protection
Description
After the motor current exceeds an adjustable blocking limit (current limit), a
definable and delayable response can be parameterized in SIMOCODE pro.
For example, the motor can be set to switch off quickly independently of the
overload protection. The blocking protection is only active after the parame-
terized class interval has elapsed, e.g. for class 10 after 10 seconds. The
blocking protection prevents the motor from unnecessary high thermal and
mechanical load as well as premature deterioration.
Limit
After exceeding the blocking limit, SIMOCODE pro reacts according to the
specified response.
Range:
Response
Here you can determine the response to be executed when the blocking
limit is exceeded:
See Tables of Responses of SIMOCODE pro in chapter "Important Notes"
and the table Responses in chapter 3.1 "Introduction".
Delay
The delay parameter is used to specify the time interval. The blocking
level must constantly be exceeded before SIMOCODE pro executes the
desired response. Otherwise there is no reaction.
Limit: 0 up to 1020% of Ie
Motor Protection
SIMOCODE pro
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 3-11
3.5 Temperature monitoring
Description
Temperature monitoring is based on a direct temperature measurement in
the motor. Temperature monitoring is used for:
motors with high switching frequencies
converter operation
intermittent operation and/or during braking
a restricted air supply
speeds that are lower than the rated speed
In this case, the sensors are mounted in the winding slot or in the bearings
of the motor.
Characteristic curves
SIMOCODE pro provides the option of connecting two completely different
types of sensors:
Figure 3-5: Characteristic curves of temperature sensors

R
1 2

R
1 2
Temperature monitoring via binary PTC thermi-
stors that can be connected to basic unit 1 or
basic unit 2. The resistance of the thermistors
increases rapidly when the limit temperature is
reached.
PTC
Temperature monitoring via analog temperature
sensors like NTC, KTY83/84, PT100, PT1000 that
are connected to the optional temperature
module (T module). They have a characteristic
curve that changes almost linearly when the tem-
perature rises. For this reason, separate limits
can be set for the warning temperature and the
switch off temperature.
NTC PT / KTY
Sensor Type:
Binary
Analog
Motor Protection
SIMOCODE pro
3-12 GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
Schematic
The following schematic shows the function circuit diagram of temperature
monitoring:
Figure 3-6: Temperature monitoring
Thermistor protection, binary response
Overtemperature:
Here you can choose the SIMOCODE pro response to be executed if the tem-
perature exceeds the trip limit.
Attention
With motors for EEx e applications, the response must remain set to
switch off!
Sensor error (sensor circuit error):
Here you can choose the SIMOCODE pro response to be executed if there is
a short circuit or a wire break in the thermistor sensor cable.
See also Tables of Responses of SIMOCODE pro in chapter "Important
Notes".
Table 3-2: Thermistor protection, binary response
Response Trip limit T> Sensor fault
Deactivated - X
Signal X X
Warn X X
Switch off X X
Thermistor protection (binary)
Response at trip limit
Response to sensor fault
QE1
QE2
QE3
QE4
QE5
Activation
(in device configuration)
Signal:
- Thermistor short circuit
Thermistor
input
BU
Switching
off
u
R
see
table 3-2
see
table 3-2
- Thermistor trip limit
- Thermistor wire break
SIMOCODE pro
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 4-1
Motor Control 4
In this chapter
In this chapter you will find information on
control stations which you can select and enable according to need. The follo-
wing related topics are explained:
how control stations, modes of operation and enables work together
how control commands e.g. ON, OFF are switched through to the
control function
control functions you can select according to need. The following related
topics are explained:
how control commands e.g. ON, OFF are switched through from the
control stations to the contactor controls/relay outputs
which parameters apply depending on the control function chosen
Target groups
This chapter is addressed to the following target groups:
configurators
PLC programmers.
Necessary knowledge
You need knowledge about:
the principle of connecting plugs to sockets
electrical drive engineering
motor protection.
Navigation in SIMOCODE ES
You will find the dialogs in SIMOCODE ES under:
Device parameter > Motor control.
Motor Control
SIMOCODE pro
4-2 GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
4.1 Control stations
4.1.1 Description
Control stations are places from which control commands are given to the
motor. SIMOCODE pro supports four different control stations:
Local, in the direct vicinity of the motor. Control commands are issued via
pushbutton.
PLC/DCS, switching commands are issued by the automation system
(remote).
PC, control commands are issued via an operator control station or via
PROFIBUS DPV1 with the SIMOCODE ES software.
Operator panel, control commands are issued via the buttons of the operator
panel in the switchgear cabinet door.
Control commands can be e.g:
motor on (ON<), motor off (OFF) for a direct starter
motor left (ON<), motor off (OFF), motor right (ON>) for a reversing starter
motor slow (ON<), motor fast (ON<<) , motor off (OFF) for a Dahlander circuit
The inputs (plugs) must be connected to arbitrary sockets (e.g. device
inputs, control bits from PROFIBUS DP, etc.) for the control commands to
take effect.
Control stations contain:
5 inputs (plugs ON<<, ON<, OFF, ON>, ON>>). The number of active
inputs depends on the control function chosen. A direct starter, for
example, has only the inputs ON> and OFF active.
Motor Control
SIMOCODE pro
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 4-3
Control stations
Control station - local control
In this case, the control devices are usually in the direct vicinity of the motor
and are wired to the inputs of SIMOCODE pro. The inputs (plugs) must be
connected to arbitrary sockets (normally device inputs) for the control com-
mands to take effect.
Control station - PLC/DCS
This control station is primarily intended for control commands from the auto-
mation system (PLC/DCS) via the cyclic control telegram of PROFIBUS DP.
The inputs (plugs) must be connected to arbitrary sockets (normally
PROFIBUS DP bits) for the control commands to take effect.
Attention
The OFF command LC OFF is 0-active. Therefore, it is guaranteed that
SIMOCODE pro switches off the motor safely e.g. in case of a wire break in
the supply cable. The precondition is that the control station is active.
Pushbutton BU input Local [LC]
ON<<
ON<
OFF
ON>
ON>>
IN1
IN2
IN3
IN4
1
2
3
4
To
enable
PLC
Cycl. cont. data
DP
PLC/DCS [DPV1]
ON<<
OFF
ON>>
ON<
ON>
Bit 0.0
Bit 1.7
Number: 16
To
enable
Motor Control
SIMOCODE pro
4-4 GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
Control station - PC
This control station is primarily intended for switching commands on an arbi-
trary PC which, along with the automation system, is used as a second
master on the PROFIBUS DP. The control commands are sent via the acyclic
control telegram from PROFIBUS DPV1.
Control station - operator panel
This control station is primarily intended for control commands issued via the
buttons of the 3UF72 operator panel which is e.g. mounted in a switchgear
cabinet door. The inputs (plugs) must be connected to arbitrary sockets (nor-
mally buttons of the operator panel) for the control commands to take effect.
Attention
If the SIMOCODE ES Professional/SIMATIC PDM PC software is connec-
ted to SIMOCODE pro via PROFIBUS DP, its control commands automati-
cally take effect via the PC[DPV1] control station. No additional paramete-
rization is necessary.
PC
Acycl. cont. data
DP
PC [DPV1]
ON<<
ON<
OFF
ON>
ON>>
Bit 0.0
Bit 1.7
Number: 16
To
enable

Attention
Since the operator panel only has 4 buttons for controlling the motor feeder,
one button must be used as a speed switch button for control functions with
2 rotational speeds and 2 directions of rotation.
For this purpose, the button must be assigned to the internal control com-
mand [OP]<>/ <<>>.
Attention
If the SIMOCODE ES PC-Software is connected to SIMOCODE pro via
the system interface, the control commands automatically take effect via
the control station operator panel (OP). No additional parameterization is
necessary.
Op. panel [OP]
Operator
panel
OP buttons <>/<<>>
ON<
OFF
ON>
ON>>
To
enable
Motor Control
SIMOCODE pro
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 4-5
4.1.2 Modes of operation and mode selectors
Modes of operation
You can use the control stations either individually or in combination. There
are four different modes of operation you can switch between:
local 1
local 2
local 3
remote/automatic
In this mode of operation, the communication must be carried out via PLC.
Not all control stations are usually connected. If more than one control sta-
tion (e.g local and PLC/DCS) is connected, it makes sense and is also man-
datory to operate the control stations selectively. Four modes of operation
are provided for this purpose which can be selected via two control signals
(mode selectors). For each individual control station in every mode of opera-
tion, it can be stipulated if ON commands and/or OFF commands are to
be used. The modes of operation are controlled in multiplex operation, i.e.
only one mode of operation is active at any one time.
Example:
There are three modes of operation in a system:
Table 4-1: Modes of operation
The key-operated switch must be read in via an input to select these modes
of operation. The remote switching operation should be controlled via the
bus. The key-operated switch operation has priority over all other modes of
operation.
Mode of operation Description
Key-operated switch ope-
ration,
e.g. local 1
Only local control entries are admissible!
All other control stations are locked.
Manual operation,
e.g. local 3
Only operator panel control commands and local control
commands can be issued.
Remote operation,
e.g. remote/automatic
Only PLC/DCS control commands are permitted; locally, only
OFF commands are permitted.
Motor Control
SIMOCODE pro
4-6 GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
Mode selectors
The S1/S2 mode selectors are used to switch between the local1, local2,
local3 and remote/automatic modes of operation. The inputs (S1 and
S2 plugs) must be connected to arbitrary sockets (e.g. device inputs, control
bits from PROFIBUS DP, etc.) for this.
The following table shows the modes of operation, depending on the signal
status of the S1 and S2 mode selectors:
Table 4-2: Modes of operation depending on S1 and S2
Switch authorizations for the individual control stations (local control [LC],
PLC/DCS [DP], PC [DPV1], operator panel (OP)) can be set with the different
modes of operation for enabling the control stations. The modes of opera-
tion are operated via the mode selector in the multiplex. This means that
only one mode of operation is always valid, controlled via the signals S1 and
S2 (column).
Example for a dynamic mode of operation in relationship to time:
Figure 4-1: Example - modes of operation
Input
Mode of operation
Local 1 Local 2 Local 3 Remote/
automatic
S1 0 0 1 1
S2 0 1 0 1
0
0
Local 1 Remote Local 3 Remote Local 1
1
1
1
0
1
1
0
0
Key-
Time t
Remote operation Manual operation Remote operation Key-
S1
S2
0
operated switch operated switch
Motor Control
SIMOCODE pro
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 4-7
Operator enable of the individual control stations
The following diagram shows the operator enable of an individual control
station:
Figure 4-2: Operator enable of a single control station
The following is enabled:
: all ON commands
: OFF command
I O
ON<<
ON<
OFF
ON>
ON>>
OFF
I
O
Inputs
Single control station
Simplified diagram
of the single control station
ON
ON: ON>>, ON>,
4 4
E1...4
I
O
I
O
I
O
I
O
E1...4
E1...4
E1...4
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
Local control [LC]
PLC/DCS [DP]
PC [DPV1]
Operator panel (OP)
ON<, ON<<,
E
A
Motor Control
SIMOCODE pro
4-8 GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
4.1.3 Enables and enabled control command
Enables
Enables for the control commands ON and OFF, which must be activa-
ted, are assigned to each single control station for every mode of operation.
The corresponding checkbox is activated in the dialog Control stations in
SIMOCODE ES.
Enabled control command
The control commands are switched through to the function block Enabled
control command. The control function, e.g. reversing starter, is usually
controlled with this function blocks sockets.
Enables and enabled control command schematic
The following diagram shows the control stations and modes of operation:
Figure 4-3: Enables and enabled control command
ON <<
OFF
ON >>
ON <
ON>
Local

ON <<
OFF
ON >>
ON <
ON >
Operator

ON <<
OFF
ON >>
ON <
ON >
PLC/DCS[DP]
ON <<
OFF
ON >>
ON <
ON >
PC [DPV1]
Local1 Local2 Local3 Remote
S1
S2
Mode selector
0
0
0
1
1
0
1
1
En-
Enables
ON
OFF
abled
control
command
ON <<
OFF
ON >>
ON <
ON >
Enables
Enables
ON
OFF
Activation of enables
for control commands
ON and OFF in
SIMOCODE ES
To the control
function
Enables
ON
OFF
Enables
ON
OFF
Enables
ON
OFF
I
O
I
O
I
O
I
O
I
O
I
O
I
O
I
O
I
O
I
O
I
O
I
O
I
O
I
O
I
O
I
O
control [LC]
panel (OP
)

Motor Control
SIMOCODE pro
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 4-9
4.1.4 Settings
Control stations Description
LC Activates the control station via an arbitrary signal (arbi-
trary sockets ,
but usually device inputs).
The OFF plug is 0-active on the control station [LC].
ON<<
ON<
OFF
ON>
ON>>
PLC/DCS [DP] Activates the control station via an arbitrary signal (arbi-
trary sockets ,
but usually control bits from PROFIBUS DP)
ON<<
ON<
OFF
ON>
ON>>
PC [DPV1] Activates the control station via an arbitrary signal (arbi-
trary sockets ,
but usually control bits from PROFIBUS DPV1)
ON<<
ON<
OFF
ON>
ON>>
Operator panel [OP] Activates the control station via an arbitrary signal (arbi-
trary sockets ,
but usually operator panel pushbuttons)
<>/<<>>
ON<
OFF
ON>
ON>>
Mode selector For switching between the 4 modes of operation local 1,
local 2, local 3, remote with arbitrary signals
(arbitrary sockets , e.g. device inputs, control bits
from PROFIBUS DP, etc.)
S1
S1
Table 4-3: Control station settings
Motor Control
SIMOCODE pro
4-10 GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
4.2 Control functions
4.2.1 Description
Control functions (e.g. direct starters, reversing starters) are used for con-
trolling load feeders.
They have the following important features:
enabling/evaluation of control stations
monitoring switching on/switching off (no current flows without the ON com-
mand)
monitoring the OFF state (no current flows without the ON command)
monitoring the ON status
switching off in case of a fault.
For monitoring these statuses, SIMOCODE uses F (feedback) ON, which is
usually derived directly from the current flow information.
All necessary interlocks and connections for the corresponding applications
are already implemented in the control functions.
Control functions contain:
inputs (plug ) for
control commands (ON <<,ON <, OFF, ON >, ON >>) that are usually
connected with the sockets Enabled control command. From there,
control commands come from the different control stations. The num-
ber of active inputs depends on the control function chosen. For
example, with a direct starter, only the inputs ON> and OFF are
active.
auxiliary control inputs (plug ), e.g. Feedback ON
outputs (sockets ) for
contactor controls QE1 to QE5. The number of contactor controls
depends on the control function chosen. The contactor controls are
usually connected to the relay outputs that are intended for controlling
the contactor coils
displays (lamp controls) QL*, QLS. The number of displays depends on
the control function chosen.
statuses, e.g. Status - ON <<, Status - ON >>. The number of statu-
ses depends on the control function chosen.
faults, e.g. Fault - feedback (F) ON, Fault - antivalence
settings, e.g. interlocking time, non-maintained command mode ON/OFF, etc.
motor protection with the parameters e.g. Overload protection - set current
Ie1, overload protection - class, etc. These parameters are described in
chapter3 "Motor Protection".
Like control functions, the motor protection with its parameters and signals is
active in the background. Motor protection and thermistor motor protection
are independent functions that switch off the motor when activated via the
control functions.
Standard function blocks that can be activated as required
A logic component with all necessary interlockings and connections for the
control function
Motor Control
SIMOCODE pro
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 4-11
Control function schematic
The following schematic shows the general representation of a control
function:
Figure 4-4: General representation of the control function
1) Status signals:
The feeder status feedback is reported via the status signals or the QL
signals. The feedback information (ON or OFF) is linked to the signal
Feedback ON (e.g. current).
Feeder status feedback:
status signals, e.g. Status ON<, that can be analyzed e.g. via
PROFIBUS DP
display, (lamp control) Display - QLE<, that can activate e.g. a signal lamp
ON<<
En-
abled
control
command
ON<<
OFF
ON>>
ON<
ON>
ON<
OFF
ON>
ON>>
QE1
QE3
QE5
QE2
QE4
Control commands Contactor controls
Displays (lamp
QLE <<
QLA
QLE >>
QLE <
QLE >
QLS
(ON<<)
(ON<)
(OFF)
(ON>)
(ON>>)
(Fault)
Aux. control inputs *
Plugs of the control commands are usually
connected with the Enabled control com-
mand sockets
* Abbreviations
Feed-
back ON
Feedback ON
FC Feedback CLOSE
FO Feedback OPEN
TC Torque CLOSE
TO Torque OPEN
F ON
FC
FO
TC
TO
Status signals 1),
ON<<
OFF
ON>>
ON<
ON>
Contactors/control
Setting
Control function
Motor protection
e.g. for PROFIBUS DP
control)
Motor Control
SIMOCODE pro
4-12 GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
Extent and application
Depending on the device series, the system provides the following control
functions:
SIMOCODE
Control function pro C
(BU1)
pro V
(BU2)
Overload relay
Direct starter
Reversing starter
Circuit breaker
Star-delta starter
Star-delta starter,
with reversal of the direction of rotation

Dahlander
Dahlander,
with reversal of the direction of rotation

Pole-changing switch
Pole-changing switch,
with reversal of the direction of rotation

Valve
Slider 1 to slider 5
Soft starter
Soft reversing starter
Table 4-4: Control functions
Motor Control
SIMOCODE pro
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 4-13
4.2.2 General settings and definitions
Parameters
Parameter Description
F ON Auxiliary control input Feedback ON (connection with arbitrary
socket , usually with Status - current flowing socket) as fac-
tory default. An auxiliary contact from the contactor to the signal is
not necessary. Depending on the control function chosen, this
state is signaled by the QLE1 to QLE5 displays and by the status -
ON <<, - ON <, - ON >, - ON >> signals. No current flowing
means: the motor is switched off. An auxiliary contact from the
contactor is not required for signaling. This state is signaled by the
QLA display and the Status - OFF signal
Non-maintained
command mode
Deactivated:
the control command on the corresponding input of the control
stations ON <, ON <<, ON >,ON >> is saved. It can only be
revoked by an OFF control command from the corresponding
control station. The auxiliary contact for locking the contactor is
no longer necessary. Motor feeders are usually operated in lok-
king mode. Locking is preset.
Activated:
non-maintained command mode affects the inputs of all control
stations ON<, ON <<, ON >, ON >>, depending on the control
function chosen. A control command is only effective as long as
there is a high signal.
Save switching
command
Deactivated:
commands for switching from one direction of rotation/rotational
speed to the other are only implemented after a previous OFF
and after the interlocking time/switching interval has elapsed.
This setting is usually used and is preset.
Activated:
commands for switching from one direction of rotation/rotational
speed to the other are implemented without a previous OFF
and after the interlocking time/switching interval has elapsed.
If the selected direction/speed cannot be executed immediately
due to a parameterized interlocking time/switching interval, the
selection is signalized by flickering QLE displays. Your selection
can be canceled at any time with OFF.
Load type You can choose between
motor
resistive load
Table 4-5: General settings and definitions
Motor Control
SIMOCODE pro
4-14 GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
Feedback time SIMOCODE monitors the status of the feeder (ON or OFF) via F ON
(Feedback ON).
If the status of F ON changes - without a corresponding switching
command - the fault feedback (F) switches off the feeder.
The default value is 0.5 s.
The feedback time can be used to suppress such feedback faults
for a defined period of time, e.g. in case of network switches.
When the motor is switched off, SIMOCODE continuously controls
if F ON = 0. If the current flows longer than the set feedback time
without the ON control command being issued, a fault message
fault - feedback (F) ON is issued. The contactor controls can only
be connected after the fault has been rectified.
When the motor is switched on, SIMOCODE pro continuously con-
trols if F ON = 1. If the current flows longer than the set feedback
time without the OFF command being issued, a fault message
fault - feedback (F) OFF is issued. The contactor controls are
deactivated.
Execution time SIMOCODE pro monitors switching on/switching off. Switching on/
switching off must be completed within this time period.
The default value is 1.0 s. After an ON control command has been
issued, SIMOCODE pro must measure the current in the main cir-
cuit within the execution time. Otherwise, the fault message Fault
- execution ON command will be issued. SIMOCODE pro deacti-
vates the contactor controls.
After the OFF control command is issued, SIMOCODE pro must
not be able to detect any current in the main circuit after the execu-
tion time. Otherwise, the fault message Fault - execution OFF
command will be issued. The contactor controls can only be con-
nected after the fault has been rectified.
Switching interval For the "Dahlander" and "pole-changing switch" control functions,
switching from the fast speed to the slow one can be delayed with
the time configured.
For the "Star/Delta" control function, the switching interval extends
the switching interval between switching off the star contactor and
switching on the delta contactor by the time configured.
Interlocking time SIMOCODE pro prevents, e.g. in the case of reversing starters,
both contactors from switching on at the same time. Switching
from one direction of rotation to the other can be delayed via the
interlocking time.
Parameter Description
Table 4-5: General settings and definitions
Motor Control
SIMOCODE pro
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 4-15
Figure 4-5: Execution time (Az) and feedback time (Rz) depending on F ON
Faults
The contactor controls are deactivated. There is also:
a flashing signal on the QLS lamp control
a flashing signal on the GEN. FAULT LED
the Status - general fault signal
the corresponding signaling bit of the fault
1
0
OFF
Switch ON ON
OFF
1
0
OFF
Switch OFF
QE
F ON
Az Rz Az Rz
Voltage failure,
e.g. pulsating current conditions
Az: Execution time
Rz: Feedback time
Motor Control
SIMOCODE pro
4-16 GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
4.2.3 Overload relay
Description
With this control function, SIMOCODE pro functions like an electronic over-
load relay. Control commands (e.g. ON, OFF) cannot be issued to the load.
The control stations, as well as the inputs of the control function (e.g. ON>,
OFF), do not have any function in the case of overload relays.
When applying the control voltage, SIMOCODE pro automatically closes the
QE3 contactor control; it remains active until it is deactivated by the fault
signal of a protection or monitoring system.
The QE3 contactor control must be connected to an arbitrary relay output
that switches off the contactor coil of the motor contactor in case of over-
load.
Overload relay schematic
Figure 4-6: Overload relay schematic
Settings
You will find detailed information about the settings in chapter "General set-
tings and definitions" on page 4-13.
Note:
In the case of overload, the QE3 output is set (=1) and is only reset when
the overload is tripped (=0).
This output closes when the overload function is parameterized.
Overload relay Description
F ON Auxiliary control input Feedback ON (connection with arbitrary
socket , usually with Status - current is flowing socket).
Load type You can select between
motor
resistive load.
Table 4-6: Overload relay settings
Aux. control inputs
Contactor controls
Displays
QE3
F ON* QLS
(Fault)
*Feedback ON
Contactors/controlling
Load type
Overload relays
Motor protection
Motor Control
SIMOCODE pro
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 4-17
4.2.4 Direct starters
Description
SIMOCODE pro can switch a motor on and off with this control function.
Control commands
Start with ON > activates the QE1 internal contactor control
Stop with OFF deactivates the QE1 internal contactor control
The control commands can be issued from arbitrary control stations
to SIMOCODE pro (see also the description of control stations). The
inputs (plugs) must be connected to the corresponding sockets, preferably
to the Enabled control command sockets.
Every fault signal causes the QE1 contactor control to be deactivated.
Direct starter schematic
Figure 4-7: Direct starter schematic
Control commands
Aux. control inputs
Contactor controls
Displays (lamps)
Status
QE1
F ON*
QLA
QLE >
QLS
OFF
ON>
(ON)
(OFF)
(Fault)
*Feedback ON
OFF
ON>
Contactors/controlling
Feedback time
Execution time
Non-maintained
Load type
Direct starters
Motor protection
ON
command mode
Motor Control
SIMOCODE pro
4-18 GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
Settings
You will find detailed information about the settings in chapter "General set-
tings and definitions" on page 4-13.
Direct starter Description
OFF OFF control command
(connection with arbitrary socket ,
preferably with the Enabled control command - OFF socket)
ON> ON control command
(connection with arbitrary socket ,
preferably with the Enabled control command - ON> socket)
F ON Auxiliary control input Feedback ON (connection with arbitrary
socket , usually with Status - current is flowing socket).
Non-maintained
command mode
Deactivated (presetting)
Activated
Load type You can select between
motor
resistive load
Feedback time Range: 0 to 25.5 seconds
Execution time Range 0 to 6553.5 seconds
Table 4-7: Direct starter settings
Motor Control
SIMOCODE pro
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 4-19
4.2.5 Reversing starters
Description
With this control function, SIMOCODE pro can control the direction of rota-
tion of the motor (forwards and backwards).
Control commands
Start with ON > activates the QE1 contactor control (clockwise i.e. for-
wards)
Start with ON < activates the QE2 contactor control (counter-clockwise i.e.
backwards)
Stop with OFF deactivates the QE1 and QE2 internal contactor controls.
The control commands can be issued from arbitrary control stations
to SIMOCODE pro (see also the description of control stations). The
inputs (plugs) must be connected to the corresponding sockets, preferably
to the enabled control command sockets.
Every fault signal causes the QE1 and QE2 contactor controls to be deacti-
vated.
Switching the direction of rotation
Switching the direction of rotation is possible
via the OFF control command
directly, when the Save switching command is activated
if the signal Status - ON > or Status - ON < is no longer issued (motor is
switched OFF) AND after the interlocking time has expired.
SIMOCODE pro prevents both the contactors from switching on at the
same time. Switching from one direction of rotation to the other can be
delayed via the interlocking time.
Motor Control
SIMOCODE pro
4-20 GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
Reversing starter schematic
Figure 4-8: Reversing starter schematic
Control commands
Aux. control inputs
Contactor activations
Displays
Status -
QE1
QE2
F ON*
QLE <
QLA
QLE >
QLS
ON<
OFF
ON>
ON<
OFF
ON>
Contactors/controlling
Feedback time
Execution time
Interlocking time
Non-maintained
Save switching

Load type

(ON>)
(OFF)
(Fault)
(ON<)
*Feedback ON
Reversing starter
Motor protection
Right
Left
Interlocking time
active

command mode
command
Motor Control
SIMOCODE pro
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 4-21
Settings
You will find detailed information about the settings in chapter "General set-
tings and definitions" on page 4-13.
Reversing starter Description
ON< ON< control command, counter-clockwise rotation
(connection with arbitrary socket ,
usually with Enabled control command - ON< socket)
OFF OFF control command
(connection with optional socket ,
usually with Enabled control command - OFF socket)
ON> ON> control command, clockwise rotation
(connection with arbitrary socket ,
usually with Enabled control command - ON> socket)
F ON Auxiliary control input Feedback ON (connection with arbitrary
socket , usually with Status - current is flowing socket)
Non-maintained
command mode
Deactivated (presetting)
Activated
Save switching
command
Deactivated (presetting)
Activated
Load type You can select between
motor
resistive load
Feedback time Range: 0 to 25.5 seconds
Execution time Range 0 to 6553.5 seconds
Interlocking time Range 0 to 255 seconds
Table 4-8: Reversing starter settings
Motor Control
SIMOCODE pro
4-22 GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
4.2.6 Circuit breaker
Description
With this control function, SIMOCODE pro can ideally switch a circuit brea-
ker (e.g. 3WL, 3VL) ON and OFF. Thus, the circuit breakers are connected to
PROFIBUS DP via SIMOCODE pro.
Control commands
Start with ON> activates the QE1 contactor control for an impulse of
400 ms.
Stop with OFF activates the QE2 contactor control for an impulse of
400 ms.
With reset, the QE2 contactor control is activated for an impulse of 400 ms
when the circuit breaker is released (alarm switch = ON).
The impulse of a control command is always fully executed before the
counter impulse is set.
The control commands can be issued from arbitrary control stations
to SIMOCODE pro (see also the description of control stations). The
inputs (plugs) must be connected to the corresponding sockets, preferably
to the Enabled control command sockets.
Making internal assignments
You have to make the following assignments:
1. Assign the QE1 contactor control to the relay output that is connected to the
ON connection of the motor drive of the circuit breaker.
2. Assign the QE2 contactor control to the relay output that is connected to the
OFF connection of the motor drive of the circuit breaker.
3. Assign the SIMOCODE pro input, which is connected to the auxiliary switch
(HS) of the circuit breaker, to the auxiliary control input Feedback ON.
4. Assign the SIMOCODE pro input, which is connected to the alarm switch of
the circuit breaker, to the input of the External fault 1 standard function
block.
Motor Control
SIMOCODE pro
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 4-23
Circuit breaker schematic
Figure 4-9: Circuit breaker schematic
Control commands
Aux. control inputs
Contactor controls
Displays
Status
QE1
QE2
F ON*
QLA
QLE >
QLS
OFF
ON>
400 ms.
400 ms.
OFF
ON>
Contactors/controlling
Feedback time
Execution time
Non-maintained
Load type
(ON)
(OFF)
(Fault)
*Feedback ON
Circuit breaker
Motor protection
ON
OFF
Auxiliary switch
command mode
Motor Control
SIMOCODE pro
4-24 GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
Settings
You will find detailed information about the settings in chapter "General set-
tings and definitions" on page 4-13.
Circuit breaker Description
OFF OFF control command
(connection with arbitrary socket ,
usually with Enabled control command - OFF socket)
ON> ON control command
(connection with arbitrary socket ,
usually with Enabled control command - ON> socket)
F ON Auxiliary control input Feedback ON (connection always with sok-
ket , (input), which the auxiliary switch of the circuit breaker is
connected to.)
Non-maintained
command mode
Deactivated (presetting)
Activated
Load type You can choose between
motor
resistive load
Feedback time Higher than the motor running time of the motor drive of the circuit
breaker. Range: 0 to 25.5 seconds
Execution time Range 0 to 6553.5 seconds
Table 4-9: Circuit breaker settings
Motor Control
SIMOCODE pro
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 4-25
4.2.7 Star-delta starters
Description
Star-delta starting is used to limit the starting current and to avoid overloa-
ding the network. In this control function, SIMOCODE pro starts the motor
first with a star-switched stator winding and then switches it to delta.
Control commands
Start with ON first activates the QE1 contactor control (star contactor) and
then immediately activates the QE3 contactor control (network contactor)
Stop with OFF deactivates the QE1, QE2 and QE3 contactor controls.
The control commands can be issued from arbitrary control stations
to SIMOCODE pro (see also the description of control stations). The
inputs (plugs) must be connected to the corresponding sockets, preferably
to the Enabled control command sockets
Every fault signal causes the QE1, QE2 and QE3 contactor controls to be
deactivated.
Switching from star to delta
For this, SIMOCODE pro first deactivates the QE1 contactor control before
the QE2 contactor control (delta contactor) is connected.
SIMOCODE pro switches from star to delta:
current-dependent with decreasing current below the level (I < 90% Ie).
time-dependent according to the set time parameter Maximum time for star
operation when the current in the star operation does not sink below this
level.
Notes
It is recommended wiring the QE* contactor controls to the relay outputs of
the basic unit.
Attention
If you use the internal earth-fault detection with a star-delta connection,
false trippings might occur. For delta operation, the summation current is
non-zero due to harmonics.
Attention
If the current measurement module is switched to delta (normal case), a
current which is 1/3 times smaller must be set for the star-delta starter
control function.
Example: In = 100 A Ie = In x 1/3
Ie = 100 A x 1/3 = 57.7 A
Current to be set Ie = 57.7 A
Motor Control
SIMOCODE pro
4-26 GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
Switching interval
The switching time from star to delta can be extended by the switching
interval.
Reason: for motors with a high ratio between starting current and rated cur-
rent, the mains voltage plus motor EMF might lead to a very high delta star-
ting current if the switching interval is too short. The motor EMF decreases
if the interval is longer.
Star-delta starter schematic
Figure 4-10: Star-delta starter schematic
Control commands
Aux. control inputs
Contactor controls
Displays
Status -
QE1
QE2
F ON*
QLA
QLE >
QLS
OFF
ON>
OFF
ON>
Contactors/controlling
Feedback time
Execution time
Non-maintained
Load type
(ON)
(OFF)
(Fault)
QE3
Switching interval
Maximum time for
star operation
Transformer
mounted
*Feedback ON
Star-delta starter
Motor protection
Switching time
active
Star contactor
Delta contactor
Network contactor
command mode
Motor Control
SIMOCODE pro
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 4-27
Settings
You will find detailed information about the settings in chapter "General set-
tings and definitions" on page 4-13.
Star-delta starter Description
OFF OFF control command
(connection with arbitrary socket ,
usually with Enabled control command - OFF socket)
ON> ON control command
(connection with arbitrary socket ,
usually with Enabled control command - ON> socket)
F ON Auxiliary control input Feedback ON (connection with arbitrary
socket, usually with Status - current is flowing socket)
Non-maintained
command mode
Deactivated (presetting)
Activated
Load type You can choose between
motor
resistive load
Feedback time Range: 0 to 25.5 seconds
Execution time Range 0 to 6553.5 seconds
Switching interval Range 0 to 655.3 seconds(10 ms steps)
Maximum time for
star operation
Time-dependent switching from star to delta
range 0 to 255 seconds
Transformer moun-
ted
The set current and the switching levels for star-delta switching
depend on the mounting place of the current measurement
module.
Delta: set current reduced to In x 1/3
In supply cable: set current Ie = In (rated current of the motor)
Table 4-10: Star-delta starter settings
Motor Control
SIMOCODE pro
4-28 GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
4.2.8 Star-delta starters with reversal of the direction of rotation
Description
With this control function, a motor can be started in both directions of rota-
tion in star-delta operation.
Control commands
Clockwise rotation: start with ON> first activates the QE1 (star contactor)
contactor control and then immediately activates the QE3 contactor control
(network contactor, clockwise rotation)
Counter-clockwise rotation: start with ON< first activates the QE1 (star con-
tactor) contactor activation and then immediately activates the QE4 contactor
control QE4 (network contactor, counter-clockwise rotation)
Stop with OFF deactivates the QE1, QE2, QE3 and QE4 contactor con-
trols.
The control commands can be issued from arbitrary control stations
to SIMOCODE pro (see also the description of control stations). The
inputs (plugs) must be connected to the corresponding sockets, preferably
to the Enabled control command sockets.
Every fault signal causes the QE1, QE2 QE3 and QE4 contactor controls to
be deactivated.
Switching from star to delta
For this, SIMOCODE pro first deactivates the QE1 contactor control before
connecting the QE2 contactor control (delta contactor).
SIMOCODE pro switches from star to delta:
current-dependent, for decreasing current below the level (I < 90% Ie).
time-dependent to the set time parameter Maximum time for star opera-
tion when the current in the star operation does not sink below this level.
Switching the direction of rotation
It is possible to change the direction of rotation
via the OFF control command
directly, when the Save switching command is activated
if the signal Feedback ON is no longer issued (motor is switched off) AND
after the interlocking time has expired.
SIMOCODE pro prevents both the contactors from switching on at the
same time.
Switching from one direction of rotation to the other can be delayed via the
interlocking time.
Start-up is always in star mode.
Motor Control
SIMOCODE pro
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 4-29
Notes
It is recommended to wire the QE1 and QE2 contactor controls to the relay
outputs of the basic unit. You need at least 1 digital module for this control
function.
Attention
If you use the internal earth-fault detection for a star-delta connection,
false trippings might occur.
For delta operation, the summation current is non-zero due to harmonics.
Attention
If the current measurement module is switched to delta (normal case), a
current which is 1/3 times smaller must be set for the star-delta starter
control function.
Example: In = 100 A Ie = In x 1/3
Ie = 100 A x 1/3 = 57.7 A
Current to be set Ie = 57.7 A
Switching interval
The switching time from star to delta can be extended by the switching
interval.
Reason: for motors with a high ratio between starting current and rated cur-
rent, the mains voltage plus motor EMF might lead to a very high delta star-
ting current, if the switching interval is too short. The motor EMF decreases
if the interval is longer.
Motor Control
SIMOCODE pro
4-30 GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
Star-delta starter with reversal of the direction of rotation
Figure 4-11: Star-delta starter schematic, with reversal of the direction of rotation
Displays
QLA
QLE>
(ON>)
(OFF)
QLE<
(ON<)
Control commands
Aux. control inputs
Contactor controls
Status -
QE1
QE2
F ON*
QLS
OFF
ON>
OFF
ON>
(Fault)
QE3
ON<
Contactors/controlling
Feedback time
Execution time
Non-maintained
Load type
Switching interval
Maximum time for
star operation
Transformer
mounted
Save switching

command
Interlocking time
*Feedback ON
QE4
ON<
Star-delta starter with
reversal of the
Motor protection
Star contactor
Delta contactor
Right - network contactor
Left - network contactor
Switching interval
active
Interlocking time
active
command mode
direction of rotation
Motor Control
SIMOCODE pro
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 4-31
Settings
You will find detailed information about the settings in chapter "General set-
tings and definitions" on page 4-13.
Star-delta starter Description
OFF OFF control command
(connection with arbitrary socket ,
usually with Enabled control command - OFF socket)
ON> ON> control command
(connection with arbitrary socket ,
usually with Enabled control command - ON> socket)
ON< ON< control command
(connection with arbitrary socket ,
usually with Enabled control command - ON< socket)
F ON Auxiliary control input Feedback ON (connection with arbitrary
socket , usually with Status - current is flowing socket)
Non-maintained
command mode
Deactivated (presetting)
Activated
Save switching
command
Deactivated (presetting)
Activated
Load type You can choose between
motor
resistive load
Feedback time Range: 0 to 25.5 seconds
Execution time Range 0 to 6553.5 seconds
Switching interval Range 0 to 6553.5 seconds
Interlocking time Range 0 to 255 seconds
Maximum time for
star operation
Time-dependent switching from star to delta.
Range 0 to 255 seconds
Transformer moun-
ted
The set current and the switching levels for the star-delta switching
depend on the mounting position of the current transformer/ cur-
rent measurement module.
Delta: set current reduced to In x 1/3
In supply cable: set current Ie = In (rated current of the motor)
Table 4-11: Star-delta starter settings, with reversal of the direction of rotation
Motor Control
SIMOCODE pro
4-32 GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
4.2.9 Dahlander
Description
With this function, SIMOCODE pro can control motors with only one stator
winding at two speeds (fast and slow). SIMOCODE pro wires the stator
winding via the contactors so that there is a high pole number at low speed
and a low pole number at high speed.
Control commands
Slow: start with ON> first activates the QE2 contactor control (slow)
Fast: start with ON>> first activates the QE3 contactor control (star contac-
tor, fast) and then immediately activates the QE1 contactor control (network
contactor, fast)
Stop with OFF deactivates the QE1, QE2 and QE3 contactor controls.
The control commands can be issued from arbitrary control stations
to SIMOCODE pro (see also the description of control stations). The
inputs (plugs) must be connected to the corresponding sockets, preferably
to the Enabled control command sockets.
Every fault signal causes the QE1, QE2 and QE3 contactor controls to be
deactivated.
Switching the speed
It is possible to switch the speed
via the OFF control command
directly, when the Save switching command is activated
when the signal Feedback ON is no longer issued (motor was switched off)
AND when changing from fast = > slow after the switching interval has
expired.
SIMOCODE pro prevents the contactors for the fast speed from being
switched on at the same time as the contactor for the slow speed.
Switching interval
The switching interval parameter can be used to delay switching from
fast to slow to give the motor enough time to run down.
Motor Control
SIMOCODE pro
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 4-33
Note
Attention
Two set currents must be set for the Dahlander circuit:
Ie1 for the slower speed
Ie1 for the faster speed
Depending on the current range, the current can be directly measured at
both speeds with a single current converter. Otherwise, you will need -
according to the corresponding speed - two external current converters (e.g.
3UF18 with 1A secondary transformer rated current), whose secondary
cables must lead through the current measurement module with the range
0.3 - 3A. The Ie1/Ie2 set currents must be converted according to the secon-
dary currents of the external transformers.
Dahlander schematic
Figure 4-12: Dahlander control function schematic
Control commands
Aux. control inputs
Contactor controls
Displays
Status -
QE1
QE2
F ON*
QLA
QLE>
QLS
OFF
ON>
OFF
ON>
(ON>)
(OFF)
(Fault)
QE3
*Feedback ON
ON>>
ON>>
QLE>
(ON>>)
Contactors/controlling
Feedback time
Execution time
Non-maintained
Load type
Switching interval
Save switching

command
Dahlander
Motor protection
Switching interval
active
Fast
Slow
Fast - star contactor
command mode
Motor Control
SIMOCODE pro
4-34 GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
Settings
You will find detailed information about the settings in chapter "General set-
tings and definitions" on page 4-13.
Dahlander Description
OFF OFF control command
(connection with arbitrary socket ,
usually with Enabled control command - OFF socket)
ON> ON> control command (slow)
(connection with arbitrary socket ,
usually with Enabled control command - ON> socket)
ON>> ON>> control command (fast)
(connection with arbitrary socket ,
usually with Enabled control command - ON>> socket)
F ON Auxiliary control input Feedback ON (connection with arbitrary
socket , usually with Status - current is flowing socket)
Non-maintained
command mode
Deactivated (presetting)
Activated
Save switching
command
Deactivated (presetting)
Activated
Load type You can choose between
motor
resistive load
Feedback time Range: 0 to 25.5 seconds
Execution time Range: 0 to 6553.5 seconds
Switching interval Range: 0 to 6553.5 seconds
Table 4-12: Dahlander settings
Motor Control
SIMOCODE pro
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 4-35
4.2.10 Dahlander with reversal of the direction of rotation
Description
This control function is used to change the direction of rotation of a motor at
both speeds.
Control commands
Right - slow: start with ON> first activates QE2 the contactor control (right-
slow).
Right - fast: start with ON>> first activates the QE3 contactor control (fast-
star contactor) and then immediately activates the QE1 contactor control
(right-fast)
Left - slow: start with ON< activates the QE4 contactor control (left-slow)
Left - fast: start with ON<< activates the QE3 contactor control (fast-star
contactor) and then immediately activates the QE5 contactor control (left-
fast)
Stop with OFF deactivates the contactor controls.
The control commands can be issued from arbitrary control stations
to SIMOCODE pro (see also the description of control stations). The
inputs (plugs) must be connected to the corresponding sockets, preferably
to the Enabled control command sockets
It does not matter in what order the control commands are given.
Every fault signal causes the contactor controls to be deactivated.
Switching the direction of rotation
It is possible to switch the direction of rotation
via the OFF control command
directly, when the parameter Save switching command is activated
if the signal Feedback ON is no longer issued (motor was switched off)
AND after the interlocking time has expired.
SIMOCODE prevents both contactors from switching on at the same time.
Switching from one direction of rotation to the other can be delayed via the
interlocking time.
Switching the speed
It is possible to switch the speed
via the OFF control command
directly when the Save switching command is activated
when the signal Feedback ON is no longer issued (motor was switched off)
AND when changing from fast = > slow after the switching interval has
expired.
Motor Control
SIMOCODE pro
4-36 GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
Switching interval
The switching interval parameter is used to delay switching from fast
to slow to give the motor enough time to run down.
Notes
You need at least 1 digital module for this control function. This control
function cannot be implemented with bistable relay outputs.
Schematic Dahlander with reversal of the direction of rotation
Figure 4-13: Dahlander with reversal of the direction of rotation
Control commands
Displays
Status -
QE1
QE2
F ON*
QLA
QLE>
QLS
OFF
ON>
(ON>)
(OFF)
(Fault)
QE3
ON<
*Feedback ON
QLE<
(ON<)
QE4
Contactor controls
QE5
QLE<<
(ON<<)
QLE>
(ON>>)
OFF
ON>
ON<
ON<<
ON>>
ON>>
ON<<
Contactors/controlling
Feedback time
Execution time
Non-maintained
Load type
Switching interval
Save switching
command
Interlocking time
Aux. control inputs
Dahlander with
reversal of the
Motor protection
Right - fast
Right - slow
Fast - star contactor
Left - slow
Left - fast
Switching interval
active
Interlocking time
active
command mode

direction of rotation
Motor Control
SIMOCODE pro
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 4-37
Settings
You will find detailed information about the settings in chapter "General set-
tings and definitions" on page 4-13.
Dahlander with
reversal of the
direction of
rotation
Description
ON<< ON<< control command (left, fast)
(connection with arbitrary socket ,
usually with Enabled control command - ON<< socket)
ON< ON< control command (left, slow)
(connection with arbitrary socket ,
usually with Enabled control command - ON< socket)
OFF OFF control command
(connection with optional socket ,
optionally with socket Enabled control command - OFF)
ON> ON> control command (left, slow)
(connection with arbitrary socket ,
usually with Enabled control command - ON> socket)
ON>> ON>> control command (right, fast)
(connection with arbitrary socket ,
usually with Enabled control command - ON>> socket)
F ON Auxiliary control input Feedback ON (connection with arbitrary
socket , usually with Status - current is flowing socket)
Non-maintained
command mode
Deactivated (presetting)
Activated
Save switching
command
Deactivated (presetting)
Activated
Load type You can choose between
motor
resistive load
Feedback time Range: 0 to 25.5 seconds
Execution time Range: 0 to 6553.5 seconds
Interlocking time Range: 0 to 255 seconds
Switching interval Range: 0 to 6553.5 seconds
Table 4-13: Dahlander control function settings with reversal of the direction of rotation
Motor Control
SIMOCODE pro
4-38 GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
4.2.11 Pole-changing switches
Description
With this function, SIMOCODE pro can control motors with two stator win-
dings in two speed levels (fast and slow).
Control commands
Slow: start with ON> activates the QE2 contactor control (slow).
Fast: start with ON>> activates the QE1 contactor control (fast).
Stop with OFF deactivates the contactor controls.
The control commands can be issued from arbitrary control stations
to SIMOCODE pro (see also the description of control stations). The
inputs (plugs) must be connected to the corresponding sockets, preferably
to the Enabled control command sockets
It does not matter in what order the control commands are given.
Every fault signal causes the contactor controls to be deactivated.
Switching the speed
It is possible to switch the speed when the "Feedback ON" signal is no lon-
ger issued (motor is switched off) AND when changing from "fast" -> "slow"
after the switching interval has expired:
via the OFF control command
directly, when the Save switching command is activated.
Switching interval
The switching interval parameter can be used to delay switching from
fast to slow to give the motor enough time to run down.
Motor Control
SIMOCODE pro
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 4-39
Note
Attention
Two set currents have to be set for the pole-changing switch:
Ie1 for the slower speed
Ie1 for the faster speed
Depending on the current range, the current can be directly measured at
both speeds with a single current converter. Otherwise, you will need -
according to the corresponding speed - two external current converters (e.g.
3UF18 with 1A secondary transformer rated current), whose secondary
cables must lead through the current measurement module with the range
0.3 - 3A. The Ie1/Ie2 set currents must be converted according to the secon-
dary currents of the external transformers.
Pole-changing switches schematic
Figure 4-14: Pole-changing switch control function
Control commands
Aux. control inputs
Contactor controls
Displays
Status
QE1
QE2
F ON*
QLA
QLE>
QLS
OFF
ON>
OFF
ON>
(ON>)
(OFF)
(Fault)
*Feedback ON
ON>>
ON>>
QLE>>
(ON>>)
Contactors/controlling
Feedback time
Execution time
Non-maintained
Load type
Switching interval
Save switching
command
Pole-changing switches
Motor protection
Switching interval
active
Fast
Slow
command code
Motor Control
SIMOCODE pro
4-40 GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
Settings
You will find detailed information about the settings in chapter "General set-
tings and definitions" on page 4-13.
Pole-changing
switches
Description
OFF OFF control command
(connection with arbitrary socket ,
usually with Enabled control command - OFF socket)
ON> ON> control command (slow)
(connection with arbitrary socket ,
usually with Enabled control command - ON> socket)
ON>> ON>> control command (fast)
(connection with arbitrary socket ,
usually with Enabled control command - ON>> socket)
F ON Auxiliary control input Feedback ON (connection with arbitrary
socket , usually with Status - current is flowing socket)
Non-maintained
command mode
Deactivated (presetting)
Activated
Save switching
command
Deactivated (presetting)
Activated
Load type You can choose between
motor
resistive load
Feedback time Range 0 to 25.5 seconds
Execution time Range 0 to 6553.5 seconds
Switching interval Range 0 to 6553.5 seconds
Table 4-14: Pole-changing switch settings
Motor Control
SIMOCODE pro
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 4-41
4.2.12 Pole-changing switch with reversal of the direction of rotation
Description
This control function is used to change the direction of rotation of a motor at
both speeds.
Control commands
Right - slow: start with ON> activates the QE2 contactor control (right-slow)
Right - fast: start with ON>> activates the QE1 contactor activation (right-
fast)
Left - slow: start with ON< activates the QE4 contactor control (left-slow)
Left - fast: start with ON<< activates the QE5 contactor control (left-fast)
Stop with OFF deactivates the contactor controls
The control commands can be issued from arbitrary control stations
to SIMOCODE pro. The inputs (plugs) must be connected to the correspon-
ding sockets, preferably to the Enabled control command sockets.
It does not matter in what order the control commands are given.
Every fault signal causes the contactor controls to be deactivated.
Switching the direction of rotation
It is possible to switch the direction of rotation
via the OFF control command
directly, when the parameter Save switching command is activated
if the signal Feedback ON is no longer issued (motor was switched OFF)
AND after the interlocking time has expired.
SIMOCODE pro prevents both contactors from switching on at the same
time.
Switching from one direction of rotation to the other can be delayed via the
interlocking time.
Switching the speed
It is possible to switch
via the OFF control command
directly when the Save switching command is activated
when the signal Feedback ON is no longer issued (motor was switched off)
AND when changing from fast to slow after the switching interval has
expired.
Switching interval
SIMOCODE pro prevents the contactors for the speeds fast and slow
from switching on at the same time. The switching interval parameter is
used to delay switching from fast to slow to give the motor enough
time to run down.
Motor Control
SIMOCODE pro
4-42 GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
Notes
At least one additional digital module is necessary for this control function.
Attention
Two set currents are to be set with the pole-changing switch:
Ie1 for the slower speed
Ie1 for the faster speed
Depending on the current range, the current can be directly measured at
both speeds with a single current converter. Otherwise you will need -
according to the corresponding speed - two external current converters (e.g.
3UF18 with 1A secondary transformer rated current), whose secondary
cables must lead through the current measurement module with the range
0.3 - 3A. The Ie1/ Ie2 set currents must be converted according to the
secondary currents of the external transformers
Schamatic: Pole-changing switch with reversal of the direction of rotation
Figure 4-15: Pole-changing switch with reversal of the direction of rotation
Control commands
Displays
Status
QE1
QE2
F ON*
QLA
QLE>
QLS
OFF
ON>
(ON>)
(OFF)
(Fault)
ON<
*Feedback ON
QLE<
(ON<)
QE4
Contactor controls
QE5
QLE<<
(ON<<)
QLE>>
(ON>>)
OFF
ON>
ON<
ON<<
ON>>
ON>>
ON<<
Contactors/controlling
Feedback time
Execution time
Non-maintained
Load type
Switching interval
Save switching
command
Interlocking time
Pole-changing switch with
reversal of the
Motor protection
Right - fast
Right - slow
Left - slow
Left - fast
Switching interval
active
Interlocking time
active
direction of rotation
command mode
Motor Control
SIMOCODE pro
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 4-43
Settings
You will find detailed information about the settings in chapter "General set-
tings and definitions" on page 4-13.
Dahlander with
reversal of the
direction of
rotation
Description
ON<< ON<< control command (left, fast)
(connection with arbitrary socket ,
usually with Enabled control command - ON<< socket)
ON< ON< control command (left, slow)
(connection with arbitrary socket ,
usually with Enabled control command - ON< socket)
OFF OFF control command
(connection with arbitrary socket ,
usually with Enabled control command - OFF socket)
ON> ON> control command (right, slow)
(connection with arbitrary socket ,
usually with Enabled control command - ON> socket)
ON>> ON>> control command (right, fast)
(connection with arbitrary socket ,
usually with Enabled control command - ON>> socket)
Feedback ON Auxiliary control input Feedback ON (connection with arbitrary
socket , usually with Status - current is flowing socket)
Non-maintained
command mode
Deactivated (presetting)
Activated
Save switching
command
Deactivated (presetting)
Activated
Load type You can choose between
motor
resistive load
Feedback time Range 0 to 25.5 seconds
Execution time Range 0 to 6553.5 seconds
Interlocking time Range 0 to 255 seconds
Switching interval Range 0 to 6553.5 seconds
Table 4-15: Settings for pole-changing switches with reversal of the direction of rotation
Motor Control
SIMOCODE pro
4-44 GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
4.2.13 Valve
Description
With this control function, SIMOCODE pro can activate a solenoid valve.
With the control commands OPEN and CLOSE, the valve is brought into
the corresponding end position. SIMOCODE must be informed via corre-
sponding limit switches (OPEN, CLOSE) when the end position has been
reached.
Control commands
Open: start with ON> activates the QE1 internal contactor control.
Close: stop with OFF deactivates the QE1 internal contactor control.
The control commands can be issued from arbitrary control stations
to SIMOCODE pro (see also the description of control stations). The
inputs (plugs) must be connected to the corresponding sockets, preferably
to the Enabled control command sockets.
Every fault signal causes the QE1 contactor control to be deactivated and
puts the valve into the close position.
Notes
Attention
The motor protection functions are not active. A current measurement
module is not necessary.
Attention
If both end position switches respond at the same time (FO=1 and FC=1),
the valve is immediately switched OFF via the fault message Fault - double
1 (=close)
If the end position feedback does not correspond to the control command,
the valve is switched off with the fault message Fault - end position fault
(=close)
Motor Control
SIMOCODE pro
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 4-45
Valve schematic
Figure 4-16: Control function valve schematic
Settings
You will find detailed information about the settings in chapter "General set-
tings and definitions" on page 4-13.
Direct starters Description
OFF OFF control command (close)
(connection with arbitrary socket ,
usually with Enabled control command - OFF socket)
ON> ON control command (open)
(connection with arbitrary socket ,
usually with Enabled control command - ON> socket)
Non-maintained
command mode
Deactivated (presetting)
Activated
Execution time Time until the end position is reached.
Range: 0 to 6553.5 seconds
Table 4-16: Valve control function settings
Control commands
Aux. control inputs *
Contactor controls
Displays
Status
QE1
QLA
QLE>
QLS
OFF
ON>
(OPEN)
(CLOSE)
(Fault)
OFF
ON>
FC
FO
Contactors/controlling
Execution time
* Abbreviations
FC Feedback CLOSE
FO Feedback OPEN
Non-maintained
Valve
OPEN
FC
FO
command mode
Motor Control
SIMOCODE pro
4-46 GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
4.2.14 Slider
Description
SIMOCODE can control sliders/actuators with this control function. The
slider is moved into the corresponding end position with the OPEN and
CLOSE control commands and is deactivated via its end position switches
(1-active) or torque switch (0-active).
SIMOCODE pro must be informed about the response of the end position
switches/ torque switches via its inputs.
Control commands
Open: start with ON > activates the QE1 contactor control until End posi-
tion OPEN (feedback open) is reached.
Close: start with ON < activates the QE2 contactor control until End posi-
tion CLOSE (feedback close) is reached.
Stop with OFF deactivates the contactor controls.
The drive remains stopped in that position.
The control commands can be issued from arbitrary control stations
to SIMOCODE (see also the description of control stations). The inputs
(plugs) must be connected to the corresponding sockets, preferably to the
Enabled control command sockets.
Function schematic
Figure 4-17: Function schematic of the torque switch and the end position switch when controlling
sliders

Torque switch OPEN
Torque switch
TC
Motor shaft with springs
at the beginning
FO
FC
End position switch
Slider
Gear
OPEN CLOSE
OPEN CLOSE
and end
Motor Control
SIMOCODE pro
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 4-47
Switching the direction of travel
It is possible to switch the direction of travel
via the OFF control command
if the signal Feedback ON is no longer issued (motor was switched off)
AND after the interlocking time has expired.
SIMOCODE pro prevents both contactors switching on at the same time.
Switching from one direction of rotation to the other can be delayed via the
interlocking time.
Notes
Attention
The corresponding torque switch must not respond before the associated
end position switch when the torque switch (TO)/(TC) is connected.
In this case, the slider is switched off immediately with the fault message
Fault - blocked slider.
If both end position switches respond at the same time (FO=1 and FC=1),
the slider is immediately switched off via the fault message Fault - double
1 (=close)
If both torque switches respond at the same time (TO=0 and TC=0), the
slider is switched off immediately with the fault message Fault - double 0.
If the end position feedback does not correspond to the control command,
the slider is switched off with the fault message Fault - end position fault.
Motor Control
SIMOCODE pro
4-48 GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
Slider schematic
Figure 4-18: Slider schematic
Control commands Contactor controls
Displays
Status -
QE1
QE2
QLE<
QLA
QLE>
QLS
ON<
OFF
ON>
ON<
OFF
ON>
OPEN
Stop
(Fault)
CLOSE
* Abbreviations
Feed-
back ON
Feedback ON
FC Feedback CLOSE
FO Feedback OPEN
TC Torque CLOSE
TO Torque OPEN
Aux. control inputs *
Feedback ON
FC
FO
TC
TO
OPEN
CLOSE
OPEN
Stop
CLOSE
Protecting/controlling
Feedback time
Execution time
Interlocking time
Non-maintained
Load type
Slider
Motor protection
Interlocking time
active
Closes
Opens
FC
FO
TC
TO
command mode
Motor Control
SIMOCODE pro
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 4-49
Variants for slide control
The following table shows the 5 variants for slide control:

Table 4-17: Variants for slide control
Notes
Attention
The signals of the torque switches and the position switches must be wired
to the inputs of the basic units. Torque switches must be O-active, whereas
the position switches must be 1-active.
Variant
Switch off
TC
Torque
CLOSE
FC
End position
CLOSE
FO
End position
OPEN
TO
Torque OPEN
Slider 1
After reaching the end position FO
(OPEN) or FC (CLOSE).
X X
Slider 2
After reaching the end position FO
(OPEN) or FC (CLOSE) AND
response of the associated torque
switch TO (OPEN) or TC (CLOSE)
X X X X
Slider 3
After reaching the end position FO
(open). After reaching the end posi-
tion 'CLOSE', the respective torque
switch TC must respond after the
end position switch FC has respon-
ded.
X X X
Slider 4
After reaching the end position FC
(CLOSE). After reaching the end
position FO (OPEN), the respective
torque switch TO must also
respond after the end position
switch FO has responded.
X X X
Slider 5
After reaching the end position or the
torque. The actuator is either monito-
red by the end position switches or
by the torque switches. The swit-
ches are implemented as changeo-
ver contacts and are checked for
antivalence. In the case of non-anti-
valent feedback (e.g. FC=0 and
TC=0), SIMOCODE recognizes a
wire break and deactivates the slider
with the fault message Fault - anti-
valence
Antivalent active Antivalent active
CLOSE OPEN
Motor Control
SIMOCODE pro
4-50 GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
Settings
You will find detailed information about the settings in chapter "General set-
tings and definitions" on page 4-13.
Dahlander with
reversal of the
direction of
rotation
Description
ON< ON< control command (close)
(connection with arbitrary socket ,
usually with Enabled control command - ON< socket)
OFF Control command stop
(connection with arbitrary socket ,
usually with Enabled control command - OFF socket)
ON> ON> control command (open)
(connection with arbitrary socket ,
usually with Enabled control command - ON> socket)
F ON Auxiliary control input Feedback ON (connection with arbitrary
socket , usually with Status - current is flowing socket)
FC Auxiliary control input Feedback CLOSE (connection with arbi-
trary socket , usually with the socket of an input which the end
position switch is wired to)
FO Auxiliary control input Feedback OPEN (connection with arbitrary
socket , usually with the socket of an input which the limit
switch is wired to)
TC Auxiliary control input Torque CLOSE (connection with arbitrary
socket , usually with the socket of an input which the torque
switch is wired to)
TO Auxiliary control input Torque CLOSE (connection with arbitrary
socket , usually with the socket of an input which the torque
switch is wired to)
Non-maintained
command mode
Deactivated (presetting)
Activated
Load type You can choose between
motor
resistive load
Feedback time Range: 0 to 25.5 seconds
Execution time Time until the limit position is reached.
range: 0 to 6553.5 seconds
Interlocking time Range: 0 to 255 seconds
Table 4-18: Control function slider settings
Motor Control
SIMOCODE pro
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 4-51
4.2.15 Soft starters
Description
With this control function, SIMOCODE pro can activate the 3RW soft star-
ter. Thus, the 3RW soft starters are connected to the PROFIBUS DP via
SIMOCODE pro.
Control commands
Start with ON > activates the QE1 and QE4 internal contactor controls.
Stop with OFF first deactivates the QE4 contactor control. When the signal
Feedback ON is no longer issued, the QE1 contactor control is deactivated
3 s later in order to facilitate a smooth run down via the soft starter.
With reset, the QE3 contactor control is activated for 20 ms and then sends
the soft starter an acknowledgement signal via a parameterizable relay out-
put.
The control commands can be issued from arbitrary control stations
to SIMOCODE pro (see also the description of control stations). The
inputs (plugs) must be connected to the corresponding sockets, preferably
to the Enabled control command sockets.
Every fault signal causes the contactor controls to be deactivated.
Making internal assignments
You have to make the following assignments:
1. Assign the QE1 contactor control to the relay output that activates the coil of
the network contactor
2. Assign the QE4 contactor control to an arbitrary relay output with which the
ON input from the soft starter is to be activated
3. Assign the QE3 contactor control to the relay output which gives the acknow-
ledgement signal of 20 ms to the soft starter
4. Assign the ON> and OFF control commands to the enabled control com-
mands
5. Assign the input of SIMOCODE pro that is connected to the signaling output
fault of the soft starter to the input of the standard function module exter-
nal fault 1.
6. The signal End of start-up of the soft starter can also be wired to one of the
outputs and processed by SIMOCODE.
Note
Attention
In order to avoid disconnections due to faults, the Execution time parame-
ter in SIMOCODE pro must be set at least to the smooth running down time
of the soft starter.
Motor Control
SIMOCODE pro
4-52 GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
Soft starter schematic
Figure 4-19: Soft starter schematic
Settings
You will find detailed information about the settings in chapter "General set-
tings and definitions" on page 4-13.
Circuit breakers Description
OFF OFF control command
(connection with arbitrary socket ,
usually with Enabled control command - OFF socket)
ON> ON control command
(connection with arbitrary socket ,
usually with Enabled control command - ON> socket)
Feedback ON Auxiliary control input Feedback ON
(connection with arbitrary socket , usually with Status - current
is flowing socket)
Non-maintained
command mode
Deactivated (presetting)
Activated
Load type You can choose between
motor
resistive load
Feedback time Range 0 to 25.5 seconds
Execution time At least > smooth running down time.
range 0 to 6553.5 seconds
Table 4-19: Soft starter settings
Control commands
Aux. control inputs
Contactor controls
Status
QE1
F ON*
QLA
QLE>
QLS
OFF
ON>
OFF
ON>
Protecting/controlling
Feedback time
Execution time
Non-maintained
Load type
(ON>)
(OFF)
(Fault)
*Feedback ON
QE3
Displays
20 ms.
QE4
ON
Soft starter
Motor protection
Network contactor
command mode
Motor Control
SIMOCODE pro
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 4-53
4.2.16 Soft reversing starter
Description
With this control function, SIMOCODE pro can activate the 3RW soft star-
ter. Thus, the 3RW soft starters are connected to the PROFIBUS DP via
SIMOCODE pro. With this control function, SIMOCODE pro can control the
motor direction of rotation (forwards and backwards).
Control commands
Start with ON > activates QE1 and QE4 contactor control (clockwise, i.e.
forwards)
Start with ON < activates QE2 and QE4 contactor control (counter-clock-
wise i.e. backwards)
Stop with OFF first deactivates the QE4 contactor control. When the
Feedback ON signal is no longer issued, the QE1 / QE4 contactor control is
deactivated 3 s later in order to facilitate a smooth run down via the soft star-
ter.
With reset, the QE3 contactor control is activated for 20 ms and sends the
soft starter an acknowledgement signal via a parameterizable relay output.
The control commands can be issued from arbitrary control stations
to SIMOCODE pro (see also the description of control stations). Thus, the
inputs (plugs) must be connected to the corresponding sockets, preferably
to the Enabled control command sockets.
Every fault signal causes the contactor activations to be deactivated.
Switching the direction of rotation
It is possible to switching the direction of rotation
via the OFF control command
directly, when the Save switching command parameter is activated
if the Status - ON> or Status - ON< signal is no longer issued (motor was
switched OFF) AND after the interlocking time has expired.
SIMOCODE pro prevents both contactors from switching on at the same
time. Switching from one direction of rotation to the other can be delayed
via the interlocking time.
Motor Control
SIMOCODE pro
4-54 GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
Making internal assignments
You have to make the following assignments:
1. Assign the QE1 contactor control to the relay output that activates the coil of
the network contactor (right)
2. Assign the QE2 contactor control to the relay output that activates the coil of
the network contactor (left)
3. Assign the QE4 contactor control to an optional relay output with which the
ON input from the soft starter must be activated
4. Assign the QE3 contactor control to the relay output which gives the acknow-
ledgement signal of 20 ms to the soft starter
5. Assign the ON>, ON< and OFF control commands to the enabled con-
trol commands
6. Assign the input of SIMOCODE pro which is connected to the signaling out-
put Fault of the soft starter to the input of the standard function module
External fault 1.
7. The Start-up end signal of the soft starter can also be wired to one of the
outputs and processed by SIMOCODE pro.
Note
An additional digital module may be necessary for this control function.
Soft reversing starter schematic
Figure 4-20: Soft reversing starter schematic
Control commands
Feedbacks
Contactor controls
Displays
Status -
QE2
F ON*
QLE<
QLA
QLE>
QLS
ON<
OFF
ON>
ON<
OFF
ON>
Protecting/controlling
Feedback time
Execution time
Interlocking time
Non-maintained
Save switching
Load type
command
(ON>)
(OFF)
(Fault)
(ON<)
*Feedback ON
QE1
QE3
QE4
Right
Left
Soft reversing starter
Motor protection
20 ms.
ON
Interlocking time
active
command mode
Motor Control
SIMOCODE pro
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 4-55
Settings
You will find detailed information about the settings in chapter "General set-
tings and definitions" on page 4-13.
Reversing starter Description
ON< ON< control command, counter-clockwise rotation
(connection with arbitrary socket ,
usually with Enabled control command - ON< socket)
OFF OFF control command
(connection with arbitrary socket ,
usually with Enabled control command - OFF socket)
ON> ON> control command, clockwise rotation
(connection with arbitrary socket ,
usually with Enabled control command - ON> socket)
Feedback ON Auxiliary control input Feedback ON (connection with arbitrary
socket , usually with Status - current is flowing socket)
Non-maintained
command mode
Deactivated (presetting)
Activated
Save switching
command
Deactivated (presetting)
Activated
Load type You can choose between
motor
resistive load
Feedback time Range 0 to 25.5 seconds
Execution time At least > smooth running down time.
Range 0 to 6553.5 seconds
Interlocking time Range 0 to 255 seconds
Table 4-20: Soft reversing starter settings
Motor Control
SIMOCODE pro
4-56 GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
4.3 Active control stations, contactor & lamp controls and
status signal of the control functions
Table 4-21: Active control stations, contactor & lamp controls and status signal
of the control functions
1
)

B
a
s
i
c

u
n
i
t

1
,

S
I
M
O
C
O
D
E
p
r
o
C
2
)

B
a
s
i
c

u
n
i
t

2
,

S
I
M
O
C
O
D
E
p
r
o
V
S
p
e
c
i
f
i
c
a
t
i
o
n
/
C
o
n
t
r
o
l

f
u
n
c
t
i
o
n
C
o
n
t
r
o
l

s
t
a
t
i
o
n
C
o
n
t
a
c
t
o
r

c
o
n
t
r
o
l
L
a
m
p

c
o
n
t
r
o
l
Q
L
E
<
<
(
O
N
<
<
)
Q
L
E
<
(
O
N
<
)
Q
L
A
(
O
F
F
)
Q
L
E
>
(
O
N
>
)
Q
L
E
>
>
(
O
N
>
>
)
S
t
a
t
u
s

s
i
g
n
a
l
O
N
<
<
O
N
<
O
F
F
O
N
>
O
N
>
>
Q
E
1
Q
E
2
Q
E
3
Q
E
4
Q
E
5
O
N
<
<
O
N
<
O
F
F
O
N
>
O
N
>
>
O
v
e
r
l
o
a
d

1
)
,
2
)
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
A
c
t
i
v
e
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
D
i
r
e
c
t

s
t
a
r
t
e
r

1
)
,
2
)
-
-
O
F
F
O
N
-
O
N
-
-
-
-
-
O
F
F
O
N
-
R
e
v
e
r
s
i
n
g

s
t
a
r
t
e
r

1
)
,
2
)
-
L
e
f
t
O
F
F
R
i
g
h
t
-
R
i
g
h
t
L
e
f
t
-
-
-
L
e
f
t
O
F
F
R
i
g
h
t
-
C
i
r
c
u
i
t

b
r
e
a
k
e
r

1
)
,
2
)
-
-
O
F
F
O
N
-
O
N
i
m
p
u
l
s
e
O
F
F
i
m
p
u
l
s
e
-
-
-
-
-
O
F
F
O
N
-
S
t
a
r
-
d
e
l
t
a

s
t
a
r
t
e
r

2
)
-
-
O
F
F
O
N
-
S
t
a
r
c
o
n
t
a
c
t
o
r
D
e
l
t
a
c
o
n
t
a
c
t
o
r
N
e
t
w
o
r
k
c
o
n
t
a
c
t
o
r
-
-
-
-
O
F
F
O
N
-
S
t
a
r
-
d
e
l
t
a

s
t
a
r
t
e
r
w
i
t
h

r
e
v
e
r
s
a
l

o
f

t
h
e

d
i
r
e
c
t
i
o
n

o
f

r
o
t
a
t
i
o
n

2
)
L
e
f
t
O
F
F
R
i
g
h
t
-
S
t
a
r
c
o
n
t
a
c
t
o
r
D
e
l
t
a
c
o
n
t
a
c
t
o
r
R
i
g
h
t
n
e
t
w
o
r
k
c
o
n
t
a
c
t
o
r
L
e
f
t
n
e
t
w
o
r
k
c
o
n
t
a
c
t
o
r
-
L
e
f
t
O
F
F
R
i
g
h
t
-
D
a
h
l
a
n
d
e
r

2
)
-
-
O
F
F
S
l
o
w
F
a
s
t
F
a
s
t
S
l
o
w
F
a
s
t
s
t
a
r
c
o
n
t
a
c
t
o
r
-
-
-
-
O
F
F
S
l
o
w
F
a
s
t
D
a
h
l
a
n
d
e
r
w
i
t
h

r
e
v
e
r
s
a
l

o
f

t
h
e

d
i
r
e
c
t
i
o
n

o
f

r
o
t
a
t
i
o
n

2
)
L
e
f
t
f
a
s
t
L
e
f
t
s
l
o
w
O
F
F
R
i
g
h
t
s
l
o
w
R
i
g
h
t
f
a
s
t
R
i
g
h
t
f
a
s
t
R
i
g
h
t
s
l
o
w
F
a
s
t
s
t
a
r
c
o
n
t
a
c
t
o
r
L
e
f
t
s
l
o
w
L
e
f
t
f
a
s
t
L
e
f
t
f
a
s
t
L
e
f
t
s
l
o
w
O
F
F
R
i
g
h
t
s
l
o
w
R
i
g
h
t
f
a
s
t
P
o
l
e

c
h
a
n
g
i
n
g

s
w
i
t
c
h

2
)
-
-
O
F
F
S
l
o
w
F
a
s
t
F
a
s
t
S
l
o
w
-
-
-
-
-
O
F
F
S
l
o
w
F
a
s
t
P
o
l
e

c
h
a
n
g
i
n
g

s
w
i
t
c
h
w
i
t
h

r
e
v
e
r
s
i
n
g

t
h
e

d
i
r
e
c
t
i
o
n

o
f

r
o
t
a
t
i
o
n

2
)
L
e
f
t
f
a
s
t
L
e
f
t
s
l
o
w
O
F
F
R
i
g
h
t
s
l
o
w
R
i
g
h
t
f
a
s
t
R
i
g
h
t
f
a
s
t
R
i
g
h
t
s
l
o
w
-
L
e
f
t
s
l
o
w
L
e
f
t
f
a
s
t
L
e
f
t
f
a
s
t
L
e
f
t
s
l
o
w
O
F
F
R
i
g
h
t
s
l
o
w
R
i
g
h
t
f
a
s
t
V
a
l
v
e

2
)
-
-
C
l
o
s
e
d
O
p
e
n
-
O
p
e
n
-
-
-
-
-
-
C
l
o
s
e
d
O
p
e
n
-
S
l
i
d
e
r

1

2
)
-
C
l
o
s
e
d
S
t
o
p
O
p
e
n
-
O
p
e
n
C
l
o
s
e
d
-
-
-
-
C
l
o
s
e
d
S
t
o
p
O
p
e
n
-
S
l
i
d
e
r

2

2
)
-
C
l
o
s
e
d
S
t
o
p
O
p
e
n
-
O
p
e
n
C
l
o
s
e
d
-
-
-
-
C
l
o
s
e
d
S
t
o
p
O
p
e
n
-
S
l
i
d
e
r

3

2
)
-
C
l
o
s
e
d
S
t
o
p
O
p
e
n
-
O
p
e
n
C
l
o
s
e
d
-
-
-
-
C
l
o
s
e
d
S
t
o
p
O
p
e
n
-
S
l
i
d
e
r

4

2
)
-
C
l
o
s
e
d
S
t
o
p
O
p
e
n
-
O
p
e
n
C
l
o
s
e
d
-
-
-
-
C
l
o
s
e
d
S
t
o
p
O
p
e
n
-
S
l
i
d
e
r

5

2
)
-
C
l
o
s
e
d
S
t
o
p
O
p
e
n
-
O
p
e
n
C
l
o
s
e
d
-
-
-
-
C
l
o
s
e
d
S
t
o
p
O
p
e
n
-
S
o
f
t

s
t
a
r
t
e
r

2
)
-
-
O
F
F
O
N
-
O
N
n
e
t
w
o
r
k
c
o
n
t
a
c
t
o
r
-
R
e
s
e
t
O
N
c
o
m
m
a
n
d
-
-
-
O
F
F
O
N
-
S
o
f
t

r
e
v
e
r
s
i
n
g

s
t
a
r
t
e
r
2
)
-
L
e
f
t
O
F
F
R
i
g
h
t
-
R
i
g
h
t
n
e
t
w
o
r
k
-
c
o
n
t
a
c
t
o
r
L
e
f
t
n
e
t
w
o
r
k
-
c
o
n
t
a
c
t
o
r
R
e
s
e
t
O
N
c
o
m
m
a
n
d
-
-
L
e
f
t
O
F
F
R
i
g
h
t
-
SIMOCODE pro
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 5-1
Monitoring Functions 5
In this chapter
In this chapter you will find information about the monitoring functions
earth fault monitoring
current limit monitoring
operation monitoring.
Like motor protection and motor control, the monitoring functions work in
the background. All parameters of the monitoring functions are explained.
They can be active or not active, depending on the control function selected.
Target groups
This chapter is addressed to the following target groups:
configurators
programmers
commissioners
service personnel.
Necessary knowledge
You need knowledge about:
SIMOCODE pro
motor protection, motor control
the principle of connecting plugs to sockets
knowledge of electrical drive engineering.
Navigation in SIMOCODE ES
You will find the dialogs in SIMOCODE ES under
Device parameters > Monitoring functions.
Monitoring Functions
SIMOCODE pro
5-2 GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
5.1 Earth-fault monitoring via current/voltage
measurement module
5.1.1 Description
SIMOCODE pro measures and monitors all three phase currents. By evalua-
ting the summation current of the 3 current values, the motor feeder can be
monitored for a possible fault current/earth fault. The internal earth fault
monitoring is only possible for motors with a 3-phase connection in net-
works which are either grounded directly or grounded with a low impe-
dance. On recognizing an earth fault, a definable and delayable response can
be parameterized.
5.1.2 Internal earth fault
Response
Here you can set the response of SIMOCODE pro to an internal earth fault:
For this, see also Tables for the response of SIMOCODE pro in Kapitel
"Important Notes".
Figure 5-1: Internal earth fault monitoring
Table 5-1: Internal earth-fault monitoring response
Response Internal
earth fault
Deactivated X (d)
Signal X
Warn X
Switch off X
Delay 0 ... 25.5 s
Monitoring - Internal earth fault
Response to an internal earth fault
Delay of the internal earth fault
Current
- Internal earth fault
See
table 5-1
Signal
Switching
off
QE1
QE2
QE3
QE4
QE5
from
current
measure-
ment
Monitoring Functions
SIMOCODE pro
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 5-3
5.2 Current limit monitoring
5.2.1 Description
The current limit monitoring function is used - independently of the overload
protection - for process monitoring. Exceeding a current limit which is still
below the overload limit can e.g. indicate a dirty filter on a pump or a motor
mounting which is running increasingly sluggishly. Falling below a current
limit can be the first hint that a drive motor belt is worn-out. SIMOCODE pro
supports two-phase monitoring of the motor current for upper and lower
current limits which can be freely chosen. Here, the response of
SIMOCODE pro on reaching a pre-warning or trip level can be freely parame-
terized and delayed.
Figure 5-2: Current limit monitoring
Trip level: I>
Response when I>
Delay when I>
Warning level: I>
Response when I>
Delay when I>
Trip level: I<
Response when I<
Delay when I<
Warning level: I<
Response when I<
Delay when I<
Hysteresis levels
H
Signal
Signal
Signal
Current
from
current
measure-
See
table 5-2
See
table 5-3
See
table 5-4
See
table 5-5
Current limit values
- Trip level I>
Signal
- Warning level I>
- Trip level I<
- Warning level I<
ment
Monitoring Functions
SIMOCODE pro
5-4 GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
Diagram
The following diagram shows the warning level and trip level functions for
the upper and lower current limits:
Figure 5-3: Warning levels and trip levels for the upper and lower current limits
Current
Trip
level I>
Warning level I>
H
H
Warning level I<
Trip
level I<
Upper
current
limit
Lower
current
limit
H
H
0
H Hysteresis
Monitoring Functions
SIMOCODE pro
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 5-5
5.2.2 I> (upper limit)
Trip level, warning level
With current limit monitoring I> (upper limit), 2 different synchronization
levels, I> (upper limit) trip level and I> (upper limit) warning level, can be
parameterized and monitored.
If the current of one or more phases exceeds the synchronization level, the
current limit monitoring is activated.
Range:
Trip level response
Here you can set the response of SIMOCODE pro if the trip level is excee-
ded:
For this, see also Tables for the response of SIMOCODE pro in Kapitel
"Important Notes".
Table 5-2: Trip level response for current limit monitoring I>
Warning level response
Here you can set the response of SIMOCODE pro if the warning level is
exceeded:
For this, see also Tables for the Responses of SIMOCODE pro in Kapitel
"Important Notes".
Table 5-3: Warning level response for current limit monitoring I>
Trip level: 0 up to 1020% of Ie
Warning level: 0 up to 1020% of Ie
Response Trip level
Deactivated X (d)
Signal X
Warn -
Switch off X
Delay 0 ... 25.5 s
Response Warning
level:
Deactivated X (d)
Signal X
Warn X
Switch off -
Delay 0 ... 25.5 s
Monitoring Functions
SIMOCODE pro
5-6 GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
5.2.3 I< (lower limit)
Trip level, warning level
With current limit monitoring I< (lower limit), 2 different synchronization
levels (trip level / warning level) can be parameterized and monitored. If the
current of one or more phases falls below the synchronization level, the cur-
rent limit monitoring is activated.
Range:
Trip level response
Here you can set the response of SIMOCODE pro on falling below the trip
level:
For this, see also Tables for the Responses of SIMOCODE pro in Kapitel
"Important Notes".
Table 5-4: Trip level response for current limit monitoring I<
Warning level response
Here you can set the response of SIMOCODE pro on falling below the
warning level:
For this, see also Tables for the Responses of SIMOCODE pro in Kapitel
"Important Notes".
Table 5-5: Trip level response for current limit monitoring I<
Trip level: 0 up to 1020% of Ie
Warning level: 0 up to 1020% of Ie
Response Trip level
Deactivated X (d)
Signal X
Warn -
Switch off X
Delay 0 ... 25.5 s
Response Warning
level:
Deactivated X
Signal X
Warn X
Switch off -
Delay 0 ... 25.5 s
Monitoring Functions
SIMOCODE pro
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 5-7
5.3 Operation monitoring
5.3.1 Description
SIMOCODE pro can monitor the operating hours and stop times of a motor
in order to avoid plant downtimes due to failed motors because they were
either running too long (wear-out) or they were stopped too long a period of
time. For example, if an adjustable limit value is exceeded, a signal can be
issued which can indicate that maintenance on the relevant motor is neces-
sary or even that the motor should be replaced. After replacing the motor,
the operating hours and stop times can be reset.
In order to avoid excessive thermal strain on a motor and its premature
aging, the number of motor start-ups in a selected time frame can be
limited. The number of starts still possible is available for further processing
in SIMOCODE pro. The limited number of possible starts can be indicated
by pre-warnings.
Figure 5-4: Operation monitoring
Response
Table 5-6: Operation monitoring response
Response Monitoring
operating
hours - level
Stop time
monitoring -
level
Overshooting Number of
starts pre-
warning
Deactivated X (d) X (d) X (d) X (d)
Signal X X X X
Warn X X X X
Switch off - - X -
Operating hours level.
Response
Signal
Control
functions
Operating hours
Motor operating hours
Stopped time level
Response
Signal - Stop time >
Motor stop times
Stop time
Number of starts
Permissible starts
Start time frame
Number of motor starts
Overshoot response
Pre-warning response
Interlocking time
Signal
- Motor operating hours >
- Number of motor starts>
- Another start permitted
See
table 5-6
See
table 5-6
See
table 5-6
See
table 5-6
- No start permitted
Switching
off
QE1
QE2
QE3
QE4
QE5
Operation monitoring
Monitoring Functions
SIMOCODE pro
5-8 GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
5.3.2 Operating hours monitoring
The operating hours monitoring function offers the option of generating
maintenance prompts for the motor in good time.
Level
If the operating hours exceed the set synchronization level, the monitoring
function is activated.
Range:
Response
Here you can set the overshooting response.
For this, see also Tables for the Responses of SIMOCODE pro in Kapitel
"Important Notes" and table 5-6.
5.3.3 Stop time monitoring
In system parts for important processes, dual drives are often in operation
(A and B drives).
It must be assured here that these drives are always alternately run to avoid
long stop times and reduce the risk of non-availability.
The stop time monitoring function can be used, for example, to issue a
warning which causes the other motor not presently in operation to be con-
nected.
Level
The length of the stop time is set here. The monitoring function is activated
when this stop time interval is exceeded.
Range:
Response
Here you can determine the response when the permissible stop time is
exceeded:
For this, see also Tables for the Responses of SIMOCODE pro in Kapitel
"Important Notes" and table 5-6.
Level 0 to 1193046 hours
Level 0 to 65535 hours
Monitoring Functions
SIMOCODE pro
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 5-9
5.3.4 Monitoring the number of starts
The function for monitoring the number of starts is used to protect system
parts (motor, switching devices like e.g. soft starters and converters) against
too many impermissible start processes inside a parameterizable time
frame and thus to prevent damage from occurring. This is especially useful
for start-up or manual control.
The following schematic shows the principle of the function for monitoring
the number of starts.
Figure 5-5: Monitoring the number of starts
Permissible starts
The maximum number of starts is set here. With the first start, the time
interval Start time frame starts to run. After the second to the last permis-
sible start has been executed, a pre-warning Another start permitted is
issued.
Range:
Start time frame
The time frame of the start process is set here. The maximum number of
starts is only available again after the parameterizable start time frame is
finished.
The available starts are shown by the analog value Permissible starts -
actual value.
Range:
Overshooting response
Here you can set the response to be carried out when the permissible num-
ber of starts within the start time frame have been exceeded:
For this, see also Tables for the Responses of SIMOCODE pro in Kapitel
"Important Notes" and table 5-6.
Permissible starts 1 to 255
Start time frame 0 to 65535 seconds
Time frame
1. Start within the time frame
t
Example:
3 starts allowed
Pre-warning Overshooting
Monitoring Functions
SIMOCODE pro
5-10 GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
Pre-warning response
Here you can set the response to be carried out after the second to the last
start:
For this, see also Tables for the Responses of SIMOCODE pro in Kapitel
"Important Notes" and table 5-6.
Interlocking time
If a new start command is issued within the time frame after the last per-
missible start has been carried out, this new start command will no longer
be executed by the setting Overshoot response - switching off. The Fault
- number of starts > and the set interlocking time is activated.
Range:
Interlocking time 0 to 65535 seconds
SIMOCODE pro
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 6-1
Outputs 6
In this chapter
In this chapter you will find information on the outputs of
SIMOCODE pro:
relay outputs
light-emitting diodes of the operator panel
signaling data on the PROFIBUS DP.
Target groups
This chapter is addressed to the following target groups:
planners and configurators
programmers.
Necessary knowledge
You need the following knowledge:
the principle of connecting plugs to sockets
PROFIBUS DP.
Outputs
SIMOCODE pro
6-2 GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
6.1 Introduction
Description
SIMOCODE pro has different outputs.
The outputs include, for example:
output terminals , located on the outside of the basic units and digital
modules
LEDs on the operator panel for visualizing the operating state
outputs to the PROFIBUS DP.
Schematic
The following schematic shows the general representation of the types of
outputs:
Figure 6-1: General display of the types of outputs
SIMOCODE pro
DP PROFIBUS DP
LEDs operator panel
Output
Output
Output
Output terminals
SIMOCODE pro
SIMOCODE pro
Plugs
Plugs
Plugs
Outputs
SIMOCODE pro
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 6-3
Extent and application
Outputs are used, e.g. for controlling motor contactors, displaying the sta-
tus or signaling via PROFIBUS DP. The system provides different outputs,
depending on the device series:
Table 6-1: Outputs
SIMOCODE
Outputs pro C
(BU1)
Number
pro V
(BU2)
Number
Basic unit BU, outputs 1 to 3
Operator panel LEDs
Digital module 1 DM1 - output 1 to 2
Digital module 2 DM2 - output 1 to 2
Acyclic signaling data
Cyclic signaling data
Outputs
SIMOCODE pro
6-4 GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
6.2 Basic unit (BU)
Description
The basic unit has a BU - output function block with 3 relay outputs. You
can e.g. switch contactors or lamps using relay outputs. The inputs (plugs)
must be connected to the corresponding sockets. The BU - output
function block consists of
3 plugs, corresponding to the relay outputs Out1 to Out3
3 relays
output terminals
In total there is:
1 BU - output function block for BU1 and BU2.
Schematic
The following schematic shows the relay outputs:
Figure 6-2: BU output schematic
Application examples
Controlling the main contactor in the motor feeder:
You can e.g. define which relay output is used for controlling the motor con-
tactor in the motor feeder. For this, connect the desired relay output with the
corresponding QE. contactor control.
Controlling lamps for displaying operating states:
You can e.g. define which relay outputs are used for controlling lamps/
LEDs which then display the operating states of the motor (fault, ON,
OFF, fast, slow...).
For this, connect the desired relay output to the corresponding QL..
contactor control. These are specially designed for controlling lamps and
LEDs:
The QL... lamp controls also automatically signal to the status displays
via a 2 Hz flashing frequency:
test mode (QLE.../QLA lamp outputs are flashing)
unacknowledged fault case (lamp output general fault QLS is flashing)
passing on any other information, signals, warnings, faults, etc. to the
relay outputs
lamp test: all QL outputs are activated for approx. 2s
1
2
BU - output
3
1
2
3
6
7
Out1
Out2
Out3
Output terminals
Terminal numbers
SIMOCODE pro
Outputs
SIMOCODE pro
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 6-5
Settings
BU output Description
Outputs 1 to 3 Controls the BU-output function block from an arbitrary signal
(optional sockets
e.g. device inputs, control bits from PROFIBUS DP, etc. (usually
from the QE contactor controls)
Table 6-2: BU output settings
Outputs
SIMOCODE pro
6-6 GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
6.3 Operator panel (OP)
Description
SIMOCODE pro has an OP - LED function block with 7 LEDs. The LEDs
are in the operator panel and can be used for arbitrary status displays. For
this, the inputs (plugs) must be connected to the corresponding sockets
(e.g. with the sockets for the status signals). The OP - LED function block
can only be used if the operator panel (OP) is connected and parameterized
in the device configuration! The OP - LED function block contains
4 inputs, OP LED green 1 to OP LED green 4, corresponding to the green
LEDs. The green LEDs are optically/logically assigned to the buttons of the
operator panel. They usually display the feedback of the motor operating state
3 inputs, OP - LED yellow 1 to OP - LED yellow 3, corresponding to the
yellow LEDs
4 green LEDs
3 yellow LEDs
In total there is:
1 OP - LED function block for BU1 and BU2.
Schematic
Figure 6-3: OP LED schematic
Application examples
Displaying operating states:
You can e.g. define which LEDs are to be activated for displaying the motor
operating states (fault, ON, OFF, fast, slow...).
For this, connect the desired LED to the corresponding QL contactor con-
trol.
Passing on any other information, signals, warnings, faults, etc. to the yellow
LEDs.
Yellow 1
Yellow 2
Yellow 3
Green 1
Green 2
Green 3
Green 4
OP - LED
LEDs in the operator panel
QL
Outputs
SIMOCODE pro
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 6-7
Settings
OP LED Description
Green 1 - green 4 Controls the OP - LED function block from an arbitrary signal
(arbitrary sockets ,
e.g. feedback operating state motor)
Yellow 1 - yellow 3 Controls the OP - LED function block from an arbitrary signal
(arbitrary sockets
e.g. displays for status, signals, faults)
Table 6-3: OP LED settings
Outputs
SIMOCODE pro
6-8 GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
6.4 Digital modules (DM)
Description
Basic unit 2 (SIMOCODE pro V) provides the option of extending the num-
ber of inputs and outputs as well as their types by degrees via expansion
modules (digital modules).
The basic unit has 2 function blocks: Digital module 1 - output and Digital
module 2 - output, with 2 relay outputs each. You can e.g. switch contactors
or lamps via the relay outputs. For this, the inputs (plugs) must be connec-
ted to the corresponding sockets. Function blocks can only be used if the
corresponding digital modules (DM) are connected and parameterized in the
device configuration! Each function block contains
2 plugs, corresponding to the relay outputs Out1, Out2
2 relays
output terminals
In total there is
1 function block Digital module1 - output BU2
1 function block Digital module2 - output BU2.
The following digital modules are available for basic unit 2:
Table 6-4: Digital modules variations
With the monostable version, the relay outputs open after switching off the
supply voltage. With the bistable version, the switching state of the relay
outputs remains intact even after switching off the supply voltage.
Schematic
The following schematic shows the relay outputs:
Figure 6-4: DM1 / DM2 output schematic
Inputs Supply Outputs
4 inputs 24 V DC, external 2 monostable relay
outputs
4 inputs 110... 240V AC/DC, external 2 monostable relay
outputs
4 inputs 24 V DC, external 2 bistable relay outputs
4 inputs 110... 240V AC/DC, external 2 bistable relay outputs
1
2
DM1 - output
Out1
Out2
1
2
DM2 - output
Out1
Out2
Output terminals Output terminals
Outputs
SIMOCODE pro
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 6-9
Application examples
Controlling the motor contactor in the motor feeder:
You can e.g. define which relay output is to be used for controlling the main
contactor in the motor feeder.
For this, connect the desired relay output with the corresponding QE con-
tactor control.
Controlling lamps for displaying the operating states:
You can e.g. define which relay outputs are to be used for controlling the
lamps/LEDs which then display the motor operating states (fault, ON, OFF,
fast, slow...).
For this, connect the desired relay output with the corresponding QL...
lamp control.
Passing on any other information, signals, warnings, faults, etc. to the relay
outputs.
Settings
DM1 / DM2 output Description
Output 1 to 2 Controls the DM1 output and DM2 output function blocks
from an arbitrary signal
(arbitrary sockets
e.g. device inputs, control bits from PROFIBUS DP, etc. (usually
from the QE contactor controls)
Table 6-5: DM1 / DM2 output settings
Outputs
SIMOCODE pro
6-10 GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
6.5 Cyclic signaling
Description
The Cyclic signaling function block is used to determine which informa-
tion is given cyclically to the automation system via PROFIBUS DP. For this,
the inputs (plugs) must be connected to the corresponding sockets.
The Cyclic signaling function block consists of
16 inputs (2 bytes, byte 0 and byte 1 for binary information)
1 input (2 bytes, byte 2 and 3 for analog information, one freely paramete-
rizable word)
1 output (PROFIBUS DP).
In total there is
1 Cyclic signaling function block for BU1 and BU2.
Schematic
Figure 6-5: Cyclic signaling data schematic
Bit 0
Bit 1
Bit 2
Byte 0
Bit 3
Bit 4
Bit 5
Bit 6
Bit 7
Bit 0
Bit 1
Bit 2
Byte 1
Bit 3
Bit4
Bit 5
Bit 6
Bit 7
to PROFIBUS DP
Input (analog)
Cyclic signaling
Byte 2/3
DP
Outputs
SIMOCODE pro
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 6-11
Cyclic services
Cyclic signaling data is exchanged once in every DP cycle between the DP
master and the DP slave. In this case, the DP master sends the cyclic con-
trol data to SIMOCODE pro. In response, SIMOCODE pro sends the cyclic
signaling data to the DP master.
Settings
Acyclic signaling
data
Description
Byte 0 to 1
Bit 0 to bit 7
Controls the bits with arbitrary signals
(arbitrary sockets
e.g. device inputs, signaling data, etc.)
Byte 2/3 Controls the word with arbitrary analog signals
(arbitrary sockets
e.g. maximum current Imax, remaining cooling time, actual value of
timers, etc.)
Table 6-6: Test settings
Byte 0 of the signaling data is already preset. Byte 2/3 is preset with the
max. current!
Outputs
SIMOCODE pro
6-12 GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
6.6 Acyclic signaling
Description
In addition to Cyclic signaling, it is also possible to transmit additional 16-
bit information to the PLC/PC via acyclic services.
The Acyclic signaling function block is used to determine which informa-
tion is given acyclically to the automation system via PROFIBUS DP. For this,
the inputs (plugs) must be connected to the corresponding sockets.
The Acyclic signal function block consists of
16 inputs (2 bytes, byte 0 and byte 1 for binary information)
1 logic component
1 output (PROFIBUS DP).
In total there is
1 function block Acyclic signaling for the BU1 and BU2.
Schematic
Figure 6-6: Acyclic signaling data schematic
Bit 0
Bit 1
Bit 2
Byte 0
Bit 3
Bit 4
Bit 5
Bit 6
Bit 7
Bit 0
Bit 1
Bit 2
Byte 1
Bit 3
Bit 4
Bit 5
Bit 6
Bit 7
to PROFIBUS DP
Acyclic signaling
DP
Outputs
SIMOCODE pro
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 6-13
Acyclic services
Acyclic signaling data is only transmitted on request.
The information (2 bytes) is in data record 203.
This data record can be read by every master (PLC or PC) which supports
the acyclic services of PROFIBUS DPV1.
Settings
Acyclic signaling
data
Description
Byte 0 to 1
Bit 0 to bit 7
Controls the bits with arbitrary signals
(arbitrary sockets , e.g. device inputs, signaling data, state infor-
mation, fault signals, etc.)
Table 6-7: Test settings
Outputs
SIMOCODE pro
6-14 GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
SIMOCODE pro
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 7-1
Inputs 7
In this chapter
In this chapter you will find information on the inputs of SIMOCODE pro.
The inputs include:
the four inputs of the basic units (BU1, BU2)
the four inputs of digital modules 1 and 2 (DM1, DM2).
Target groups
This chapter is addressed to the following target groups:
planners and configurators
planners.
Necessary knowledge
You need knowledge about:
the principle of connecting plugs to sockets.
Navigation in SIMOCODE ES
You will find the dialogs in SIMOCODE ES under:
Device parameters > Inputs.
Inputs
SIMOCODE pro
7-2 GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
7.1 Introduction
Description
SIMOCODE pro has different inputs (input terminals). These inputs provide
external information. They are interfaces from the outside to
SIMOCODE pro. These inputs become sockets inside SIMOCODE pro. The
inputs contain:
input terminals , located on the outside of the basic units and digital
modules
buttons on the operator panel (1 button test/reset, 4 freely parameterizable
buttons) and basic units (1 button test/reset)
inputs from PROFIBUS DP.
Schematic
The following schematic shows the general representation of the input
types:
Figure 7-1: General representation of the input types
SIMOCODE pro
DP PROFIBUS DP
Input
Input
Input
Input terminals
SIMOCODE pro
SIMOCODE pro
Buttons
- Control commands
- Test/reset
Sockets
Sockets
Sockets
Inputs
SIMOCODE pro
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 7-3
Scope and application
Inputs are used, for example, for inputting external signals e.g. via pushbut-
tons, key-operated switches, etc. These external signals are processed fur-
ther internally via corresponding connections. Depending on the device
series, the system provides different inputs:
SIMOCODE
Inputs pro C
(BU1)
Number
pro V
(BU2)
Number
Basic unit BU - inputs 1 to 4
Operator panel buttons
Digital module 1 DM1 - inputs 1 to 4
Digital module 2 DM2 - inputs 1 to 4
Acyclic control data
Cyclic control data
Table 7-1: Inputs
Inputs
SIMOCODE pro
7-4 GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
7.2 Basic unit (BU)
Description
The basic unit has a function block BU - input with 4 grouped digital
inputs. You can connect e.g. the buttons for a local control station to the
inputs. In order for these signals to be further processed, the plugs of other
function blocks, e.g. a control station, must be connected to the correspon-
ding sockets.
The function block BU - input consists of
input terminals , located on the outside of the basic unit, corresponding to
the sockets BU - input 1 to BU - input 4
24 V DC internally for supplying the inputs of the basic unit
outputs in the form of sockets in SIMOCODE pro which can be connected to
any plugs, e.g. to the control stations.
In total there is:
1 function block BU - input for BU1 and BU2.
Schematic
The following schematic shows the inputs of the basic unit
Figure 7-2: Schematic BU - Input
Application example
The inputs can be used, for example, to connect the start and stop buttons
of the local control station - which can then be assigned to the local con-
trol internal control station.
Via the corresponding assignments, the input signals can be used to acti-
vate, for example, function blocks such as Reset or External fault.
Basic unit (BU)
8
5
4
10
9
BU - Inputs
1
2
3
4
Terminal
numbers
24 V DC
IN1
IN2
IN3
IN4
internally
Inputs
SIMOCODE pro
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 7-5
Supplying the inputs
You have three possibilities for supplying the inputs:
a): 24 V DC internal.
b): 24 V DC external. However, input 3 is reference potential, i.e. 3 inputs are
available.
c): 24 V DC external. Only possible for the basic unit with a supply
voltage of 24 V DC!
Figure 7-3: 24 V DC for supplying the inputs
Settings
All inputs work reaction-free, i.e. the signal states on the neighboring inputs
do not influence each other.
Basic unit Description
Debounce time
Inputs
If necessary, you can set a debounce time for the inputs.
Range: 6, 16, 26, 36 ms (default setting: 16 ms).
Table 7-2: BU - input settings
Basic unit (BU)
BU - input
1
2
3
4
IN1
IN2
IN3
IN4
24 V DC internal, 4 inputs usable
Basic unit (BU)
BU - input
1
2
3
4
IN1
IN2
IN3
IN4
24 V DC external, 3 inputs usable
Basic unit (BU)
BU - input
1
2
3
4
IN1
IN2
IN3
IN4
24 V DC external, 4 inputs usable
A1
A2
a) b) c)
Only possible for the basic unit

24 V DC
(not usable)
with a supply voltage of 24 V DC!
Inputs
SIMOCODE pro
7-6 GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
7.3 Digital modules (DM)
Description
The digital module has a function block BU - input with 4 grouped digital
inputs. You can connect e.g. the buttons for a local control station to the
inputs. In order for these signals to be further processed, the plugs of other
function blocks, e.g. a control station, must be connected to the correspon-
ding sockets.
The function block DM - input consists of
input terminals , located on the outside of the digital module, correspon-
ding to the sockets DM - input 1 to DM - input 4
outputs in the form of sockets in SIMOCODE pro which can be connected to
any plugs, e.g. to the control stations.
In total there is:
1 function block DM1 - Input and DM2 - Input for BU2.
Schematic
The following schematic shows the inputs of the digital module
Figure 7-4: Schematic of DM inputs
Application example
Digital modules offer the option of further increasing the number of binary
inputs and outputs on basic device 2.
Up to 2 digital modules can be connected. Thus, 4 further binary inputs and 2
further binary outputs are available in each case.
Supplying the inputs (only externally, not via BU1/2) 24 V DC or
110 V up to 240 V AC/DC.
SIMOCODE pro V can thus be extended to a maximum of 12 binary inputs
and 7 binary outputs.
Digital module (DM)
25
23
24
26
27
DM - inputs
1
2
3
4
Terminal
numbers
IN1
IN2
IN3
IN4
N/M
Inputs
SIMOCODE pro
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 7-7
Supplying the inputs
There are two versions of the digital module:
a): Digital module with 24 V DC input supply
b): Digital module with 110 to 240 V AC/DC input supply.
Figure 7-5: Supplying the inputs for the digital module
Settings
Basic unit Description
Debounce time
Inputs
If necessary, you can set a debounce time for the inputs.
Range: 6, 16, 26, 36 ms. Default setting: 16 ms.
These values are valid for digital modules with a 24 V DC input sup-
ply.
For digital modules with a 110 to 240 V AC/DC input supply, the
values are about 40 ms higher.
Table 7-3: BU - input settings
24 V DC external 110 V up to 240 V AC/DC external
Digital module (DM)
DM - inputs
1
2
3
4
IN1
IN2
IN3
IN4
N/M
Digital module (DM)
DM - inputs
1
2
3
4
IN1
IN2
IN3
IN4
N/M
~
a) b)
Inputs
SIMOCODE pro
7-8 GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
7.4 Cyclic controlling
Description
With the Cyclic controlling function block, you can transfer information
cyclically to the automation system via PROFIBUS DP. For this, the inputs
(plugs) must be assigned to the corresponding outputs (sockets).
The function block Cyclic controlling consists of
16 outputs (2 byte, byte 0 and byte 1 for binary information)
1 input PROFIBUS DP.
In total there is:
1 function block Cyclic controlling for BU1 and BU2.
Schematic
Figure 7-6: Schematic cyclic control data
Cyclic services
The cyclic data is exchanged once in every DP cycle between DP master
and DP slave. The DP master sends the cyclic control data (cyclic con-
trolling) to SIMOCODE pro. As a response, SIMOCODE pro sends the cyclic
signal data (cyclic send) to the DP master.
Bit 0
Bit 1
Bit 2
Byte 0
Bit 3
Bit 4
Bit 5
Bit 6
Bit 7
Bit 0
Bit 1
Bit 2
Byte 1
Bit 3
Bit 4
Bit 5
Bit 6
Bit 7
Cyclic controlling
DP
from PROFIBUS DP
Inputs
SIMOCODE pro
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 7-9
7.5 Acyclic controlling
Description
In addition to Cyclic controlling, there is also the option of transferring fur-
ther 16-bit information via the function block Acyclic controlling.
You can determine which information should be transferred acyclically via
PROFIBUS DP to the automation system. For this, the outputs (sockets)
must be assigned to the corresponding plugs.
The function block Acyclic controlling consists of
16 outputs (2 byte, byte 0 and byte 1 for binary information)
1 input (PROFIBUS DP).
In total there is:
1 function block Acyclic controlling for BU1 and BU2.
Schematic
Figure 7-7: Schematic of acyclic control data
Cyclic services
Acyclic data is only transferred on request.
The information (2 bytes) is in record 202.
This record can be read by every master (PLC or PC) which supports the
acyclic services of PROFIBUS DPV1.
Bit 0
Bit 1
Bit 2
Byte 0
Bit 3
Bit 4
Bit 5
Bit 6
Bit 7
Bit 0
Bit 1
Bit 2
Byte 1
Bit 3
Bit 4
Bit 5
Bit 6
Bit 7
Acyclic controlling
Byte 2/3
DP
from PROFIBUS DP
Inputs
SIMOCODE pro
7-10 GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
SIMOCODE pro
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 8-1
Standard Function Blocks 8
In this chapter
In this chapter you will find information about standard function blocks
which you can activate as required. Standard function blocks often contain
functions needed for motor feeders and are characterized by simple hand-
ling.
Target groups
This chapter is addressed to the following target groups:
configurators
programmers of application programs for comprehension purposes.
Necessary knowledge
You need knowledge about:
the principle of connecting plugs to sockets
motor protection
control functions, control stations.
Navigation in SIMOCODE ES
You will find the dialogs in SIMOCODE ES under:
More function blocks > Standard functions.
Standard Function Blocks
SIMOCODE pro
8-2 GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
8.1 Introduction
Description
The system also contains so-called standard function blocks which can be
used if required. They can contain:
inputs (plug )
outputs (sockets ) via a signal
setting values, e.g. the response when external faults occur (Signal, Warn
or Switch off).
Schematic
The following schematic shows the general functioning of a standard
function block:
Figure 8-1: General functioning of a standard function block
Scope and application
Standard function blocks work independently of the selected control
function and can be used as optional additions. They are already available,
and just have to be activated, which is achieved by wiring up the input
(External fault standard function block).
Depending on the device range, the system provides several function
blocks:
SIMOCODE
Standard function block pro C(BU1)
Number
pro V(BU2)
Number
Test 2 2
Reset 3 3
Test position feedback (TPF) 1 1
External fault 4 6
Operational protection off (OPO) 1
Power failure monitoring (UVO) 1
Emergency start 1 1
Watchdog (monitoring PLC/DCS) 1 1
Timestamping 1
Table 8-1: Standard function blocks
Signal
Input 1
Input n
Standard function block
Setting value
Standard Function Blocks
SIMOCODE pro
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 8-3
8.2 Test/reset
Test/reset description
The function of the test/reset button is generally dependent on the opera-
ting status of the device:
Reset function: when a fault occurs
Test function: other operating statuses
The Test function block consists of:
1 Input
a logic component (test/reset buttons locked).
In total there are:
2 Test 1 and Test 2 function blocks for BU1 and BU2:
Test 1: with testing/switching off the output relays
Test 2: without switching off the output relays (normally for a test via the
bus).
Schematic
Figure 8-2: Schematic "Test/Reset"
Carrying out the test
The test can be carried out as follows:
using the test/reset button on the basic unit and operator panel (can be
deactivated)
Test input 1/2 of the internal function block
The test function can be terminated at any time - it does not influence the
thermal motor model/overload function, i.e. after switching off using Test, it
can immediately be switched back again.
Switching off only occurs for Test 1 if the operation type is set to Remote.
Reset 3
Test 1
Test/Reset buttons locked
Test 2
Reset 1
Reset 2
Botton "TEST/RESET" BU
control functions
Test/Reset
Botton "TEST/RESET" OP
Standard Function Blocks
SIMOCODE pro
8-4 GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
Reset function:
The reset function can be carried out as follows:
using the test/reset button on the basic unit and operator panel (can be
deactivated)
using the Reset input of the internal function blocks
The inputs (plugs) must be connected to the corresponding sockets.
The Reset function block consists of:
1 Input.
In total there are:
3 function blocks, Reset 1 to 3 for BU1 and BU2.
All reset inputs are equal (OR function).
Test function
A function test of SIMOCODE pro can also be installed using the test
function.
The test function contains the following steps:
Lamp/LED test (test function activated < 2 s)
Testing the device functionality (test function activated 2 to 5 s)
Only for Test 1: Switching off the QE (test function activated > 5 s).
Standard Function Blocks
SIMOCODE pro
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 8-5
Test phases
The following table shows the test phases carried out when the test/
reset button is pressed for the respective period of time:
Settings test
Test
phase
Status Without main current With main current
O.K. Fault *) O.K. Fault
Hardware test/lamp test
< 2 s
DEVICE LED Green Green Green Green
GEN.FAULT
LED
Contactor control Unchanged Unchanged Unchanged Unchanged
Show QL*
Hardware/lamp test result
2 s - 5 s
DEVICE LED Green Red Green Rot
GEN.FAULT
LED
Contactor control Unchanged Deactivated Unchanged Deactivated
Relay test
> 5 s
DEVICE LED Green Red Green Rot
GEN.FAULT
LED
Contactor control Deactivated Deactivated Deactivated Deactivated
LED lit/activated LED flashing LED flickering LED off
*) Fault displayed after 2 s
Table 8-2: Statuses of the status LEDs/contactor controls during the test
Test 1 to 2 - Description
Input Activates the Test function block from any signal
(any sockets , e.g. device inputs, control bits from
PROFIBUS DP, etc.)
Test/reset button
locked
The blue test/reset buttons on the basic unit and the operator panel
are designed for acknowledgement of faults and for carrying out
device tests.
The keys can be locked using Test/reset button locked. They can
then be used for other purposes.
Table 8-3: Settings test
Standard Function Blocks
SIMOCODE pro
8-6 GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
Acknowledging reset fault
The following applies to the acknowledgement of faults:
faults can be simply acknowledged
when the cause of the fault has been eliminated
if no ON control command is present.
No reset will be carried out when a reset command is issued if the cause of
the fault or an ON control command is still present. The reset is saved,
depending on the type of fault. The saving of the reset is indicated by the
GEN.FAULT LED on the basic unit and the control panel. The LEDs change
from flashing to a continuous signal.
Automatic acknowledgement of fault reset
The acknowledgement of faults occurs automatically in the following cases:
Case 1: A reset is saved and the cause of the fault disappears (user pre-
viously acknowledged)
Case 2: An overload tripping or thermistor tripping is automatically reset if
motor protection reset = Auto (the acknowledgement occurs automatically
after the cooling off time expires). The motor cannot start immediately since a
reset cannot occur if an ON command is present.
Case 3: If a configured module fails, all associated faults are automatically
acknowledged. However, a removal fault is generated (exception: operating
panel during the corresponding parameterization). This ensures that a module
fault does not cause the general fault to be acknowledged automatically.
Case 4a: If a function or module is deactivated in the device configuration (via
a parameterization), all associated faults are acknowledged automatically (the
motor cannot start immediately since no parameter can be entered if an ON
command is present).
Case 4b: If a function's parameter is changed from Switch off to Warn,
Signal or Deactivated, all associated faults are automatically acknowled-
ged.
For an external fault: with its own parameter: Auto reset.
Reset setting
Reset 1 to 3 - Description
Input Activates the Reset function block from any signal
(any sockets , e.g. device inputs, control bits from
PROFIBUS DP, etc.)
Test/reset button
locked
The blue test/reset buttons on the basic unit and the operator panel
are designed for acknowledgement of faults and carrying out
device tests.
The keys can be locked using Test/reset button locked. They can
then be used for other purposes.
Table 8-4: Reset setting
Standard Function Blocks
SIMOCODE pro
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 8-7
8.3 Test position feedback (TPF)
Description
You can carry out the Cold starting function test using the test position
feedback (TPF) function. The input (plug) must be connected to the corre-
sponding socket. The active test position is indicated by a flashing QL*.
The Test position feedback (TPF) function block consists of
1 Input
1 Status - test position output
This is set when a signal is connected to the input.
1 Fault - test position feedback fault output.
It is set when
TPF is activated, even if current is flowing in the motor feeder
TPF is activated, and current is flowing in the motor feeder
In total there is
1 Test position function block for BU1 and BU2.
Notice:
When the test position is activated, the QLE/QLA outputs are controlled by
flashing.
Schematic
Figure 8-3: Feedback test position schematic
Cold starting
If the motor feeder is in the test position, its main circuit is isolated from the
network. However, the control voltage is connected.
The Cold starting function test is carried out in this status. Cold starting is
defined as the testing of the motor feeder without a current in the main cir-
cuit.
This function must be activated via an input to differentiate this function
from normal operation.
The feedback that the motor feeder is isolated from the mains voltage can
be achieved using an auxiliary contact of the main switch in the motor fee-
der which is connected to any device input (terminal). This is then linked to
the Test position feedback (TPF) input.
Following this, the protection outputs can be set using the enabled control
stations (see chapter "Control stations" on page 4-2), which enables the cur-
rent-free status to be tested.
If current falsely flows during the test operation, the contactor outputs are
switched off with the message Fault - Test position feedback fault.
Input
Fault -
Feedback fault test position
Status -
Test position
TPF
Type
Standard Function Blocks
SIMOCODE pro
8-8 GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
Fault - Test position feedback (TPF) fault message and acknowledgement
Attention
Fault - Test position feedback (TPF) is generated when:
TPF is activated, even if current is flowing in the motor feeder
TPF is activated, and current is flowing in the motor feeder
It can be acknowledged using Reset or the OFF/STOP control com-
mand.
Settings
External fault
1 to 6 -
Description
Input Controls the test position feedback (TPF) using any signal (any
sockets ,
e.g. device input)
Type Specifies the input logic
NO contact (1-active)
NC contact (0-active)
Table 8-5: Test position feedback (TPF) setting
Standard Function Blocks
SIMOCODE pro
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 8-9
8.4 External fault
Description
External faults 1-6 can optionally be used to monitor any statuses and/or
external devices and to create fault messages. In order to do this, the inputs
(plugs) must be connected to any sockets (e.g. device inputs, control bits
from PROFIBUS DP, etc.). Example: monitoring the rotational speed of the
motor using an external rotational-speed monitor.
The External fault function block consists of
2 inputs
evaluation
1 Signal - external fault output. This is set when a signal is connected to
the input.
In total there are:
4 external fault function blocks (1 to 4) for BU1
6 external fault function blocks (1 to 6) for BU2.
Schematic
Figure 8-4: Schematic of external faults
Special reset possibilities:
A reset input is also available in addition to the other reset possibilities
(remote reset, test/reset button, OFF command reset). Furthermore, auto
reset can also be activated.
For this, see the chapter "External fault signal" on page 8-10.
Signal -
Input
Type
Reset
External fault 1
Type
Effectiveness
Response
Reset
(Labeling)
Ext. fault 1
Signal -
Input
Type
Reset
External fault 2
Type
Effectiveness
Response
Reset
(Labeling)
Ext. fault 2
Signal -
Input
Type
Reset
External fault 3
Type
Effectiveness
Response
Reset
(Labeling)
Ext. fault 3
Signal -
Input
Type
Reset
External fault 4
Type
Effectiveness
Response
Reset
(Labeling)
Ext. fault 4
Signal -
Input
Type
Reset
External fault 5
Type
Effectiveness
Response
Reset
(Labeling)
Ext. fault 5
Signal -
Input
Type
Reset
External fault 6
Type
Effectiveness
Response
Reset
(Labeling)
Ext. fault 6
Standard Function Blocks
SIMOCODE pro
8-10 GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
Settings
External fault signal
Table 8-7: External fault signal
External faults
1 to 6 -
Description
Input Activates the External fault function block using the monitored
signal (any sockets , e.g. device inputs, control bits from
PROFIBUS DP, etc.)
Status:
Type Specifies the input logic:
NO contact (1-active)
NC contact (0-active) (default setting)
Effectiveness Specifies in which motor operating status the external fault should
be evaluated:
Always:
Always evaluate, regardless of whether the motor is running or
stationary.
only when the motor is on:
Evaluation only when the motor is switched on.
Response Specifies the response to an external fault when activated using
the input. (See the following table and the Kapitel "Important
Notes")
Reset Acknowledges the External fault fault using any signal
(any sockets , e.g. device inputs, control bits from
PROFIBUS DP, etc.)
Reset also through Specifies further (common) acknowledgement possibilities using
additional reset types:
Test/reset button on the basic unit and the control panel (panel
reset)
Remote reset: Acknowledgement though resets 1-3, DPV1,
Reset command
Auto reset: Fault resets itself after the cause of the fault has been
eliminated (after removal of the activation signal)
OFF command reset: OFF control command resets the fault.
(Labelling) No parameters. Optional labelling to describe the signal, e.g.
Rotational speed >, e.g. using SIMOCODE ES.
Range: up to 10 characters
Table 8-6: External fault settings
Response External fault
Fault / switch off X
Warning X
Signal X
Disabled
Delay -
Standard Function Blocks
SIMOCODE pro
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 8-11
8.5 Operational protection OFF (OPO)
8.5.1 Response for slider control function
Description
This function puts the slider into the safe mode. In order to do this, the
inputs (plugs) must be connected to the corresponding sockets (e.g. device
inputs, control bits from PROFIBUS DP, etc.).
The Operational protection off function block consists of
1 Input
1 Status - OPO output. This is set when a signal is connected to the input.
1 Fault - OPO fault output. It is set when the corresponding, safe end posi-
tion is reached.
In total there is:
1 function block Operational protection off (OPO) for BU2.
The following table shows the main functionality:
Table 8-8: Main functionality of Operational protection off (OPO) for slider control function
Schematic
Figure 8-5: Operational protection off (OPO) schematic
OPO Initial position when OPO occurs
Slider is open Slider opens Slider stop-
ped/off
Slider closes Slider is clo-
sed
Reaction to OPO
Parameterized
Slider clo-
sed response
Fault
Reset: with
close com-
mand
Closes
Fault
Reset: with
close com-
mand
Closes
Fault
Reset: with
close com-
mand
Closes
-
Closes
-
Parameterized
Slider open
response
- -
Opens
Fault
Reset: with
open command
Opens
Fault
Reset: with
open command
Opens
Fault
Reset: with
open command
Opens
Input
Fault -
Operational protection off (OPO)
Status -
Operational

Slider response
Type
Operational protection off (OPO)
protection off (OPO)
Standard Function Blocks
SIMOCODE pro
8-12 GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
Settings
Notes
No Fault - Operational protection off (OPO) fault message is created if the
OPO command tries to move the slider to the position where it already is
or to the position towards which it is already heading.
No other control command (counter command or stop command) is carried
out while Operational protection off (OPO) is active.
The Fault - Operation protection off (OPO) fault message must be acknow-
ledged using the open or close control command, depending on the slider's
present end position.
The acknowledgement is carried out even if the desired end position has not
yet been reached.
The fault message can be used to diagnose the PROFIBUS DP.
8.5.2 Response to other control functions
Description
For other control functions, the following scenarios can be differentiated if
OPO is used:
The motor is running: The motor switches off with a Fault - Operational pro-
tection off (OPO) fault.
The motor is off. Initially no fault. The Fault - Operational protection off
(OPO) fault only occurs when the ON command is issued.
Operational
protection off
(OPO) -
Description
Input Activates of the Operational protection off function block using
the monitored signal
(any sockets , e.g. device inputs, etc.)
Slider response Specifies the response for the slider control function when activa-
ted via the input:
CLOSE: Slider goes to the Closed end position
OPEN: Slider goes to the Open end position
Type Species the input logic
NO contact (1-active)
NC contact (0-active)
Table 8-9: Operational protection off settings
Standard Function Blocks
SIMOCODE pro
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 8-13
8.6 Power failure monitoring (UVO)
Description
The Power failure monitoring (UVO) is activated using the input. This is
achieved using an external relay.
Process (see process diagram below).
1) All contactors (QE) are immediately deactivated after the monitoring-input
relay/activation of the input (UVO) have been addressed.
2) The motor switches back into its previous status if the voltage returns within
the Power failure time. This can either take place immediately or an additio-
nal time delay can be included (restart delay).
3) If the Power failure time expires before the voltage returns, the device
signals a fault (UVO fault).
Condition: The SIMOCODE pro control voltage is buffered and is not inter-
rupted.
Schematic
Figure 8-6: Power failure monitoring (UVO) process diagram
Figure 8-7: Power failure monitoring (UVO)
Input*
Fault -
Power failure monitoring (UVO)
UVO
Type
Power failure time
*Activation
External power failure monitoring
Restart delay
QE
t
Power failure
time
Power failure
time
UVO
t
Fault
t
Fault
1)
2)
3)
Standard Function Blocks
SIMOCODE pro
8-14 GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
Settings
Power failure
monitoring (UVO) -
Description
Input Activates the Power failure monitoring function block using the
monitored signal (any sockets , e.g. device inputs, control bits
from PROFIBUS DP, etc.)
Type Specifies the type of power failure monitoring:
deactivated
device supply is not interrupted
The control voltage from SIMOCODE pro remains constant.
The interruption of the mains voltage must be measured by a
separate voltage relay (for example).
Power failure time The time at which the power failure starts.
If the mains voltage returns within the power failure time period, all
the drives that were connected before the power failure are auto-
matically reconnected.
If the mains voltage does not return within this time period, the
drives remain disconnected and the Fault - Power failure UVO
fault message is generated.
The fault message can be acknowledged using Reset once the
mains voltage returns.
Range: 0 to 25.5 seconds
Restart delay (stag-
gered)
The restart delay can be set so that not all motors restart at the
same time (mains voltage would collapse again).
Range: 0 to 255 seconds
Table 8-10: Power failure monitoring settings
Standard Function Blocks
SIMOCODE pro
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 8-15
8.7 Emergency start
Description
The emergency start deletes the thermal memory from SIMOCODE pro
each time it is activated. This enables the motor to restart immediately after
an overload tripping.
This function can be used to:
make an immediate restart/reset possible after an overload switch-off
influence the operation of the thermal memory (motor model) if required.
Since the emergency start is edge-triggered, it is not possible for this
function to continuously affect the thermal motor model.
The emergency start is carried out as follows:
Via the input. In order to do this, the inputs (plugs) must be connected to any
sockets (e.g. device inputs, control bits from PROFIBUS DP, etc.).
The Emergency start function block consists of:
1 Input
1 Status - emergency start carried out output. It is set when the emer-
gency start is carried out.
In total there is:
1 emergency start function block for BU1 and BU2.
Schematic
Figure 8-8: Emergency start schematic
Settings
1) The Emergency start carried out signal is triggered by the edge (input) and
reset when current flows.
Emergency start - Description
Input Activates the Emergency start function block using any signal
(any sockets , e.g. device inputs,
control bits from PROFIBUS DP, etc.)
Table 8-11: Emergency start settings
Input
Status -
Emergency start
Emergency start
carried out 1)
Standard Function Blocks
SIMOCODE pro
8-16 GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
8.8 Watchdog (bus monitoring, PLC/DCS monitoring)
Description
The Watchdog standard function block monitors both the communication
with the PLC using PROFIBUS DP as well as the operating status of the PLC
in the Remote operation type.
Schematic
Bus monitoring:
With this type of monitoring, Fault - Bus is generated if
Bus monitoring is active
the cyclic data transfer between the PLC and SIMOCODE pro is interrupted,
e.g. by an interruption to the PROFIBUS DP connection when in the
Remote operation type (operation type switch S1=1 and S2=1).
The Status - Bus O.K. can always be evaluated. If the SIMOCODE pro is
cyclically transferring data with PLC, the
Status - Bus O.K. is set to 1.
Figure 8-9: Bus monitoring
Response: Also see Table 8-13: Bus fault / PLC/DCS fault response and
Kapitel "Important Notes".
PLC/DCS monitoring:
With this type of monitoring, Fault - PLC/DCS is generated if
PLC/DCS monitoring is activated.
the PROFIBUS DP switches to the CLEAR status when in the Remote
operation type (operation type switch S1=1 and S2=1).
Status - PLC/DCS in Run can always be evaluated. If the PROFIBUS DP is in
the CLEAR status, the Status - PLC/DCS in Run is set to 0.
If the PLC/DCS monitoring - input is set by default to the Cyclic control -
Bit 0.7 bit, the status of the PLC is deduced from this bit alone.
Bus fault
Watchdog (Bus monit.)
Bus/PLC-fault - Reset
Bus monitoring
Cyclic communication
Status - Bus O.K.
(Bus active)
Bus response
Standard Function Blocks
SIMOCODE pro
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 8-17
Figure 8-10: PLC/DCS monitoring
Response: See also Table 8-13: Bus fault / PLC/DCS fault response and
Kapitel "Important Notes".
Bus fault / PLC/DCS fault response
Table 8-13: Bus fault / PLC/DCS fault response
Watchdog - Description
PLC/DCS monito-
ring - input
Activates the Watchdog function block using the monitored
signal
(optional sockets , e.g. control bits from PROFIBUS DP, etc.)
Bus monitoring Activated:
If a bus fault occurs, the Fault - Bus fault message is genera-
ted, which must be acknowledged
Deactivated:
No fault message
Monitoring
PLC/DCS
Activated:
If an SPS fault occurs, the Fault - PLC/DCS fault message is
generated, which must be acknowledged
Deactivated:
No fault message
Bus/PLC fault -
reset
You can select whether the faults are acknowledged automatically
or manually.
Range: Manual / automatic
Table 8-12: Watchdog settings
Response Bus fault PLC/DCS fault
Fault X X
Warning - -
Signal - -
Not active X X
PLC/DCS monitoring - input
Fault - PLC/DCS
Watchdog (PLC/DCS monit.)
Bus/PLC-fault - Reset
Bus monitoring
Cyclic communication
Status - PLC/DCS in Run
(level sensitive)
PLC/DCS monitoring
Standard Function Blocks
SIMOCODE pro
8-18 GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
8.9 Timestamping
8.9.1 Time stamping in the fault memory
The time stamping in the fault memory is based on the operating hours of
SIMOCODE pro (resolution: 1 s).
The Error/ Fault events and Mains on are recorded. Each of these
events is annotated with a timestamp.
Error / Fault:
The last 21 faults are stored in a ring buffer. The fault that occurs (rising edge)
is always recorded. A fault that is disappearing (falling edge) is not recorded.
Mains on:
If the most recent entry was Mains on, this is not recorded multiple times.
Rather, the fault number is used as a network-on fault. This means that the
fault memory cannot be deleted by frequent ON/OFF operations.
Entry 1 is the most recent entry and entry 21 the oldest.
The data is displayed using the SIMOCODE ES software.
Example:
Figure 8-11: Example of event recording using the SIMOCODE ES software
Screenshot
SIMOCODE pro
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 9-1
Logic Modules 9
In this chapter
In this chapter you will find information about the logic modules of
SIMOCODE pro. In addition to the predefined control functions, you can, for
example, implement logical functions, time relays functions and counter
functions.
Target groups
This chapter is addressed to the following target groups:
configurators
programmers.
Necessary knowledge
You need the following knowledge:
the principle of connecting plugs to sockets
basics of digital signal processing, e.g. timer, counter etc.
Navigation in SIMOCODE ES
You will find the dialogs in SIMOCODE ES under:
Further function blocks > Logic modules.
Logic Modules
SIMOCODE pro
9-2 GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
9.1 Introduction
Description
Freely programmable logic modules are function blocks that process input
signals and provide digital output signals. Logic modules can contain:
inputs (plugs )
an internal logic component
outputs (sockets )
settings, e.g. the time for a timer.
Schematic
The following schematic shows a general representation of a logic module:
Figure 9-1: General representation of a logic module
Extent and application
If you need any other additional functions for your application, you can use
the logic modules. These can be used, for example, to implement logical
functions, time relay functions and counter functions.
Depending on the device series, the system provides several logic modules:
SIMOCODE
BU1
Number
BU2
Number
Truth tables for 3 inputs/1 output 3 6
Truth tables for 2 inputs/1 output 2
Truth tables for 5 inputs/2 outputs 1
Timers 2 4
Counters 2 4
Signal conditioners 2 4
Non-volatile elements 2 4
Flashing 3 3
Flickering 3 3
Limit monitor 4
Table 9-1: Logic modules which can be programmed freely
Logic module
Input 1
Input n
Output
(Logic component)
Setting
Logic Modules
SIMOCODE pro
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 9-3
9.2 Truth table for 3I/1O
Description
The truth table for 3I/1O contains
3 inputs
a logic component
1 output.
You can choose among 8 possible input conditions with which you want to
create an output signal.
In total there are:
3 truth tables, 1 to 3, for BU1
6 truth tables, 1 to 6, for BU2
Schematic
Figure 9-2: Schematic truth tables for 3I/1O
Truth table1, 3I/1O
Input 1
Input 2
Input 3
Output
Truth table 3, 3I/1O
Input 1
Input 2
Input 3
Output
Truth table 5, 3I/1O
Input 1
Input 2
Input 3
Output
Truth table 2, 3I/1O
Input 1
Input 2
Input 3
Output
Truth table 4, 3I/1O
Input 1
Input 2
Input 3
Output
Truth table 6, 3I/1O
Input 1
Input 2
Input 3
Output
Logic Modules
SIMOCODE pro
9-4 GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
Example
You want to implement the following circuit:
Figure 9-3: Example of a truth table
Truth table, input conditions colored in gray:
S1=
Input 1
S2=
Input 2
S3=
Input 3
K1=
Output
0 0 0 0
0 0 1 0
0 1 0 0
0 1 1 1
1 0 0 0
1 0 1 1
1 1 0 0
1 1 1 1
S1 S2
S3
K1
Circuit:
K1 switches with:
(S1 or S2) and S3
or
S1 and S2 and S3
Logic Modules
SIMOCODE pro
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 9-5
Switching and parameterizing
Figure 9-4: Example circuit and parameterization for truth table for 3I/1O
Settings
Truth table for 1-6
3I/1O -
Description
Input 1 to 3 Activate the truth table with any signal
(any sockets
e.g. device inputs, control bits from PROFIBUS DP, etc.)
Table 9-2: Settings for 3I/1O truth table
S2
S3
S1
Circuit:
1
2
BU output
Out1
3
Truth table 1, 3I/1O
Input 1
Input 2
Input 3
Output
BU input
1
2
3
4
L1
N
K1
BU
Connecting inputs, i.e.
connecting the plugs with the sockets
Setting of bits
Parameterization with SIMOCODE ES
for output signals
Logic Modules
SIMOCODE pro
9-6 GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
9.3 Truth table for 2I/1O
Description
The truth table for 2I/1O contains
2 inputs
a logic component
1 output.
You can choose among 4 possible input conditions with which you want to
create an output signal.
In total there are:
2 truth tables 7 to 8 for BU2
Schematic
Figure 9-5: Schematic for 2I/1O truth tables
Example
You want to implement the following circuit:
Figure 9-6: Example for 2I/1O truth table
Truth table 7 2I/1O
Input 1
Input 2
Output
Truth table 8 2I/1O
Input 1
Input 2
Output
Truth table, input conditions
colored in gray:
S1=
Input 1
S2=
Input 2
K1=
Output
0 0 0
0 1 1
1 0 1
1 1 1
S1 S2
K1
Circuit:
K1 switches with :
S1 or S2
Logic Modules
SIMOCODE pro
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 9-7
9.4 Truth table for 5I/2O
Description
The truth table 5I/2O contains
5 inputs
a logic component
2 outputs.
You can choose among 32 possible input conditions with which you want to
create up to 2 output signals.
In total there are:
1 truth table 9 for BU2.
Schematic
Figure 9-7: Schematic 5I/2O truth table
Settings
Truth table 9 for 5I/
2O -
Description
Input 1 to 5 Activation by any signal
(any sockets
e.g. device inputs, control bits from PROFIBUS DP, etc.)
Table 9-3: Settings for truth table for 5I/2O
Input 1
Input 2
Input 3
Output 1
Input 4
Input 5
Output 2
Truth table 9 for 5I/2O
Logic Modules
SIMOCODE pro
9-8 GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
9.5 Counters
Description
Counters are integrated in the SIMOCODE pro system. These are activated
via the inputs + or -.
The counter output switches to 1 when the preset limit is reached. The
counter is reset with Reset.
The current count value can be read out cyclically via the bus. It must be
entered as an analog value.
Input +: increases actual value by 1
Input : decreases actual value by 1 (minimum: 0).
Reset: resets the actual value to 0.
The counter contains
3 inputs (input +, input and reset)
a counter function
1 output.
In total there are:
2 counters 1 to 2 for BU1
4 counters 1 to 4 for BU2
Schematic
Figure 9-8: Schematic counter
Notes
Please observe the following notes:
The time between the events to be counted depends on
the input delay
the device cycle time (see chapter Technical data).
The actual value remains the same
during parameterization or failure of supply voltage
if there is a simultaneous input signal at input + and input -.
Notice:
When a reset is pending, the output is always 0.
Counter 1
Input +
Input
Reset
Output
Counter 2
Input +
Input
Reset
Output
Limit Limit
Counter 3
Input +
Input
Reset
Output
Counter 4
Input +
Input
Reset
Output
Limit Limit
Logic Modules
SIMOCODE pro
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 9-9
Settings
Counter 1 to 4 - Description
Input + Increases the actual value by 1
Activation by any signal
(any sockets
e.g. device inputs, control bits from PROFIBUS DP, etc.)
Input Decreases the actual value by 1.
Activation by any signal
(any sockets
e.g. device inputs, control bits from PROFIBUS DP, etc.)
Reset Resets the counter to 0 (count value and output)
Activation by any signal
(any sockets
e.g. device inputs, control bits from PROFIBUS DP, etc.)
Limit The maximum value that can be reached when counting and where
the counter provides an output signal.
Range: 0 to 65535
Table 9-4: Counter settings
Logic Modules
SIMOCODE pro
9-10 GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
9.6 Timer
Description of function
The timer contains
2 inputs (input and reset)
1 output.
If there is an input signal, the timer can provide an output signal with the
output response
with closing delay
with closing delay with memory
with off delay
with fleeting closing.
In total there are:
2 timers 1 to 2 for BU1
4 timers 1 to 4 for BU2
timer current value.
Schematic
Figure 9-9: Schematic of timer
Note
The output is always 0 following a reset.
Timer 1
Input
Reset
Output
Value
Type
Timer 2
Input
Reset
Output
Value
Type
Timer 3
Input
Reset
Output
Value
Type
Timer 4
Input
Reset
Output
Value
Type
Logic Modules
SIMOCODE pro
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 9-11
Output response
Figure 9-10: Output response of the timer
With closing delay:
Input
Reset
Time
Output
Closing delay with memory:
Input
Reset
Time
Output
With OFF delay:
Input
Reset
Time
Output
With fleeting closing:
Input
Reset
Time
Output
t t
t
t t
t
Logic Modules
SIMOCODE pro
9-12 GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
Settings
Timer 1 to 4 - Description
Input Activation by any signal
(any sockets ,
e.g. device inputs, control bits from PROFIBUS DP, etc.)
Reset Resets the timer to 0.
Activation by any signal
(any sockets ,
e.g. device inputs, control bits from PROFIBUS DP, etc.)
Type Various output responses
Range: with closing delay, closing delay with memory, with OFF
delay, with fleeting closing
Value Time during which the timer provides an output signal when activa-
ted, depending on the output response (type).
Range: 0 to 65535, unit 100 ms
Table 9-5: Timer settings
Logic Modules
SIMOCODE pro
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 9-13
9.7 Signal conditioner
Description
If there is an input signal, the signal conditioner can provide an output signal
with the output response
not inverting
inverting
edge rising with memory
edge falling with memory
You can select the type of output response.
The signal conditioner contains
2 inputs (input and reset)
a logic
1 output.
In total there are:
2 signal conditioners for BU1 (signal conditioner 1 to 2)
4 signal conditioners for BU2 (signal conditioner 1 to 4).
Schematic
Figure 9-11: Schematic of the signal conditioner
Note
The output is always 0 following a reset.
Signal conditioner 1
Input
Reset
Output
Type
Signal conditioner 2
Input
Reset
Output
Type
Signal conditioner 3
Input
Reset
Output
Type
Signal conditioner 4
Input
Reset
Output
Type
Logic Modules
SIMOCODE pro
9-14 GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
Types of signals/output responses
Figure 9-12: Types of signals/output response of the signal conditioners
Level inverting
Edge rising with memory
Edge falling with memory
Input
Output
Reset
Input
Output
Reset
Input
Output
Reset
Level not inverting
Input
Output
Reset
Logic Modules
SIMOCODE pro
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 9-15
NOR function
You can implement a NOR function with the signal type Level inverted:
Table 9-6: NOR function
Settings
Input Reset Output Schematic
0 0 1
1 0 0
0 1 0
1 1 0
Signal conditioner
1 to 4 -
Description
Input Activation by any signal
(any sockets ,
e.g. device inputs, control bits from PROFIBUS DP, etc.)
Reset Resets the signal conditioner to 0.
Activation by any signal
(any sockets ,
e.g. device inputs, control bits from PROFIBUS DP, etc.)
Type Different output responses
Range:
Level not inverted, level inverted without memory, edge rising with
memory, edge falling with memory
Table 9-7: Signal condition settings
Input
Reset
Output
>
=
1
Logic Modules
SIMOCODE pro
9-16 GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
9.8 Non-volatile elements
Description
Non-volatile elements behave like signal conditioners.
The output signals remain after failure of the supply voltage.
If there is an input signal, the signal conditioner can provide an output signal
with the output response
not inverting
inverting
edge rising with memory
edge falling with memory
You can set the output response.
The non-volatile element contains
2 inputs (input and reset)
a logic
1 output.
In total there are:
2 non-volatile elements1 to 2 for BU1
4 non-volatile elements1 to 4 for BU2
Schematic
Figure 9-13: Schematic for non-volatile elements
Note
The output is always 0 following a reset.
Non-volat. elem. 1
Input
Reset
Output
Type
Non-volat. elem. 2
Input
Reset
Output
Type
Non-volat. elem. 1
Input
Reset
Output
Type
Non-volat. elem. 2
Input
Reset
Output
Type
Logic Modules
SIMOCODE pro
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 9-17
Types of signals/output responses
Figure 9-14: Signal types/output responses of non-volatile elements
Level inverted
Edge rising with memory
Edge falling with memory
Input
Output
Reset
Input
Output
Reset
Input
Ausgang
Reset
Level not inverted
Input
Output
Reset
Voltage failure
Voltage failure
Logic Modules
SIMOCODE pro
9-18 GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
NOR function
You can implement a NOR function with the level inverted type of signal:
Table 9-8: NOR function
Settings
Input Reset Output Schematic
0 0 1
1 0 0
0 1 0
1 1 0
Non-volatile
elements
1 to 4 -
Description
Input Activation by any signal
(any sockets
e.g. device inputs, control bits from PROFIBUS DP, etc.)
Reset Resets the signal conditioner to 0.
Activation by any signal
(any sockets
e.g. device inputs, control bits from PROFIBUS DP, etc.)
Type Different output responses
Range: Level not inverted, level inverted without memory, edge
rising with memory, edge falling with memory
Table 9-9: Non-volatile elements settings
Input
Reset
Output
>
=
1
Logic Modules
SIMOCODE pro
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 9-19
9.9 Flashing
Description
With the flashing function blocks, you can e.g. assign the flashing
function to the operator panel LEDs (for example).
The flashing function block provides an output signal with a frequency of
2 Hz if there is an input signal. The function block contains
1 input
flashing frequency
1 output.
In total there are:
3 flash function blocks, 1 to 3, for BU1 and BU2.
Schematic
Figure 9-15: Schematic for flashing
Settings
Flashing 1 to 3 - Description
Input Activation by any signal
(any sockets ,
e.g. device inputs, signals, status, etc.)
Table 9-10: Flashing settings
Flashing 1
Input
Output
Flashing 2
Input
Output
Flashing 3
Input
Output
Logic Modules
SIMOCODE pro
9-20 GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
9.10 Flickering
Description
With the flickering function blocks, you can e.g. assign the flickering
function to the operator panel LEDs (for example).
The flickering function block provides an output signal with a frequency of
4 Hz if there is an input signal.
The function block contains
1 input
flickering frequency
1 output.
In total there are:
3 flickering functions, 1 to 3, for BU1 and BU2.
Schematic
Figure 9-16: Schematic for flickering
Settings
Flickering 1 to 3 - Description
Input Activation by any signal
(any sockets ,
e.g. signals, etc.)
Table 9-11: Flickering settings
Flickering 1
Input
Output
Flickering 2
Input
Output
Flickering 3
Input
Output
Logic Modules
SIMOCODE pro
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 9-21
9.11 Limit monitor
Description
Any analog signals (length: 2 bytes) can be monitored for limit overshooting
or undershooting. The limit monitor provides a Signal - limit output signal.
Example: Monitoring the mains voltage for overvoltage.
The limit monitor contains
1 analog input
a logic component
1 output.
In total there are:
4 limit monitors 1 to 4 for BU2
Schematic
Figure 9-17: Schematic of limit monitor
Response
Table 9-12: Response of the limits
See also Tables of responses of SIMOCODE pro in chapter "Important
Notes".
Response Limit 1 to 4
Switch off -
Warn -
Signal X (d)
Disabled -
Delay 0 to 25.5 s
Limit monitor 1
Signal - Type
Limit
Effectiveness
(Labeling)
Limit value 1
Input (analog)
Limit monitor 2
Signal - Type
Limit
Effectiveness
Limit value 2
Input (analog)
Limit monitor 3
Signal - Type
Limit
Effectiveness
Limit value 3
Input (analog)
Limit monitor 4
Signal - Type
Limit
Effectiveness
Limit value 4
Input (analog)
Response
(Labeling)
Response
(Labeling)
Response
(Labeling)
Response
Logic Modules
SIMOCODE pro
9-22 GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
Settings
Functional principle
The limit signal issued depends on
the operating state of the motor
the TPF function
the parmeterized effectiveness:
on
on+
run
run+.
Limit monitor - Description
Input
(analog, 2 bytes)
Activation of the word via any analog signals
(any sockets ,
e.g. maximum current Imax, remaining cooling time, actual value of
timers, etc.)
Type Specifies if the limit has to be monitored for overshooting or
undershooting.
Effectiveness Determines in what motor operating state the limit monitor is to be
analyzed:
on, i.e. always analyze, independent of whether the motor is run-
ning or not (default)
on+, i.e. always analyze, independent of whether the motor is
running or not
Exception: 'TPF', i.e. motor feeder is in test position.
run, i.e., analyze only if the motor is in the ON state (TPF)
run+, i.e. analyze only if the motor is running and the start-up pro-
cedure is finished (i.e. the Start active message is not applied)
and there is no test position (TPF); Example: Monitoring the
power factor
Limit Operating value of monitoring. The return value is always determi-
ned by the Limit monitor - delay parameter.
Range: 0 to 65535.
Delay Specifies the time period for which the limit must be constantly
exceeded before the Signal - limit output is set.
Range: 0 to 25.5 seconds.
Table 9-13: Limit monitor settings
Logic Modules
SIMOCODE pro
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 9-23
The following display shows a flow chart with the different effectiveness
parameters.
Figure 9-18: Functional principle of the limit monitor
Off Start Motor is running Off
On
On+
Run
Run+
Class-time
Not with TPF
Not with TPF
Not with TPF
Logic Modules
SIMOCODE pro
9-24 GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
SIMOCODE pro
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 10-1
Communication 10
In this chapter
In this chapter you will find information about the possibilities of SIMO-
CODE pro communication, e.g. with a PLC. The presetting of the control,
signaling and diagnostic data is sufficient for almost all applications so that
the parameterization only has to be changed a little. Otherwise, you can
adapt the settings of the individual bits specifically for your application.
Target groups
This chapter is addressed to the following target groups:
configurators
PLC programmers.
Necessary knowledge
You need the following knowledge:
the principle of connecting plugs to sockets
knowledge about PROFIBUS DP.
Navigation in SIMOCODE ES
You will find the following dialogs in SIMOCODE ES:
Device parameters > Bus parameters
Further function blocks > Outputs >Acyclic signaling data
Further function blocks >Outputs >Cyclic signaling data
Communication
SIMOCODE pro
10-2 GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
10.1 Introduction
10.1.1 Definitions
PROFIBUS DP
PROFIBUS bus system with the DP protocol. DP stands for decentralized
periphery. The main task of PROFIBUS DP is fast cyclic data exchange bet-
ween the central DP master and the periphery devices.
PROFIBUS DPV1
PROFIBUS DPV1 is an extension of the DP protocol. With this, acyclic data
exchange of parameter, diagnostic, control and test data is also possible.
DP master
A master is designated as a DP master if it works with the DP protocol
according to the EN 50 170 norm, volume 2, PROFIBUS.
Class 1 master
A class 1 master is an active station on the PROFIBUS DP. Characteristic is
the cyclic data exchange with other stations. Typical class 1 masters are, for
example, PLCs with a PROFIBUS DP connection.
Class 2 master
A class 2 master is an optional station on the PROFIBUS DP. Typical class 2
masters are, for example,
PC/programing devices with the SIMOCODE-ES professional software
SIMATIC PDM (PCS7)
PC with SIMARIS manager software (power management).
DPV1 slave
A slave is designated as a DPV1 slave if it is operated on the PROFIBUS bus
with the PROFIBUS DP protocol and works according to the EN 50 170
norm, volume 2, PROFIBUS.
GSD (device data)
Device data (GSD) contains DP slave descriptions in a standard format.
Using GSD (device data) makes it easier to parameterize the DP slave in a
DP master system.
OM SIMOCODE pro
OM SIMOCODE pro (object manager) is used instead of GSD (device data)
to integrate SIMOCODE pro into STEP 7.
OM SIMOCODE pro enables the use of SIMOCODE ES Professional (if it is
installed) for parameterizing within STEP7.
Communication
SIMOCODE pro
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 10-3
SIMOCODE pro S7 slave
SIMOCODE pro S7 slave is a slave which is fully integrated into Step7 and
has the following characteristics. It is connected via OM SIMOCODE pro
instead of GSD (device data). It supports the S7 model (diagnostic alarms,
process alarms)
Writing data
Writing data means that data is transmitted to the SIMOCODE pro system.
Reading data
Reading data means that data is transmitted from the SIMOCODE pro
system.
Communication
SIMOCODE pro
10-4 GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
10.2 Transmitting data
Options for data transfer
The following figure shows the options for data transfer:
Figure 10-1: Options for data transfer
Communication principle
The following figure shows the communication principle where, depending
on the master and slave modes of operation, different data is transmitted:
Figure 10-2: Communication principle
Class 2 master
PC or programming device
with SIMOCODE ES Profes-
sional
Class 1 master
SIMATIC S7 with PROFIBUS DP
communication processor
PROFIBUS DPV1 norm extension: parameterizing,
diagnostics, controlling, signaling, testing via
PROFIBUS DPV1
PC/programming device e.g. with
SIMOCODE ES Smart
Parameterizing, diagnostics, controlling, signaling,
testing via system interface
Data transfer to class 1
master, depending on the
slave mode of operation:
(table below, slave
modes of operation)
Maximum of two
class 2 masters
possible
PLC
3UF7
PLC-CPU
Communication processor
Cycl. signalingdata
Cycl. control data
Configuration
Cyclic I/O Acyclic
GSD
Parameters
Start-up
parameter
block
Acyclic
DPV1
Class 1 master
Acyclic
PC or DCS
e.g.
SIMOCODE ES
Professional
Class 2 master (max. 2)
SIMOCODE pro
Diagnostics Alarms
DPV0
DPV1
Datarecords Datarecords
PLC-CPU
Communication processor
Cycl. signalingdata
Cycl. control data
Configuration
Cyclic I/O Acyclic
GSD
Parameters Parameters
Start-up
parameter
block
Acyclic
DPV1
Class 1 master
Acyclic
PC or DCS
e.g.
SIMOCODE ES
Professional
Class 2 master (max. 2)
SIMOCODE pro
Diagnostics Alarms
DPV0
Diagnostics Diagnostics Alarms Alarms
DPV0
DPV1
Datarecords Datarecords Datarecords Datarecords Datarecords Datarecords
Communication
SIMOCODE pro
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 10-5
Slave modes of operation
The following table shows an overview of the slave modes of operation
which SIMOCODE pro can be operated with on the class 1 master:
Figure 10-3: Slave modes of operation of SIMOCODE pro
Preparing the data transfer
SIMOCODE pro must be connected to a DP master system for data trans-
fer.
For this, you must configure in two places:
You must decide on one of the options in the above-mentioned table
(GSD (device data) or OM)
You must prepare SIMOCODE pro e.g. with SIMOCODE ES. There you can
set the following parameters in the dialog Device parameters > Bus para-
meters:
DP address
diagnostics
start-up parameter block
SIMOCODE pro
connected as:
Class 1 master Class 1 master S7 master
DP master
manufacturer-
independent,
without DPV1 alarms
DP master
manufacturer-
independent,
with DPV1 alarms
DPV1 slave
via GSD (device
data)
Cyclical data transfer
Norm diagnostics
Status messages
Parameterization star-
ting (only BU1)
Acyclic writing and rea-
ding of DPV1 data
records (if supported by
the master)
Cyclic data transfer
Norm diagnostics
Status messages
Process and diagnostic
alarm
Parameterization star-
ting (only BU1)
Acyclic writing and rea-
ding of DPV1 data
records
Cyclic data transfer
Norm diagnostics
Status messages
Process and diagnostic
alarm
Parameterization star-
ting (only BU1)
Acyclic writing and rea-
ding of DPV1 data
records
S7 slave
via OM
SIMOCODE ES

Cyclic data transfer
Norm diagnostics
Process and diagnostic
alarm
Parameterization star-
ting
Acyclic writing and rea-
ding of DPV1 data
records
Communication
SIMOCODE pro
10-6 GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
10.3 Configuring SIMOCODE pro
10.3.1 Configuring with a GSD file
Definition of GSD
Device data (GSD) contain DP slave descriptions in a standard format. Using
GSD (device data) makes it easier to configure the DP master and the DP
slave.
Connecting SIMOCODE pro as a norm slave with a GSD file
You configure SIMOCODE pro via the GSD file. SIMOCODE pro is connec-
ted as a standard slave in your system via the GSD file.
You can download the GSD file
from the Internet under
http://www.ad.siemens.de/csi_d/gsd (under Schaltgerte i.e. switchgear).
via a modem under the telephone number +49 (0)911 737972.
The following GSD files are available for SIMOCODE pro C:
SI0180FD.GSG (German)
SI0180FD.GSE (English)
The following GSD files are available for SIMOCODE pro V:
SI1180FD.GSG (German)
SI1180FD.GSE (English)
Attention
If you want to use the complete functionality of SIMOCODE pro
(e.g. timestamping), your configuration tool must support GSD files - rev.5,
like e.g. STEP7 V5.3 and higher.
Communication
SIMOCODE pro
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 10-7
Integrating the GSD file into the configuration software
The following table describes how to integrate the GSD file into
SIMATIC S7:
Table 10-1: Integrating the GSD file into the configuration software
Parameterizing via GSD
Attention
Parameterization via GSD is only designed for SIMOCODE pro C.
The GSD for SIMOCODE pro V does not contain any device parameters.
Step STEP 7, from V5.1 + SP2
1 Start STEP 7 and call the menu command
Extras > Install new GSD file in the HW configuration.
2 In the following dialog, select the GSD file to be installed and confirm
with OK.
Result:
The field device is displayed in the hardware catalog in the PROFIBUS DP
directory.
Insert from the SIMOCODE pro hardware catalog under
Further field devices >Switchgear > SIMOCODE pro >
SIMOCODE pro V (GSD) (device data) or
SIMOCODE pro C (GSD) (device data) on the PROFIBUS.
3 Configure SIMOCODE pro with STEP 7 (see integrated help in STEP 7).
Communication
SIMOCODE pro
10-8 GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
10.3.2 Configuring with the SIMOCODE ES software
You can also configure SIMOCODE pro via the SIMOCODE ES software.
There are several options available for this:
SIMOCODE ES Smart, for parameterizing via system interface.
Order number: 3ZS1 312-1CC10-0YA0
SIMOCODE ES Professional, for parameterizing via the DPV1 interface and
system interface. This version contains the object manager (OM)
SIMOCODE pro. This enables the connection of SIMOCODE pro as an S7
slave in STEP7 and the integration in STEP7.
Order number: 3ZS1 312-2CC10-0YA0.
There you will find SIMOCODE pro under Switchgear > SIMOCODE pro.
10.3.3 Configuring with SIMATIC PDM
You can also configure SIMOCODE pro via the SIMATIC PDM
(Process Device Manager) software.
There are several options available for this:
SIMATIC PDM as a stand-alone program
Prerequisite:
Programming device/PC with PROFIBUS DP interface which is supported by
SIMATIC PDM. SIMOCODE pro is parameterized via PROFIBUS DP.
SIMATIC PDM integrated into STEP7
Prerequisite for data record routing:
SIMATIC S7-400 with PROFIBUS DP interface connection which supports the
whole data record routing for the parameterization of field devices
(CP443-5 Extended) or with IE/PB link.
Note
Note that the parameter block must be set so that the parameters will not
be overwritten by the start-up parameterization!
Communication
SIMOCODE pro
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 10-9
10.4 Telegram description
Cyclic data
The cyclic data is exchanged once every DP cycle between the
PROFIBUS DP master and DP slave. The PROFIBUS DP master module
then sends the control data to SIMOCODE pro. As a response,
SIMOCODE pro sends the signaling data to the master module.
By parameterizing SIMOCODE pro, you can select between two basic types
which determine the contents of the cyclic data:
Cyclic data from the PROFIBUS DP master to SIMOCODE pro:
Cyclic data from SIMOCODE pro to the PROFIBUS DP master:
Diagnostic data/alarms
The diagnostic data contains important information about the status of
SIMOCODE pro. This simplifies troubleshooting.
In contrast to the cyclic data, the diagnostic data is only transmitted to the
master module if it changes.
PROFIBUS DP differentiates between:
Norm diagnostics
Status messages
Process and diagnostic alarms according to DPV1.
You will find the detailed description in the appendix.
Specification Length Specification Info
Basic type 1
(available from the middle
of 2005)
4 bytes control data Cyclic controlling - bit
0.0 to 1.7 BU2
Cyclic controlling - ana-
log value
Basic type 2 2 bytes control data Cyclic controlling - bit
0.0 to 1.7
BU1
BU2
Specification Length Specification Info
Basic type 1
(available from the middle
of 2005)
10 bytes
Signaling data
Cyclic signaling - bit 0.0
to 1.7 BU2
Cyclic signaling - analog
input 1 to 4
Basic type 2 4 bytes signaling
data
Cyclic signaling - bit 0.0
to 1.7 BU1
BU2
Cyclic signaling - analog
input 1
Communication
SIMOCODE pro
10-10 GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
Starting up parameter data
For every start-up of SIMOCODE pro on PROFIBUS DP, parameters are
transmitted to the device.
Depending on the master module used, norm parameters or norm parame-
ters + SIMOCODE pro parameters are transmitted.
Notice:
If the effective device parameters of SIMOCODE pro are overwritten by the
start-up parameters, start-up parameter block = no must be set. For start-up
parameter block = yes, the start-up parameters are discarded and the effec-
tive SIMOCODE pro parameters remain active.
The start-up parameters are set with
the configuration tool when the GSD file is loaded (only BU1)
with OM SIMOCODE ES Professional (when connected as an S7 slave).
Acyclic writing and reading of data records
You can use these functions according to DPV1 if the DP master supports
this. Part of these are the acyclic DPV1 services for reading and writing data
records. With this, operator control, process monitoring and parameteriza-
tion is possible during runtime.
10.5 Process image (cyclic data) and data records (acyclic
data)
Process image
The process image is part of the system memory of the DP master. At the
start of the cyclic program, the signal states of the inputs are transmitted to
the process image of the inputs. At the end of the cyclic program, the pro-
cess image of the outputs is transferred as a signal state to the DP slave.
Data records
Data records contain additional information which can only be read/partly
written. Data record 67 contains the information about the process image of
the outputs. Data record 69 contains the information about the process
image of the inputs. Both these data records can only be read.
You will find further information on the data records in chapter "Data For-
mats and Data Records" starting from page B-1.
Communication
SIMOCODE pro
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 10-11
10.6 Diagnostics with STEP 7
10.6.1 Reading out the diagnostics
Length of the diagnostic telegram
The telegram has a maximum length of 62 bytes.
Options for reading out the diagnostics
Table 10-2: Reading out the diagnostics with STEP 7
Example for reading out the S7 diagnostics with SFC 13 DP NRM_DG
Here you will find an example of how to read out the slave diagnostics for a
DP slave in the STEP 7 user program with the SFC 13.
Assumptions
The following assumptions apply for this STEP 7 user program:
The diagnostic address is 1022 (3FE
H
).
The slave diagnostics should be stored in DB82: From the address 0.0,
length 62 bytes.
The slave diagnostics consist of 62 bytes.
STEP 7 user program
Automation system
with DP master
Block or register
in STEP 7
Application See...
SIMATIC S7/M7 SFC 13
DP NRM_DG
Reading out slave diagnostics
(store in the data region of the
user program)
chapter "Configuring the
slave diagnostics" on
page 10-12; SFC see
online help in STEP 7
STL (statement list) Explanation
CALL SFC 13
REQ :=TRUE
LADDR :=W#16#3FE
RET_VAL :=MW0
RECORD :=P#DB82.DBX 0.0 BYTE 62
BUSY :=M2.0
read request
diagnostic address
RET_VAL from SFC 13
data compartment for diagnostics in the DB82
read process runs over several OB1 cycles
Communication
SIMOCODE pro
10-12 GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
10.6.2 Configuring the slave diagnostics
Configuring the slave diagnostics
Figure 10-4: Configuring the slave diagnostics
Attention
The length of the diagnostic telegram varies between 28 and 62 bytes.
You will find the length of the last diagnostic telegram received in
STEP 7 from the RET_VAL parameter of the SFC 13.
.
.
.
.
.
.
Station status 1 to 3
Master PROFIBUS address
High byte
Low byte
Manufacturer's

Identification-related diagnostics
Status message
Channel-related diagnostics
(3 bytes per entry)
Byte 1
Byte 2
Byte 3
Byte 4
Byte 5
Byte 6
Byte 9
Byte 28
Byte 29
Byte 30
Byte 31
up to max.
Byte 34
D
e
t
a
i
l
s
Byte 7
Byte 8
up to max.
Byte 62
Byte 35
Alarms
.
.
.
OB40
OB82
.
.
.
.
.
.
identification
Communication
SIMOCODE pro
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 10-13
10.6.3 Station status 1 to 3
Definition
Station status 1 to 3 gives an overview of the state of a
DP slave.
Station status 1
Table 10-3: Configuring the station status 1 (byte 0)
Bit Meaning Cause/corrective measures
0 1: The DP slave cannot be addressed by
the DP master.
Is the correct PROFIBUS address set on the DP
slave?
Is the bus connection plug connected?
Voltage on the DP slave?
RS-485 repeater configured correctly?
Reset implemented on the DP slave?
1 1: The DP slave is not yet ready for the
data transfer.
Wait, as the DP slave is just starting-up.
2 1: The configuration data sent from the DP
master to the DP slave does not corre-
spond to the configuration of the
DP slave.
Correct station type or correct configuration of
the DP slave in the configuration software?
3 1: There are external diagnostics present
(general diagnostic display)
Evaluate the identification-related diagnostics,
the status messages and/or the channel-related
diagnostics. As soon as all errors are rectified,
bit 3 is reset. The bit is reset if there is a new
diagnostic message in the bytes of the above-
mentioned diagnostics.
4 1: The function required is not supported
by the DP slave (e.g. changing the PRO-
FIBUS address via software).
Check the configuration.
5 1: DP master cannot interpret the
response of the DP slave.
Check the bus configuration.
6 1: The DP slave type does not correspond
to the software configuration.
Is the correct station type entered in the confi-
guration software?
7 1: The DP slave has been parameterized by
another DP master (not by the DP
master which has access to the DP
slave at the moment).
Bit is always 1 when you are e.g. accessing the
DP slave from the programming device or from
another DP master.
The PROFIBUS address of the DP master which
parameterized the DP slave is in the Master
PROFIBUS address diagnostic byte.
Communication
SIMOCODE pro
10-14 GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
Station status 2
Table 10-4: Configuring station status 2 (byte 1)
Station status 3
Table 10-5: Configuring station status 3 (byte 2)
Bit Meaning
0 1: The DP slave must be parameterized anew.
1 1: There is a diagnostic message. The DP slave does not work until the error is
rectified (static diagnostic message).
2 1: The bit is always 1 when the slave is present with this PROFIBUS address.
3 1: The address monitoring is activated for this slave.
4 1: The DP slave received the FREEZE control command
1)
.
5 1: The DP slave received the SYNC control command
1)
.
6 0: Bit is always 0.
7 1: The DP slave is deactivated, i.e. it is decoupled from the current
processing.
1) Bit is only updated if another diagnostic message is changed.
Bit Meaning
0 to 6 0: Bits are always 0.
7 1: There are more diagnostic messages than the DP slave can save.
The DP master cannot enter all diagnostic messages sent from the
DP slave into its diagnostic buffer (channel-related diagnostics).
Communication
SIMOCODE pro
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 10-15
10.6.4 Master PROFIBUS address
Definition
The PROFIBUS address of the DP master (class 1 master) is stored in the
Master PROFIBUS address diagnostic byte:
which the DP slave parameterized and
which has read and write access to the DP slave.
The master PROFIBUS address is in byte 4 of the slave diagnostics.
10.6.5 Manufacturer's identification
Definition
There is a code stored in the manufacturer's identification which describes
the DP slave type.
Manufacturer's identification
Table 10-6: Configuration of the manufacturer's identification
Byte 5 Byte 6 Manufacturer's identification for
80
H
FD
H
SIMOCODE pro
Communication
SIMOCODE pro
10-16 GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
10.6.6 Identification-related diagnostics
Definition
The identification-related diagnostics begins at byte 7 and is 2 bytes long.
Identification-related diagnostics
The identification-related diagnostics is configured as follows:
Figure 10-5: Configuration of the identification-related diagnostics
0 1 0 0 0 0 1 0
7 6 5 0
Byte 7
Bit number:
= 0x42
Length of the identification-related diagnostics
including byte 6 (= 2 bytes)
Code for identification-related diagnostics
0 0 0 0 0 0 0 x
7 6 5 0
Byte 8
Bit number
0: Identification-related diagnostics are not available
1: Identification-related diagnostics are available
0 0 0 0 0 0 0 x
7 6 5 0
Byte 8
Bit number
0: Identification-related diagnostics are not available
1: Identification-related diagnostics are available
GSD (device data)
OM SIMOCODE pro
Communication
SIMOCODE pro
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 10-17
10.6.7 Status messages
Definition
The status messages yield the detailed status of SIMOCODE.
Status messages configuration
The status messages are configured as follows:
Figure 10-6: Status messages configuration
You will find the detailed messages in the section "Detailed messages of the
slave diagnostics" in chapter "Detailled signals of the slave diagnosis" on
page A-13.
0 0 0 1 0 1 0 0
7 6 5 0
Byte 9
Bit number
= 0x14
Length of the status message
including byte 9 (= 20 bytes)
7 6 5
Byte 13
Bit number
7 0
Byte 10
0x81
7 0
Byte 11
x
Byte 12
0x00
4 3 2 1 0
Slot number
Status message
GSD:
OM SIMOCODE pro: 0x04
0x01
Detailed status
.
.
.
Byte 28
Communication
SIMOCODE pro
10-18 GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
10.6.8 Channel-related diagnostics
Definition
Channel-related diagnostics give information about device errors from
SIMOCODE pro and represent a more detailed version of the identification-
related diagnostics.
Channel-related diagnostics
The channel-related diagnostics are configured as follows:
Figure 10-7: Configuring the channel-related diagnostics
Error types
The diagnostic message is signaled on channel 0.
Table 10-7: Error types
Error
numb
er
Error type Meaning/cause
F9 01001:
Error
Internal error/device error
Error on self-test
Switchgear defective
Exact information in
data record 92
F16 10000:
Parameterization
error
Incorrect parameter value
1 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
7 6 5 0
Byte 29
Bit number
Code for channel-related diagnostics
1 1 0 0 0 0 0 0
7 6 5 0
Byte 30
Bit number
Input/output channel
7 6 5 0
Byte 31
Bit number
Channel type:
Error type 9 or 16 (table below)
000
B
: No special channel type
Byte 32 to Next channel-related diagnostics message
(Allocation as for byte 29 to 31) Byte 34
0 0 0
0x80 GSD
0x83 OM SIMOCODE pro
Communication
SIMOCODE pro
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 10-19
10.6.9 Alarms
Diagnostic alarm
Device errors or parameter errors are alarm sources for diagnostic alarms.
As soon as SIMOCODE pro sets a diagnostic alarm, the OB 82 diagnostic
alarm is started in the SIMATIC-S7.
Process alarm
Process messages, warnings and errors are alarm sources for process
alarms. Configuring the process alarms is the same as for the status messa-
ges. As soon as SIMOCODE pro sets a process alarm, the OB 40 process
alarm is started in the SIMATIC-S7.
Process alarm configuration
Figure 10-8: Configuring alarm configuration
You will find the detailed messages in the section "Detailed messages of the
slave diagnostics" in chapter "Detailled signals of the slave diagnosis" on
page A-13.
0 0 0 1 0 1 0 0
7 6 5 0 Bit number
= 0x14
Length of the process alarm
including header byte (= 20 bytes)
7 6 5 Bit number
7 0
0x02
7 0
x
0x00
4 3 2 1 0
Slot number
Process alarm
GSD:
OM SIMOCODE pro: 0x04
0x01
Detailed status
.
.
.
Communication
SIMOCODE pro
10-20 GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
10.6.10 Data records - overview
Table 10-8: Data records - overview
Data record
number
Description Read/write
67 Process image of the outputs Read
69 Process image of the inputs Read
92 Device diagnostics Read
94 Measured values Read
95 Display and statistics data Read/write
130 Basic device parameter 1 Read/write
131 Basic device parameter 2 Read/write
132 Extended device parameter 1 Read/write
133 Extended device parameter 2 Read/write
139 Labeling Read/write
160 Communication parameters Read/write
165 Comment Read/write
202 Free acyclic control data Read/write
203 Free acyclic signaling data Read
224 Password protection Write
SIMOCODE pro
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 11-1
Mounting, Wiring and Interfaces 11
In this chapter
This chapter contains information about how the individual SIMOCODE pro
components are mounted and wired.
Target groups
This chapter is addressed to the following target groups:
mechanics
electricians
maintenance and service personnel.
Necessary knowledge
You need the following knowledge:
Basic general knowledge about SIMOCODE pro.
Mounting, Wiring and Interfaces
SIMOCODE pro
11-2 GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
11.1 General information about mounting and wiring
Notes
Warning
Dangerous electrical voltage! Can cause electrical shock and burns. Discon-
nect the device from the system before beginning work.
Attention
Follow the information contained in the operating manual.
Fixing lugs for screw attachments
Attention
For technical reasons, there are two sorts of mounting lugs for screw attach-
ments:
For basic units and expansion modules: Order no. 3RP1903
For current measurement modules,
45 mm and 55 mm width: Order no. 3RP1900-0B
Detachable terminals
Attention
The detachable terminals are mechanically coded and only fit in a particular
position!
Mounting, Wiring and Interfaces
SIMOCODE pro
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 11-3
11.2 Mounting
11.2.1 Mounting the basic units and expansion modules
You can attach these system components in the following manner:
Snap-on mounting onto a 35 mm standard mounting rail without requiring
tools
Snap-on mounting of the basic units onto 45 mm and 55 mm wide current
measurement modules (up to 100 A) with an integrated standard mounting
rail, without requiring tools
Screw attachment with mounting lugs (order no: 3RP1903) and screws on a
level surface.
These mounting lugs are only suitable for basic units and expansion modules!
Figure 11-1: Mounting the basic units
SIMOCODE pro C SIMOCODE pro V
with increased mounting depth
Snap-on mounting onto standard mounting rails
Screw attachment
3RP1903
5 mm
Expansion module
5 mm
3RP1903
Snap-on mounting onto the current measurement module
e.g. 45 mm wide current measurement module with BU1
Standard
BU1 BU2
mounting
rails
Mounting, Wiring and Interfaces
SIMOCODE pro
11-4 GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
11.2.2 Mounting the current measurement modules
You can attach these system components in the following manner:
Current measurement module up to 100 A: Standard mounting rail mounting
or screw attachment with mounting lugs (order no: 3RP1903-0B) and screws
on a level surface. These mounting lugs are only suitable for the current mea-
surement modules! For the current measurement modules up to 25 A you
also require an additional 25 mm long spacer.
Current measurement module up to 200 A: Standard mounting rail mounting
or screw attachment.
Current measurement modules up to 630 A screw attachment.
Figure 11-2: Mounting the current measurement modules
3RP1900-0B
3UF7100-1AA00-0
3UF7101-1AA00-0
25 mm spacer
3RP1900-0B
Snap-on mounting
3UF7102-1AA00-0
Screw attachment
45 mm wide
55 mm wide
3UF7103-1AA00-0 3UF7103-1BA00-0 3UF7104-1BA00-0
0.3 A up to 3 A
2.4 A up to 25 A 10 A up to 100 A
10 A up to 100 A 20 A up to 200 A 63 A up to 630 A
screw attachment
Snap-on mounting or
screw attachment
Snap-on mounting or
screw attachment
Mounting, Wiring and Interfaces
SIMOCODE pro
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 11-5
11.2.3 Mounting the operator panel
The operator panel is designed to be installed in the front panel of motor
control centers or in cabinet doors (for example). Carry out the following
steps:
Table 11-1: Sequence for mounting an operator panel
Figure 11-3: Mounting the operator panel
Step Description
1 Create a cutout, e.g. in the front panel or cabinet door (see diagram for
dimensions).
2 Place the operator panel in the cutout.
3 Snap the four mounting brackets onto the operator panel.
4 Lock the operator panel in position by tightly screwing the four screws of the
mounting bracket.
4x
90
+0.5
3
0
+
0
.
5
Front panel
Cutout
Switching cabinet
etc.
Operator panel Mounting bracket
door
Mounting, Wiring and Interfaces
SIMOCODE pro
11-6 GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
11.3 Wiring
11.3.1 Detachable terminals for basic units and expansion modules
Basic units and expansion modules have detachable terminals. You do not
have to detach the wiring to interchange the components!
Figure 11-4: Detachable terminals
Attention
The detachable terminals are mechanically coded and only fit in a particular
position!
Cables
The cable cross-section is the same for all devices. The following table
shows the cable cross sections, strip lengths and tightening torques of the
cables for the detachable terminals:
Table 11-2: Cable cross-sections, strip lengths and tightening torques of the cables
Detachable terminals Screwdriver Tightening torque
0.8 to 1.2 Nm
7 to 10.3 LB.IN
Strip length Cable cross-section
1 x (0.5 to 4.0) mm
2 x (0.5 to 2.5) mm
1 x (0.5 to 2.5) mm
2 x (0.5 to 1.5) mm
AWG AWG 2 x 20 to 14
Detachable terminals
Basic units Expansion modules
A
D
C
A, C, D: coded
A
C
D
M3.5
10
Solid
10 Stranded, with/without
end sleeves
Mounting, Wiring and Interfaces
SIMOCODE pro
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 11-7
Basic unit pin assignment
The following table shows the pin assignment of the detachable terminals:
Table 11-3: Detachable terminals pin assignment
Sequence for wiring the detachable terminals of basic units
Carry out the following steps:
Table 11-4: Wiring the detachable terminals of basic units
Pin Assignment
Upper terminals
1 Relay output 1 and 2
2 Relay output OUT1
3 Relay output OUT2
4 Digital input IN3
5 Digital input IN4
T2 Thermistor connection (binary PTC)
6 Relay output OUT3
7 Relay output OUT4
8 Internal 24 V DC
9 Digital input IN1
10 Digital input IN2
T1 Thermistor connection (binary PTC)
Lower terminals
A1 Pin 1 supply voltage
A2 Pin 2 supply voltage
A PROFIBUS DP Pin A
B PROFIBUS DP Pin B
SPE/PE Shielded/PE
Step Description
1 Connect the cables to the upper and lower terminals.
2 If you want to use terminals A/B for PROFIBUS DP, place the PROFIBUS DP
cable-shielding on the SPE/PE terminal.
Attention! The A/B terminals are an alternative to the 9-pole SUB-D con-
nection! Baud rates up to 1.5 MBit/s are possible!
3 Connect the system shielding to the SPE/PE terminal.
1 OUT1 2.2 3 4IN3 IN45 T2
OUT3 7 8 9IN1 IN210 T1 6
DEVICE
BUS
GEN. FAULT

TEST/
RESET
P
R
O
F
I
B
U
S

D
P
A1 A2 A B SPE/PE
24 V
SIMOCODE pro
Mounting, Wiring and Interfaces
SIMOCODE pro
11-8 GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
Digital module pin assignment
The following table shows the pin assignment of the detachable terminals:
Table 11-5: Detachable terminals pin assignment
Sequence for wiring the detachable terminals
Carry out the following steps:
Table 11-6: Wiring the detachable terminals of digital modules
Pin Assignment
Upper terminals
20 Relay output 1 and 2
21 Relay output OUT1
22 Relay output OUT2
23 Digital input IN1
24 Digital input IN2
25
Lower terminals
26 Digital input IN3
27 Digital input IN4
PE Shielding
Step Description
1 Connect the cables to the upper and lower terminals.
2 Connect the system shielding to the PE terminal.
20 21 22 OUT1 .2
23 24 25 IN2
READY
26 27 PE IN3 IN4
IN1
Mounting, Wiring and Interfaces
SIMOCODE pro
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 11-9
11.3.2 Current measurement with current measurement modules
The size of the motor current determines the size of the corresponding cur-
rent measurement module that should be chosen for current measurement:
Push-through system up to 200 A. The 3 phases pass through the push-
through openings.
Rail connection system from 20 A to 630 A, also for direct connection to Sie-
mens contactors.
The following table shows the various current measurement modules with
the corresponding current measurement ranges:
Current measurement module Current
measurement
3UF7100-1AA00-0
0.3 A up to 3 A
Push-through openings: 7.5 mm
Push-through system
3UF7101-1AA00-0
2.4 A up to 25 A
Push-through openings: 7.5 mm
3UF7102-1AA00-0
10 A up to 100 A
Push-through openings: 14 mm
3UF7103-1AA00-0
20 A up to 200 A
Push-through openings: 25 mm
3UF7103-1BA00-0
20 A up to 200 A
Pin cross-section:
16 to 95 mm, AWG 6 to 3/0
Rail connection
system
3UF7104-1BA00-0
63 A up to 630 A
Pin cross-section:
50 to 240 mm,
AWG 1/0 to 500 kcmil
Table 11-7: Current measurement module with the corresponding current measurement range

Mounting, Wiring and Interfaces


SIMOCODE pro
11-10 GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
11.4 System interfaces
11.4.1 General
Please observe the following notes:
SIMOCODE pro system components are connected to each other via the
system interfaces.
There are 4 lengths of connecting cable that can be used to join the system
components.
The system is always expanded from the basic unit. Basic units have 2
system interfaces:
Bottom: For outgoing connection cables from BU1 to the current mea-
surement module.
Front: For outgoing connecting cables to an expansion module or opera-
tor panel and for PC cables, memory modules or addressing plugs.
Current measurement modules have one system interface:
Bottom or front incoming connecting cable from basic unit.
Expansion modules have 2 interfaces on the front.
Left: For incoming connecting cable from previous expansion module or
basic unit BU2.
Right: For outgoing connecting cables to an expansion module or opera-
tor panel and for PC cables, memory modules or addressing plugs.
The operator panel has 2 system interfaces:
Front: For PC cables, memory modules and addressing plugs.
Rear side: For incoming connecting cable from previous expansion
module or basic unit.
System interfaces that are not used are closed using the covering.
Mounting, Wiring and Interfaces
SIMOCODE pro
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 11-11
Example
The following figure shows the configuration with SIMOCODE pro V:
Figure 11-5: Example of system interfaces
Outgoing, to
Expansion module
Operator panel
U
F
-
0
1
1
3
0
SIMOCODE pro V
Basic unit (BU2)
Current measurement
module (IM)
Operator panel (OP)
Expansion module
Expansion modules
Incoming, from
Expansion module
Basic unit BU2
Outgoing, to
Expansion module
Operator panel
Incoming, from
Basic unit
U
F
-0
1
1
3
0
Operator panel (OP)
Incoming, from
Previous expansion module
Basic unit
Covering
Basic units
Outgoing, to
Current measurement module
Current measurement
Module (IM)
Mounting, Wiring and Interfaces
SIMOCODE pro
11-12 GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
11.4.2 Basic units, expansion modules and current measurement modules
The system interfaces are located on the front and bottom of the basic
units.
Other system components can be
joined to them using a connecting cable, e.g. digital module, current measu-
rement module
directly plugged into them, e.g. addressing plugs and memory modules.
System interfaces that are not used are closed using the system-interface
covering.
Attention
Only connect system interfaces when there is no voltage applied!
Figure 11-6: Connecting system components to the system interface
Connecting cable
Expansion modules Basic units Current measurement modules
2 system
interfaces
System
interfaces
System
interface
System
interface
Connecting cable
Memory module,
covering,
addressing plug
Mounting, Wiring and Interfaces
SIMOCODE pro
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 11-13
Sequence for connecting the system interface
Carry out the following steps:
Table 11-8: Connecting the system interfaces
Figure 11-7: Method for connecting the system interfaces
Notes
Attention
For SIMOCODE pro C, the system interfaces on the bottom can only be
used for the current measurement module!
Attention
Follow the color-coding on the connecting cable (see Figure)!
Step Description
1 Place the plug in the plug shaft as straightly as possible. Ensure that the cat-
ches on the plug shaft above the plug housing audibly click into place.
For SIMOCODE pro C, the system interface on the bottom can only be
used for the current measurement module!
2 Use the covering to close system interfaces that are not in use
Connecting
cable
Covering
System interfaces on the
1
2
3
front side and the bottom
Example: SIMOCODE pro C
Catches
Catches
Color-coded
Mounting, Wiring and Interfaces
SIMOCODE pro
11-14 GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
11.4.3 Operator panel
The operator panel has two system interfaces:
system interface on the rear. This is not normally accessible when an integra-
ted operator panel is used since the connecting cable from the basic unit or
expansion module is attached to it.
system interface on the front. This is normally accessible when an integrated
operator panel is used. Components are connected directly when required
and then removed again afterwards.
These could include:
Memory modules
Addressing plugs
PC cable to connect a PC / programming device
Covering (if a system interface is not being used).
Figure 11-8: Connecting system components to the operator panel
Rear system interface Front system interface
e.g.
Memory module
Connecting cable
Mounting, Wiring and Interfaces
SIMOCODE pro
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 11-15
Sequence for connecting the system interfaces
Carry out the following steps:
Table 11-9: Connecting the system interface
Figure 11-9: Method for connecting the system interfaces
Notes
Attention
Follow the color-coding on the connecting cable (see figure)!
Step Description
1 Place the plug in the plug shaft as straightly as possible. Ensure that the cat-
ches on the plug shaft above the plug housing audibly click into place.
The incoming connecting cable is connected to the rear side.
2 Use the covering to close system interfaces that are not in use.
Rear system interface
Connecting cable
Front system interface
Connecting
2
1
1
Catches
Catches
Color-coded
Mounting, Wiring and Interfaces
SIMOCODE pro
11-16 GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
11.4.4 PROFIBUS DP on a 9-pole SUB-D socket
The PROFIBUS DP can only be connected to the basic unit.
Attention
The 9-pole SUB-D connection is an alternative to terminals A/B!
Sequence for PROFIBUS DP connection
Carry out the following steps:
Table 11-10: Wiring the detachable terminals of digital modules
Figure 11-10: Connecting the PROFIBUS DP to the 9-pole SUB-D socket
Step Description
1 Connect the PROFIBUS DP cable with the 9-pole SUB-D plug to the
PROFIBUS DP interface.
Example: SIMOCODE pro C
PROFIBUS DP cable
PROFIBUS DP interface
9-pole
SUB-D plug
9-pole SUB-D socket
Mounting, Wiring and Interfaces
SIMOCODE pro
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 11-17
11.5 Installation guidelines for the PROFIBUS DP
Specification
The key data included in this chapter is valid for Siemens products and
cables.
Profibus user organization (PUO) installation guidelines
For electrical PROFIBUS networks, please also follow the PROFIBUS DMP/
FMS installation guidelines from the PROFIBUS user organization. This con-
tains important information about the cable arrangement and commission-
ing of PROFIBUS networks.
Publisher:
PROFIBUS User Organization e. V.
Haid-und-Neu-Strae 7
76131 Karlsruhe, Germany
Tel.: ++721 / 9658 590
Fax: ++721 / 9658 589
Internet: http://www.profibus.com
Guidelines, order no. 2.111
Installation of bus termination modules
The 3UF1900-1K.00 bus termination module is primarily designed for use in
MCC motor feeders. It provides a proper bus termination even for removed
MCC plug-in units. The bus termination module can also be utilized when no
(SUB-D) standard plug can be used in the last device on a bus line.
The 3UF1900-1KA00 bus termination module can also be connected to 220/
230 V, 380/400 V, 115/120 V or 24 V AC. The 3UF1900-1KB00 version can
also be used for 24 V DC.
Figure 11-11: Bus termination module
Mounting, Wiring and Interfaces
SIMOCODE pro
11-18 GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
SIMOCODE pro
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 12-1
Commissioning and Servicing 12
In this chapter
In this chapter you will find e.g. information on how SIMOCODE pro is com-
missioned, how components are replaced and how statistics are read.
Target groups
This chapter is addressed to the following target groups:
commissioners
technicians
maintenance and service personnel.
Necessary knowledge
You need the following knowledge:
general basic knowledge about SIMOCODE pro e.g. from chapter 1
SIMOCODE ES software
configuring the PROFIBUS DP address.
Commissioning and Servicing
SIMOCODE pro
12-2 GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
12.1 General information about commissioning and
servicing
Notes
Warning
Dangerous electrical voltage! Can cause electrical shock and
burns. Disconnect the device from the system before beginning work.
Attention
Follow the information contained in the operating manual.
Conditions
The following prerequisites must be fulfilled for commissioning and ser-
vicing:
SIMOCODE pro is already mounted and wired
the motor is switched off
Notes on parameterizing
You can parameterize SIMOCODE pro as follows:
with the memory module - where parameters from a basic unit were already
saved: the memory module is plugged into the system interface. If the
memory module is on the system interface and the supply voltage returns to
the basic unit, then the basic unit is automatically parameterized by the
memory module. The parameters can also be loaded into the basic unit by
pressing the test/reset button.
with the SIMOCODE ES software via the serial interface:
The PC/programming device is connected to the system interface with the
PC cable.
with an automation system and/or SIMOCODE ES software via
PROFIBUS DP: For this, the PROFIBUS DP cable is connected to the
PROFIBUS DP interface of the basic unit.
Possible cases for commissioning
There are 2 possible cases for commissioning:
1. Standard case: SIMOCODE pro was not yet parameterized and has the basic
factory default settings:
When connected to PROFIBUS DP, the bus LED flashes green if a DP
master is connected.
2. SIMOCODE pro was already parameterized:
the parameters were already loaded into the basic unit in advance.
the parameters from a previous application are still present. Check if the
parameters e.g. set current are correct for the new application. Change
these correspondingly, if necessary.
Commissioning and Servicing
SIMOCODE pro
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 12-3
12.2 Commissioning
12.2.1 Sequence of steps
Note the information in the previous chapter "General information about
commissioning and servicing" on page 12-2.
Carry out the following steps to commission SIMOCODE pro:
Table 12-1: Commissioning the basic unit
Schematic
Figure 12-1: Schematic for commissioning the basic unit
Step Description
1 Switch on the supply voltage. In an error-free state, the following LEDS should
light up or flash green:
Device (light up green)
Bus if PROFIBUS DP is connected. (light up/flash)
Continue with step 2.
Otherwise, carry out diagnostics according to the LED display. You will find
further information in chapter "Diagnostics via LED display" on page 12-5. Try
to rectify the error.
2 If you want to make SIMOCODE pro available on the PROFIBUS DP, set the
PROFIBUS DP address. You will find further information on this in chapter
"Setting the PROFIBUS DP address" on page 12-4.
3 Parameterize SIMOCODE pro or check the current parameterization e.g. with
a PC with the SIMOCODE ES software installed.
For this, connect the PC/programming device to the system interface with the
PC cable.
Attention! For basic unit 1, (SIMOCODE pro C) only use the system inter-
face on the front!
4 Start SIMOCODE ES.
PC cable,
Order number 3UF7940-0AA00-0
Commissioning and Servicing
SIMOCODE pro
12-4 GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
12.2.2 Setting the PROFIBUS DP address
First you have to set the PROFIBUS DP address of the basic unit. For this,
there are the following options:
with the addressing plug
with SIMOCODE ES
Setting the PROFIBUS DP address with the addressing plug
Carry out the following steps:
Table 12-2: Setting the PROFIBUS DP address with the addressing plug
Setting the PROFIBUS DP address with SIMOCODE ES
Carry out the following steps:
Table 12-3: Setting the PROFIBUS DP address with SIMOCODE ES
Step Description
1 Set the desired valid address on the DIP switch.
The switches are numbered.
Example address 21: Put the 16+4+1 switches into the ON position.
2 Plug the addressing plug into the system interface. The Device LED lights
up yellow.
3 Press the test/reset button for a short period of time. The set address is
accepted. The Device LED flashes yellow for approx. 3 seconds.
4 Pull the addressing plug out of the system interface.
Step Description
1 Plug the PC cable into the system interface.
2 Start SIMOCODE ES.
3 Click on the menu Switchgear >Open online.
4 Select RS232 and the corresponding COM interface.
Press OK to confirm.
5 Open the dialog Device parameters >Bus parameters.
6 Select the DP address.
7 Save the data in the basic unit with
Target system > Load in switchgear. The address is set.
Commissioning and Servicing
SIMOCODE pro
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 12-5
12.2.3 Diagnostics via LED display
The basic units and the operating panel have 3 LEDs which display certain
device states:
Table 12-4: Diagnostics via LED display
LED Status Display Description Corrective measures for
errors
Device Device
status
Green Device ready for use
Green
flickering
Internal error Send back the basic unit
Yellow Memory module or
addressing plug recogni-
zed, test/reset buttons
control the memory
module or addressing
plug

Yellow
flashing
Memory module/
addressing plug read in;
basic factory default set-
tings configured (dura-
tion: 3 s)

Yellow
flickering
Memory module pro-
grammed
(duration: 3 s)

Red Faulty parameterization Parameterize anew and


switch the control
voltage off and on again
Basic unit defective (also
gen. fault on)
Replace the
basic unit!
Red
flashing
Memory module,
addressing plug
Expansion module defec-
tive (also gen. fault on -
flashing)
Reprogram/replace the
memory module, replace
the expansion module
Off supply voltage too low Check if the supply
voltage is connected/tur-
ned on
Bus Bus sta-
tus
Off Bus not connected or
bus error
Connect the bus or
check the bus parame-
ters
Green
flashing
Baud rate recognized/
communication with PC/
programming device

Green Communication with


PLC/DCS

Gen.
Fault
Error
status
Red Error present; reset is
saved
Rectify error, e.g. over-
load
Red
flashing
Error present; no reset
saved
Rectify error, e.g. over-
load
Off no error
Commissioning and Servicing
SIMOCODE pro
12-6 GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
12.3 Servicing
12.3.1 Preventive maintenance
Preventive maintenance is an important step in avoiding faults and unfore-
seen costs. Industrial plants require regular professional maintenance in
order to e.g. prevent halts in production due to plant downtimes. Preventive
maintenance ensures that all components always work properly.
Reading out the statistics data
SIMOCODE pro makes statistics data available, which you e.g. can read out
with SIMOCODE ES under Target system > Service data/statistics data.
For example, by specifying Motor operating hours and Number of
starts you can decide whether motor and/or motor contactors should be
replaced.
Figure 12-2: Reading out statistic data
Commissioning and Servicing
SIMOCODE pro
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 12-7
12.3.2 Saving the parameters
Always save the parameters in the memory module or in a
SIMOCODE ES file. This applies especially if you replace a basic unit or if
you want to transfer data from one basic unit to another.
Saving parameters from the basic unit in the memory module
Carry out the following steps:
Table 12-5: Saving the parameters in the memory module.
Saving parameters from the basic unit in a SIMOCODE ES file
Carry out the following steps:
Table 12-6: Saving parameters in a SIMOCODE ES file
Step Description
1 Plug the PC memory module into the system interface. The Device LED
lights up yellow for approx. 10 seconds. During this time, press the Test/
reset button for approx. 3 seconds. The parameters are saved in the memory
module. After a successful data transfer, the Device LED flickers yellow for
approx. 3 seconds.
2 If necessary, unplug the memory module from the system interface.
Step Description
1 Plug the PC cable into the system interface.
2 Start SIMOCODE ES.
3 Open the menu Target system > Load into PC. The parameters are loaded
into the main memory from the basic unit.
4 Click on the menu Switchgear >Save copy as .... The parameters from the
main memory are saved in a SIMOCODE ES file.
Commissioning and Servicing
SIMOCODE pro
12-8 GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
Saving parameters from the memory module in the basic unit
Carry out the following steps:
Table 12-7: Saving parameters from the memory module in the basic unit
Attention
When the memory module is plugged in, the parameters are transferred
from the memory module to the basic unit.
Saving parameters from a SIMOCODE ES file to a basic unit
Carry out the following steps:
Table 12-8: Saving parameters from a SIMOCODE ES file to a basic unit
Step Description
1 Plug the memory module into the system interface. The Device LED lights
up yellow for approx. 10 seconds. During this time, press the test/reset but-
ton for a short period of time. The parameters are saved in the basic unit. After
a successful data transfer, the Device LED lights up yellow for approx. 3
seconds.
2 If necessary, unplug the memory module from the system interface.
Step Description
1 Plug the PC cable into the system interface.
2 Start SIMOCODE ES.
3 Click on the menu Switchgear>Open. The parameters from the
SIMOCODE ES file are saved in the main memory.
4 Click on the menu Target system > Load into switchgear. The parameters
are loaded from the main memory into the basic unit.
Commissioning and Servicing
SIMOCODE pro
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 12-9
12.3.3 Replace SIMOCODE pro components
Replacing a basic unit
Carry out the following steps:
Table 12-9: Replacing a basic unit
Replacing expansion units
Carry out the following steps:
Table 12-10: Replacing a basic unit
Step Description
1 Save the parameters. You will find more information on this in chapter "Saving
the parameters" on page 12-7.
2 Switch off the main power for the feeder and the supply voltage for the basic
unit.
3 If necessary, pull out the PC cable, the cover or the connecting cable from the
system interface.
4 Remove the detachable terminals. You do not need to remove the wiring.
5 Demount the basic unit.
6 Remove the detachable terminals of the new basic unit.
7 Mount the new basic unit.
8 Plug in the wired detachable terminals.
9 Plug the connecting cable into the system interface.
10 Switch on the supply voltage for the basic unit.
11 Save the parameters in the basic unit. You will find more information on this in
chapter "Saving the parameters" on page 12-7.
12 Switch on the main power for the feeder.
Step Description
1 Switch off the main power for the feeder and the supply voltage for the basic
unit.
2 If necessary, pull out the PC cable, the cover or the connecting cable from the
system interface.
3 Remove the detachable terminals. You do not need to remove the wiring.
4 Demount the expansion module.
5 Remove the detachable terminals of the new expansion unit.
6 Mount the new expansion module.
7 Plug in the wired detachable terminals.
8 Plug the connecting cable into the system interface.
9 Switch on the supply voltage for the basic unit.
10 Switch on the main power for the feeder.
Commissioning and Servicing
SIMOCODE pro
12-10 GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
12.3.4 Configuring the basic factory default setting
With the basic factory default settings, all parameters are reset to the fac-
tory values.
Configuring the basic factory default settings with the test/reset button on the basic
device
Carry out the following steps:
Table 12-11: Configuring basic factory default settings with the test/reset button on the basic device
Notes
Attention
If one of the steps is not carried out correctly, the basic unit reverts to nor-
mal operation.
Attention
This function is always active, independent of the test/reset buttons lok-
ked parameter.
Configuring the basic factory default settings with the SIMOCODE ES software
Prerequisite: SIMOCODE pro is connected via PROFIBUS DP or via the
system interface with PC/programming device and started with
SIMOCODE ES.
Carry out the following steps:
Table 12-12: Configuring the basic factory setting with the SIMOCODE ES software
Step Description
1 Switch off the supply voltage for the basic unit.
2 Press the test/reset button on the basic unit and keep it pressed.
3 Switch on the supply voltage for the basic unit. The Device LED lights up
yellow.
4 Release the test/reset button after approx. two seconds.
5 Press the test/reset button again after approx. two seconds.
6 Release the test/reset button after approx. two seconds.
7 Press the test/reset button again after approx. two seconds.
9 Basic factory default setting is configured.
Step Description
1 Click on the menu Switchgear >Open online.
2 In the menu, select Target system > Command > Basic factory setting.
3 Press Yes to confirm.
4 Basic factory default settings are configured.
SIMOCODE pro
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 A-1
Tables A
In this chapter
In this chapter you will find various tables which can help you when working
with SIMOCODE pro.
Target groups
This chapter is addressed to the following target groups:
configurators.
Necessary knowledge
You need the following knowledge:
good knowledge of SIMOCODE pro.
Tables
SIMOCODE pro
A-2 GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
A.1 Active control stations, contactor/lamp controls and
status signals/messages for the control functions
Table A-1: Active control stations, contactor/lamp controls and status signals/messages for the
control functions
S
p
e
c
i
f
i
c
a
t
i
o
n
/
C
o
n
t
r
o
l

f
u
n
c
t
i
o
n
C
o
n
t
r
o
l

s
t
a
t
i
o
n
C
o
n
t
a
c
t
o
r

c
o
n
t
r
o
l
L
a
m
p

c
o
n
t
r
o
l
Q
L
E
<
<
(
O
N
<
<
)
Q
L
E
<
(
O
N
<
)
Q
L
A
(
O
F
F
)
Q
L
E
>
(
O
N
>
)
Q
L
E
>
>
(
O
N
>
>
)
S
t
a
t
u
s

s
i
g
n
a
l
O
N
<
<
O
N
<
O
F
F
O
N
>
O
N
>
>
Q
E
1
Q
E
2
Q
E
3
Q
E
4
Q
E
5
O
N
<
<
O
N
<
O
F
F
O
N
>
O
N
>
>
O
v
e
r
l
o
a
d

1
)
,
2
)
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
A
c
t
i
v
e
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
D
i
r
e
c
t

s
t
a
r
t
e
r

1
)
,
2
)
-
-
O
F
F
O
N
-
O
N
-
-
-
-
-
O
F
F
O
N
-
R
e
v
e
r
s
i
n
g

s
t
a
r
t
e
r

1
)
,
2
)
-
L
e
f
t
O
F
F
R
i
g
h
t
-
R
i
g
h
t
L
e
f
t
-
-
-
L
e
f
t
O
F
F
R
i
g
h
t
-
C
i
r
c
u
i
t

b
r
e
a
k
e
r

1
)
,
2
)
-
-
O
F
F
O
N
-
O
N
p
u
l
s
e
O
F
F
p
u
l
s
e
-
-
-
-
-
O
F
F
O
N
-
S
t
a
r
-
d
e
l
t
a
s
t
a
r
t
e
r

2
)
-
-
O
F
F
O
N
-
S
t
a
r
c
o
n
t
a
c
t
o
r
D
e
l
t
a
c
o
n
t
a
c
t
o
r
N
e
t
w
o
r
k
c
o
n
t
a
c
t
o
r
-
-
-
-
O
F
F
O
N
-
S
t
a
r
-
d
e
l
t
a

s
t
a
r
t
e
r
w
i
t
h

r
e
v
e
r
s
a
l

o
f

t
h
e

d
i
r
e
c
t
i
o
n

o
f

r
o
t
a
t
i
o
n

2
)
L
e
f
t
O
F
F
R
i
g
h
t
-
S
t
a
r
c
o
n
t
a
c
t
o
r
D
e
l
t
a
c
o
n
t
a
c
t
o
r
R
i
g
h
t
n
e
t
w
o
r
k
c
o
n
t
a
c
t
o
r
L
e
f
t
n
e
t
w
o
r
k
c
o
n
t
a
c
t
o
r
-
L
e
f
t
O
F
F
R
i
g
h
t
-
D
a
h
l
a
n
d
e
r

2
)
-
-
O
F
F
S
l
o
w
F
a
s
t
F
a
s
t
S
l
o
w
F
a
s
t
S
t
a
r
c
o
n
t
a
c
t
o
r
-
-
-
-
O
F
F
S
l
o
w
F
a
s
t
D
a
h
l
a
n
d
e
r
w
i
t
h

r
e
v
e
r
s
a
l

o
f

t
h
e

d
i
r
e
c
t
i
o
n

o
f

r
o
t
a
t
i
o
n

2
)
L
e
f
t
F
a
s
t
L
e
f
t
S
l
o
w
O
F
F
R
i
g
h
t
S
l
o
w
R
i
g
h
t
F
a
s
t
R
i
g
h
t
F
a
s
t
R
i
g
h
t
S
l
o
w
F
a
s
t
S
t
a
r
c
o
n
t
a
c
t
o
r
L
e
f
t
S
l
o
w
L
e
f
t
F
a
s
t
L
e
f
t
F
a
s
t
L
e
f
t
S
l
o
w
O
F
F
R
i
g
h
t
S
l
o
w
R
i
g
h
t
F
a
s
t
P
o
l
e
-
c
h
a
n
g
i
n
g

s
w
i
t
c
h

2
)
-
-
O
F
F
S
l
o
w
F
a
s
t
F
a
s
t
S
l
o
w
-
-
-
-
-
O
F
F
S
l
o
w
F
a
s
t
P
o
l
e
-
c
h
a
n
g
i
n
g

s
w
i
t
c
h
w
i
t
h

r
e
v
e
r
s
a
l

o
f

t
h
e

d
i
r
e
c
t
i
o
n

o
f

r
o
t
a
t
i
o
n

2
)
L
e
f
t
F
a
s
t
L
e
f
t
S
l
o
w
O
F
F
R
i
g
h
t
S
l
o
w
R
i
g
h
t
F
a
s
t
R
i
g
h
t
F
a
s
t
R
i
g
h
t
S
l
o
w
-
L
e
f
t
S
l
o
w
L
e
f
t
F
a
s
t
L
e
f
t
F
a
s
t
L
e
f
t
S
l
o
w
O
F
F
R
i
g
h
t
S
l
o
w
R
i
g
h
t
F
a
s
t
V
a
l
v
e

2
)
-
-
C
l
o
s
e
d
O
p
e
n
-
O
p
e
n
-
-
-
-
-
-
C
l
o
s
e
d
O
p
e
n
-
S
l
i
d
e
r

1

2
)
-
C
l
o
s
e
d
S
t
o
p
O
p
e
n
-
O
p
e
n
C
l
o
s
e
d
-
-
-
-
C
l
o
s
e
d
S
t
o
p
O
p
e
n
-
S
l
i
d
e
r

2

2
)
-
C
l
o
s
e
d
S
t
o
p
O
p
e
n
-
O
p
e
n
C
l
o
s
e
d
-
-
-
-
C
l
o
s
e
d
S
t
o
p
O
p
e
n
-
S
l
i
d
e
r

3

2
)
-
C
l
o
s
e
d
S
t
o
p
O
p
e
n
-
O
p
e
n
C
l
o
s
e
d
-
-
-
-
C
l
o
s
e
d
S
t
o
p
O
p
e
n
-
S
l
i
d
e
r

4

2
)
-
C
l
o
s
e
d
S
t
o
p
O
p
e
n
-
O
p
e
n
C
l
o
s
e
d
-
-
-
-
C
l
o
s
e
d
S
t
o
p
O
p
e
n
-
S
l
i
d
e
r

5

2
)
-
C
l
o
s
e
d
S
t
o
p
O
p
e
n
-
O
p
e
n
C
l
o
s
e
d
-
-
-
-
C
l
o
s
e
d
S
t
o
p
O
p
e
n
-
S
o
f
t

s
t
a
r
t
e
r

2
)
-
-
O
F
F
O
N
-
O
N
n
e
t
w
o
r
k
c
o
n
t
a
c
t
o
r
-
R
e
s
e
t
O
N
c
o
m
m
a
n
d
-
-
-
O
F
F
O
N
-
S
o
f
t

r
e
v
e
r
s
i
n
g

s
t
a
r
t
e
r
2
)
-
L
e
f
t
O
F
F
R
i
g
h
t
-
R
i
g
h
t
n
e
t
w
o
r
k
c
o
n
t
a
c
t
o
r
L
e
f
t
n
e
t
w
o
r
k
c
o
n
t
a
c
t
o
r
R
e
s
e
t
O
N
c
o
m
m
a
n
d
-
-
L
e
f
t
O
F
F
R
i
g
h
t
-
1
)

B
a
s
i
c

u
n
i
t

1
,

S
I
M
O
C
O
D
E
p
r
o
C
2
)

B
a
s
i
c

u
n
i
t

2
,

S
I
M
O
C
O
D
E
p
r
o
V
Tables
SIMOCODE III
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 A-3
A.2 Abbreviations and Specifications
Abbreviations
The following abbreviations are used in the tables:
Specifications
The following specifications apply in the tables:
Abbreviation Meaning Note
BU1 Basic unit 1 (SIMOCODE pro C)
BU2 Basic unit 1 (SIMOCODE pro V)
IM Current measurement module
UM Current/voltage measurement modu-
les
Available from mid 2005
DM1 Digital module 1
DM2 Digital module 2
OP Operator panel
AM Analog module Available from mid 2005
EM Earth-fault module Available from mid 2005
TM Temperature module Available from mid 2005
Th Thermistor
CF Control function
Cycl. Cyclic
Acycl. Acyclic
Table A-2: Abbreviations
Specification Type Range Unit Info
Reserved Byte[4]
Cos Byte 0 .. 100 1% BU2
Reserved Byte[5]
Max. current I
max
Word 0 .. 65535 1% / I
e
BU1
BU2
Grayed entries only available
from the middle of 2005
Entry relevant for basic
unit 1 and basic unit 2
Example
Entries in italics
not relevant (reserved)
and, when writing,
should be filled with 0
Tables
SIMOCODE pro
A-4 GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
A.3 Socket assignment table - digital
This table contains all assignment numbers (Nr.) of the sockets (digital). You
only need these assignment numbers if, in a user program, you fill data
records and write these back (for example).
Nr. Specification Specification Information
0 Static level Not connected BU1/BU2
1 Fixed level value 0 BU1/BU2
2 Fixed level value 1 BU1/BU2
3 Reserved
4 Reserved
5 Reserved
6 Reserved
7 Reserved
8 Basic unit BU BU - test/reset button BU1/BU2
9 BU - input 1 BU1/BU2
10 BU - input 2 BU1/BU2
11 BU - input 3 BU1/BU2
12 BU - input 4 BU1/BU2
13 Reserved
14 Reserved
15 Reserved
16 Digital expansion modules DM DM1 - input 1 DM1
17 DM1 - input 2 DM1
18 DM1 - input 3 DM1
19 DM1 - input 4 DM1
20 DM2 - input 1 DM2
21 DM2 - input 2 DM2
22 DM2 - input 3 DM2
23 DM2 - input 4 DM2
24 Reserved
25 Reserved
26 Reserved
27 Reserved
28 Reserved
29 Reserved
30 Reserved
31 Reserved
32 Operator panel OP OP - test/reset button OP
33 OP - button 1 OP
34 OP - button 2 OP
35 OP - button 3 OP
36 OP - button 4 OP
37 Reserved
Table A-3: Socket assignment table - digital
Tables
SIMOCODE III
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 A-5
38 Reserved
39 Reserved
40 DPV1/RS-232 interface Acyclic control data - bit 0.0 BU1/BU2
41 (Acyclic data) Acyclic control data - bit 0.1 BU1/BU2
42 Acyclic control data - bit 0.2 BU1/BU2
43 Acyclic control data - bit 0.3 BU1/BU2
44 Acyclic control data - bit 0.4 BU1/BU2
45 Acyclic control data - bit 0.5 BU1/BU2
46 Acyclic control data - bit 0.6 BU1/BU2
47 Acyclic control data - bit 0.7 BU1/BU2
48 Acyclic control data - bit 1.0 BU1/BU2
49 Acyclic control data - bit 1.1 BU1/BU2
50 Acyclic control data - bit 1.2 BU1/BU2
51 Acyclic control data - bit 1.3 BU1/BU2
52 Acyclic control data - bit 1.4 BU1/BU2
53 Acyclic control data - bit 1.5 BU1/BU2
54 Acyclic control data - bit 1.6 BU1/BU2
55 Acyclic control data - bit 1.7 BU1/BU2
56 PLC/DCS interface PLC [DPV0] Cyclic control data - bit 0.0 BU1/BU2
57 (cyclic data) Cyclic control data - bit 0.1 BU1/BU2
58 Cyclic control data - bit 0.2 BU1/BU2
59 Cyclic control data - bit 0.3 BU1/BU2
60 Cyclic control data - bit 0.4 BU1/BU2
61 Cyclic control data - bit 0.5 BU1/BU2
62 Cyclic control data - bit 0.6 BU1/BU2
63 Cyclic control data - bit 0.7 BU1/BU2
64 Cyclic control data - bit 1.0 BU1/BU2
65 Cyclic control data - bit 1.1 BU1/BU2
66 Cyclic control data - bit 1.2 BU1/BU2
67 Cyclic control data - bit 1.3 BU1/BU2
68 Cyclic control data - bit 1.4 BU1/BU2
69 Cyclic control data - bit 1.5 BU1/BU2
70 Cyclic control data - bit 1.6 BU1/BU2
71 Cyclic control data - bit 1.7 BU1/BU2
72 Enabled control command Enabled control command ON<<
73 Enabled control command ON<
74 Enabled control command OFF
75 Enabled control command ON>
76 Enabled control command ON>>
77 Reserved
78 Reserved
79 Reserved
Nr. Specification Specification Information
Table A-3: Socket assignment table - digital (cont.)
Tables
SIMOCODE pro
A-6 GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
80 Contactor controls Contactor control 1 QE1
dependent of the
control function
81 Contactor control 2 QE2
82 Contactor control 3 QE3
83 Contactor control 4 QE4
84 Contactor control 5 QE5
85 Reserved
86 Reserved
87 Reserved
88 Lamp controls Display - QLE<< (ON<<)
dependent of the
control function
89 Display - QLE< (ON<)
90 Display - QLA (OFF)
91 Display - QLE> (ON>)
92 Display - QLE>> (ON>>)
93 Display - QLS (fault) BU1/BU2
94 Reserved
95 Reserved
96 Status signals - general Status - general fault BU1/BU2
97 Status - general warning BU1/BU2
98 Status - device BU1/BU2
99 Status - bus BU1/BU2
100 Status - PLC/DCS BU1/BU2
101 Status - current flows Current measure-
ment
102 Reserved
103 Reserved
104 Status signals - controlling Status - ON<<
dependent of the
control function
105 Status - ON<
106 Status - OFF
107 Status - ON>
108 Status - ON>>
109 Status - start active BU1/BU2
110 Status - interlocking time active all reversing star-
ters and sliders
111 Status - switching interval active Star-delta, Dahlan-
der, pole-changing
switches
112 Status - runs in open direction
dependent of the
control function
113 Status - runs in closed direction
114 Status - FC
115 Status - FO
116 Status - TC
117 Status - TO
118 Status - cold starting (TPF) BU1/BU2
119 Status - OPO BU2
Nr. Specification Specification Information
Table A-3: Socket assignment table - digital (cont.)
Tables
SIMOCODE III
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 A-7
120 Status - automatic mode of ope-
ration
BU1/BU2
121 Status signals - protection Status - emergency start execu-
ted
Current measure-
ment
122 Status - cooling down time active Current measure-
ment
123 Status - pause time active Current measure-
ment
124 Status signals - miscellaneous Status - device test active BU1/BU2
125 Status - phase sequence 1-2-3 UM
126 Status - phase sequence 3-2-1 UM
127 Reserved
128 Signals - protection Signal - overload operation Current measure-
ment
129 Signal - asymmetry Current measure-
ment
130 Signal - overload Current measure-
ment
131 Signal - overload + phase failure Current measure-
ment
132 Signal - internal earth fault Current measure-
ment
133 Signal - external earth fault EM
134 Reserved
135 Signal - thermistor overload Th
136 Signal - thermistor short circuit Th
137 Signal - thermistor wire break Th
138 Signal - TM warning T> TM
139 Signal - TM tripping T> TM
140 Signal - TM sensor error TM
141 Signal - TM out of range TM
142 Reserved
143 Reserved
144 Signals - level monitoring Signal - warning I> Current measure-
ment
145 Signal - warning I< Current measure-
ment
146 Signal - warning P> UM
147 Signal - warning P< UM
148 Signal - warning cos< UM
149 Signal - warning U< UM
150 Signal - warning 0/4-20 mA> AM
151 Signal - warning 0/4-20 mA< AM
152 Signal - tripping I> Current measure-
ment
153 Signal - tripping I< Current measure-
ment
Nr. Specification Specification Information
Table A-3: Socket assignment table - digital (cont.)
Tables
SIMOCODE pro
A-8 GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
154 Signal - tripping P> UM
155 Signal - tripping P< UM
156 Signal - tripping cos< UM
157 Signal - tripping U< UM
158 Signal - tripping 0/4-20 mA> AM
159 Signal - tripping 0/4-20 mA< AM
160 Signal - blocking Current measure-
ment
161 Reserved
162 Reserved
163 Signal - no start permitted BU1/BU2
164 Signal - number of starts > BU1/BU2
165 Signal - another start permitted BU1/BU2
166 Signal - motor operating hours > BU1/BU2
167 Signal - stopped time > BU1/BU2
168 Signal - limit value 1 BU2
169 Signal - limit value 2 BU2
170 Signal - limit value 3 BU2
171 Signal - limit value 4 BU2
172 Signals - miscellaneous Signal - external fault 1 BU1/BU2
173 Signal - external fault 2 BU1/BU2
174 Signal - external fault 3 BU1/BU2
175 Signal - external fault 4 BU1/BU2
176 Signal - external fault 5 BU2
177 Signal - external fault 6 BU2
178 Reserved
179 Reserved
180 Signal - analog module wire
break
AM
181 Reserved
182 Reserved
183 Reserved
184 Signals - timestamp function Signal - timestamp function
active+ok
BU2
185 Reserved
186 Reserved
187 Reserved
188 Signals - system interface Signal - configured operator
panel is missing
BU1/BU2
189 Reserved
190 Reserved
191 Reserved
192 Faults - general Fault - HW fault basic unit BU1/BU2
193 Fault - module fault BU1/BU2
Nr. Specification Specification Information
Table A-3: Socket assignment table - digital (cont.)
Tables
SIMOCODE III
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 A-9
194 Fault - temp components BU1/BU2
195 Fault - configuration fault BU1/BU2
196 Fault - parameterization BU1/BU2
197 Fault - bus BU1/BU2
198 Fault - PLC/DCS BU1/BU2
199 Reserved
200 Faults - controlling Fault - runtime ON
not for overload
relay
201 Fault - runtime OFF
202 Fault - F ON
203 Fault - F OFF
204 Fault - blocking slider Silder
205 Fault - double 0 Valve/silder
206 Fault - double 1 Valve/silder
207 Fault - end position Valve/silder
208 Fault - antivalence Slider
209 Fault - cold starting (TPF) error BU1/BU2
210 Fault - UVO error BU2
211 Fault - OPO error BU2
212 Reserved
213 Reserved
214 Reserved
215 Reserved
216 Freely programmable elements Truth table 1 3I/1O output BU1/BU2
217 Truth table 2 3I/1O output BU1/BU2
218 Truth table 3 3I/1O output BU1/BU2
219 Truth table 4 3I/1O output BU2
220 Truth table 5 3I/1O output BU2
221 Truth table 6 3I/1O output BU2
222 Truth table 7 2I/1O output BU2
223 Truth table 8 2I/1O output BU2
224 Truth table 9 5I/2O output 1 BU2
225 Truth table 9 5I/2O output 2 BU2
226 Reserved
227 Reserved
228 Reserved
229 Reserved
230 Reserved
231 Reserved
232 Timer 1 output BU1/BU2
233 Timer 2 output BU1/BU2
234 Timer 3 output BU2
235 Timer 4 output BU2
236 Counter 1 output BU1/BU2
237 Counter 2 output BU1/BU2
Nr. Specification Specification Information
Table A-3: Socket assignment table - digital (cont.)
Tables
SIMOCODE pro
A-10 GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
238 Counter 3 output BU2
239 Counter 4 output BU2
240 Signal conditioning 1 output BU1/BU2
241 Signal conditioning 2 output BU1/BU2
242 Signal conditioning 3 output BU2
243 Signal conditioning 4 output BU2
244 Non-volatile element 1 output BU1/BU2
245 Non-volatile element 2 output BU1/BU2
246 Non-volatile element 3 output BU2
247 Non-volatile element 4 output BU2
248 Flashing 1 output BU1/BU2
249 Flashing 2 output BU1/BU2
250 Flashing 3 output BU1/BU2
251 Flickering 1 output BU1/BU2
252 Flickering 2 output BU1/BU2
253 Flickering 3 output BU1/BU2
254 Reserved
255 Reserved
Nr. Specification Specification Information
Table A-3: Socket assignment table - digital (cont.)
Tables
SIMOCODE III
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 A-11
A.4 Socket assignment table - analog
This table contains all assignment numbers (Nr.) of the sockets (analog). You
only need these assignment numbers if, in a user program, you fill data
records and write these back (for example).
All inputs for analog data can only process values of type word (2 bytes).
In order to be also able to process values of type byte, the following app-
lies:
the byte value is processed as a low byte, the high byte is always 0
Nr. Specification Unit Information
0 Not connected BU1/BU2
1 Reserved
2 Reserved
3 Reserved
4 Timer 1 - actual value 100 ms BU1/BU2
5 Timer 2 - actual value 100 ms BU1/BU2
6 Timer 3 - actual value 100 ms BU2
7 Timer 4 - actual value 100 ms BU2
8 Timer 1 - actual value BU1/BU2
9 Timer 2 - actual value BU1/BU2
10 Timer 3 - actual value BU2
11 Timer 4 - actual value BU2
12 Reserved
13 Reserved
14 Reserved
15 Reserved
16 Max. current I_max 1%/Ie Current measurement
17 Current I_L1 1%/Ie Current measurement
18 Current I_L2 1%/Ie Current measurement
19 Current I_L3 1%/Ie Current measurement
20 Phase asymmetry 1% Current measurement
21 Reserved
22 Reserved
23 Reserved
24 Voltage U_L1 1V UM
25 Voltage U_L2 1V UM
26 Voltage U_L3 1V UM
27 Cos phi 1% UM
28 Reserved
29 Reserved
30 Reserved
31 Reserved
32 Heating up of the motor model Current measurement
33 Time to trip 100 ms Current measurement
Table A-4: Socket assignment table - analog
Tables
SIMOCODE pro
A-12 GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
1) S7 format: 0/4mA=0
20mA=27648
34 Recovery time 100 ms Current measurement
35 Last tripping current 1%/Ie Current measurement
36 TM - Temperature 1 K TM
37 TM - Temperature 1 1 K TM
38 TM - Temperature 2 1 K TM
39 TM - Temperature 3 1 K TM
40 Permitted starts - actual value BU1/BU2
41 Stopped time 1h BU1/BU2
42 Reserved
43 Reserved
44 AM - input See 1) AM
45 TM - temperature 1K TM
46 Reserved
47 Reserved
48 Acyclic control data - analog value BU1/BU2
49 Cyclic control data - analog value BU1 BU2
50 Reserved
51 Reserved
52 Motor operating hours - H-word
1s
BU1 BU2
53 Motor operating hours - L-word BU1 BU2
54 Int. motor operating hours - H-word
1s
BU1 BU2
55 Int. motor operating hours - L-word BU1 BU2
56 Device operating hours - H-word
1s
BU1 BU2
57 Device operating hours - L-word BU1 BU2
58 Number of starts - H-word BU1 BU2
59 Number of starts - L-word BU1 BU2
60 Int. number of starts right - H-word BU1 BU2
61 Int. number of starts right - L-word BU1 BU2
62 Int. number of starts left - H-word BU1 BU2
63 Int. number of starts left - L-word BU1 BU2
64 Reserved
.. Reserved
69 Reserved
70 Real power - H-word
1W
BU2
71 Real power - L-word BU2
72 Apparent power - H-word
1VA
BU2
73 Apparent power - L-word BU2
75 Reserved
.. Reserved
255 Reserved
Nr. Specification Unit Information
Table A-4: Socket assignment table - analog (cont.)
Tables
SIMOCODE III
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 A-13
A.5 Detailled signals of the slave diagnosis
This table contains the detailled signals of the slave diagnosis for the status
signals and the prozess alarm. This information is also contained in the data
record 92.
Byte.Bit Status signal Info
1.0 Faults controlling Fault - Ausfhrung Ein-Befehl
1.1 Fault - Ausfhrung Aus-Befehl
1.2 Fault - F Ein
1.3 Fault - F Aus
1.4 Fault - blocked slider slider
1.5 Fault - double 0 slider
1.6 Fault - double 1 slider
1.7 Fault - Endlage slider
2.0 Fault - antivalence slider
2.1 Fault - cold starting (TPF)-error BU1 BU2
2.2 Fault - UVO error BU2
2.3 Fault - UVO error BU2
2.4 reserved
3.0 Faults - protection reserved
3.1 Fault - asymmetriy Current measurement
3.2 Fault - overload Current measurement
3.3 Fault - overload + phase failure Current measurement
3.4 Fault - Int. earth fault Current measurement
3.5 Fault - Ext. earth fault EM
3.6 reserved
3.7 Fault - thermistor overload Th
4.0 Fault - thermistor short circuit Th
4.1 Fault - Thermistor wire break Th
4.2 reserved
4.3 Fault - TM Auslsung T> TM
4.4 Fault - TM Sensorfehler TM
4.5 Fault - TM Out of range TM
4.6 reserved
5.0 Faults -
level monitoring
Fault - tripping I> Current measurement
5.1 Fault - tripping I< Current measurement
5.2 Fault - tripping P> UM
5.3 Fault - trippingP< UM
5.4 Fault - tripping cos< UM
5.5 Fault - tripping U< UM
5.6 Fault - tripping 0/4-20mA> AM
5.7 Fault - tripping0/4-20mA< AM
6.0 Fault - blocking Current measurement
6.1 reserved
Table A-5: Detailed signals of the slave diagnosis
Tables
SIMOCODE pro
A-14 GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
6.4 Fault - number of starts> BU1 BU2
6.5 reserved
7.0 Faults -
miscellaneous
Fault - ext. fault 1 BU1 BU2
7.1 Fault - ext. fault 2 BU1 BU2
7.2 Fault - ext. fault 3 BU1 BU2
7.3 Fault - ext. fault 4 BU1 BU2
7.4 Fault - ext. fault 5 BU2
7.5 Fault - ext. fault 6 BU2
7.6 reserved
7.7 reserved
8.0 Fault - analogue module wire break AM
8.1 Fault - test shutdown BU1 BU2
8.2 reserved
9.0 Warnings - protection Warning - overload protection Current measurement
9.1 Warning - asymmetry Current measurement
9.2 Warning - overload Current measurement
9.3 Warning - overload+ phase failure Current measurement
9.4 Warning - internal earth fault Current measurement
9.5 Warning - external earth fault EM
9.6 reserved
9.7 Warning - thermistor overload Th
10.0 Warning - thermistor short circuit Th
10.1 Warning - thermistor wire break Th
10.2 Warning - TM warnung T> TM
10.3 reserved
10.4 Warning - TM sensor error TM
10.5 Warning - TM out of range TM
10.6 reserved
11.0 Warnings -
level monitoring
Warning - warning I> Current measurement
11.1 Warning - warning I< Current measurement
11.2 Warning - warning P> UM
11.3 Warning - warning P< UM
11.4 Warning - warning cos< UM
11.5 Warning - warning U< UM
11.6 Warning - warning 0/4-20mA> AM
11.7 Warning - Warning 0/4-20mA< AM
12.0 Warning - Blocking Current measurement
12.1 reserved
12.3 Warning - no start permitted BU1 BU2
12.4 Warning - number of starts > BU1 BU2
12.5 Warning - another start permitted BU1 BU2
12.6 Warning - motor operation hours > BU1 BU2
12.7 Warning - stopped time t > BU1 BU2
Byte.Bit Status signal Info
Table A-5: Detailed signals of the slave diagnosis (cont.)
Tables
SIMOCODE III
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 A-15
13.0 Warnings -
miscellaneous
Warning - ext. fault 1 BU1 BU2
13.1 Warning - ext. fault 2 BU1 BU2
13.2 Warning - ext. fault 3 BU1 BU2
13.3 Warning - ext. fault 4 BU1 BU2
13.4 Warning - ext. fault 5 BU2
13.5 Warning - ext. fault 6 BU2
13.6 reserved
13.7 reserved
14.0 Warnung - analog module wire
break
AM
14.1 reserved
15.0 reserved
15.1 Status signals - pro-
tection
Status - emergency start executed
15.2 Status - cooling down time active
15.3 reserved
15.4 reserved
15.5 reserved
15.6 Status signals - cont-
rolling
Status - cold starting (TPF) BU1 BU2
15.7 reserved
16.0 Signals -
parameterization
Signal - start-up parameter block
active
BU1 BU2
16.1 Signal -
Parameter change not permitted in
the current operating state
BU1 BU2
16.2 Signal - device does not support the
required functions
BU1 BU2
16.3 Signal - parameter faulty BU1 BU2
16.4 Signal - wrong password BU1 BU2
16.5 reserved
16.6 reserved
16.7 reserved
Byte.Bit Status signal Info
Table A-5: Detailed signals of the slave diagnosis (cont.)
Tables
SIMOCODE pro
A-16 GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
Data Formats and Data Records
SIMOCODE pro
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 B-1
Data Formats and Data Records B
In this chapter
In this chapter you will find information about the data records of
SIMOCODE pro.
Target groups
This chapter is addressed to the following target groups:
configurators
PLC programmers.
Necessary knowledge
You need the following knowledge:
good knowledge about writing and reading data records
good knowledge of SIMOCODE pro.
Data records - overview
Data record
number
Description Read/write
67 Process image of the outputs Read
69 Process image of the inputs Read
92 Device diagnostics
(faults, warnings, signals)
Read
94 Measured values Read
95 Service/statistics data Read/write
130 Base device parameter 1 (BU1 BU2) Read/write
131 Base device parameter 2 (BU1 BU2) Read/write
132 Extended device parameter 1 (BU2) Read/write
133 Extended device parameter 2 (BU2) Read/write
139 Labeling Read/write
160 Communication parameters Read/write
165 Designation Read/write
202 Acyclic control data Read/write
203 Acyclic signaling data Read
224 Password protection Write
Data Formats and Data Records
SIMOCODE pro
B-2 GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
B.1 Handling data records
This section contains helpful information about how best to handle data
records.
B.1.1 Writing/reading data records
Access to data records via slot and index
Slot: access via slot 1
Index: data record number
Writing/reading data records with STEP7
You can access the data records from the user program.
Writing data records:
S7 DPV1 master: by calling SFB 53 WR_REC or SFC 58
S7 master: by calling SFC 58
Reading data records:
S7 DPV1 master: by calling SFB 52 RD_REC or SFC 59
S7 master: by calling SFC 59
Further information
You will find further information on the SFBs
in the System software for S7-300/400, system and standard functions
reference manual
in the STEP7 online help.
Byte arrangements
When data which is longer than one byte is saved, then the bytes are arran-
ged as follows (big endian):
Figure B-1: Byte arrangement in the big endian format
Byte 0
Byte 1
High byte
Low byte
High byte
Low byte
High byte
Low byte
High word
Low word
Data type
Byte 0
Byte 1
Byte 0
Byte 1
Byte 2
Byte 3
Byte 0
Byte 1
Byte arrangements
Byte
Word
Double word (D-word)
Data Formats and Data Records
SIMOCODE pro
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 B-3
B.1.2 Abbreviations
The fallowing abbreviations are used in the tables:
B.1.3 Specifications
The following specifications apply in the tables:
Settings are valid/can only be made when the corresponding system com-
ponents are used.
Abbreviation Meaning Note
BU1 Basic unit 1 (SIMOCODE pro C)
BU2 Basic unit 1 (SIMOCODE pro V)
IM Current measurement module
UM Current/voltage measurement modu-
les
Available from mid 2005
DM1 Digital module 1
DM2 Digital module 2
OP Operator panel
AM Analog module Available from mid 2005
EM Earth-fault module Available from mid 2005
TM Temperature module Available from mid 2005
Th Thermistor
CF Control function
Cycl. Cyclic
Acycl. Acyclic
Table B-1: Abbreviations
Specification Type Range Unit Info
Reserved Byte[4]
Cos Byte 0 .. 100 1% BU2
Reserved Byte[5]
max. current I
max
Word 0 .. 65535 1% / I
e
BU1
BU2
Grayed entries only
available from mid 2005
Entry is relevant for basic
Example
Entries in italics
are not relevant (reserved)
and, when writing,
should be filled with 0
unit 1 and basic unit 2
Data Formats and Data Records
SIMOCODE pro
B-4 GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
B.2 Data record 67 - process image of the outputs
Base types (cyclic control data PLC --> SIMOCODE pro)
Byte.Bit Specification Presetting
(see also
parameter)
Type Info
0.0 Cyclic controlling - bit 0.0 Control station -
PLC/DCS [DP] ON<
Bit
BU1
BU2
0.1 Cyclic controlling - bit 0.1 Control station -
PLC/DCS [DP] OFF
Bit
0.2 Cyclic controlling - bit 0.2 Control station -
PLC/DCS [DP] ON>
Bit
0.3 Cyclic controlling - bit 0.3 Test 1 Bit
0.4 Cyclic controlling - bit 0.4 Motor protection -
Emergency start
Bit
0.5 Cyclic controlling - bit 0.5 Mode selector S1 Bit
0.6 Cyclic controlling - bit 0.6 Reset 1 Bit
0.7 Cyclic controlling - bit 0.7 Not assigned Bit
1.0 Cyclic controlling - bit 1.0 Not assigned Bit
1.1 Cyclic controlling - bit 1.1 Not assigned Bit
1.2 Cyclic controlling - bit 1.2 Not assigned Bit
1.3 Cyclic controlling - bit 1.3 Not assigned Bit
1.4 Cyclic controlling - bit 1.4 Not assigned Bit
1.5 Cyclic controlling - bit 1.5 Not assigned Bit
1.6 Cyclic controlling - bit 1.6 Not assigned Bit
1.7 Cyclic controlling - bit 1.7 Not assigned Bit
2.0 to
3.7
Cyclic controlling -
analog value
Not assigned Word BU2
Table B-2: Data record 67 - process image of the outputs
Specification Length Specification Info
Base type 1
(available from mid 2005)
4 bytes of control
data
Cyclic controlling -
bits 0.0 to 1.7 BU2
Cyclic controlling -
analog value
Base type 2 2 bytes of control
data
Cyclic controlling -
bits 0.0 to 1.7
BU1
BU2
Data Formats and Data Records
SIMOCODE pro
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 B-5
B.3 Data record 69 - process image of the inputs
Base types (cyclic signaling data SIMOCODE pro --> PLC)
Byte.Bit Specification Presetting
(see also
parameter)
Type Info
0.0 Cyclic signaling - bit 0.0 Status - ON< Bit
BU1
BU2
0.1 Cyclic signaling - bit 0.1 Status - OFF Bit
0.2 Cyclic signaling - bit 0.2 Status - ON> Bit
0.3 Cyclic signaling - bit 0.3 Signal -
overload operation
Bit
0.4 Cyclic signaling - bit 0.4 Status -
interlocking time
active
Bit
0.5 Cyclic signaling - bit 0.5 Status -
automatic mode of
operation
Bit
0.6 Cyclic signaling - bit 0.6 Status -
general fault
Bit
0.7 Cyclic signaling - bit 0.7 Status -
general warning
Bit
1.0 Cyclic signaling - bit 1.0 Not assigned Bit
1.1 Cyclic signaling - bit 1.1 Not assigned Bit
1.2 Cyclic signaling - bit 1.2 Not assigned Bit
1.3 Cyclic signaling - bit 1.3 Not assigned Bit
1.4 Cyclic signaling - bit 1.4 Not assigned Bit
1.5 Cyclic signaling - bit 1.5 Not assigned Bit
1.6 Cyclic signaling - bit 1.6 Not assigned Bit
1.7 Cyclic signaling - bit 1.7 Not assigned Bit
2.0 PLC/DCS analog input 1 Max. current I_max Word
4.0 PLC/DCS analog input 2 Not assigned Word BU2
6.0 PLC/DCS analog input 3 Not assigned Word BU2
8.0 PLC/DCS analog input 4 Not assigned Word BU2
Table B-3: Data record 69 - process image of the inputs
Specification Length Specification Info
Base type 1
(available from mid 2005)
10 bytes of
signaling data
Cyclic signaling -
bits 0.0 to 1.7 BU2
Cyclic signaling -
analog inputs 1 to 4
Base type 2 4 bytes of signaling
data
Cyclic signaling -
bits 0.0 to 1.7 BU1
BU2
Cyclic signaling -
analog input 1
Data Formats and Data Records
SIMOCODE pro
B-6 GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
B.4 Data record 92 - device diagnostics
Byte.Bit Specification Info DP
Diagn.*
0.0 Reserved
1.0 Status signals -
general
Status -
general fault
BU1 BU2
1.1 Status -
general warning
BU1 BU2
1.2 Status - device BU1 BU2
1.3 Status - bus BU1 BU2
1.4 Status - PLC/DCS BU1 BU2
1.5 Status - motor current flo-
wing
Current measu-
rement
1.6 Reserved
2.0 Status signals -
controlling
Status - ON<<
Depending on
the CF
2.1 Status - ON<
2.2 Status - OFF
2.3 Status - ON>
2.4 Status - ON>>
2.5 Status - start active BU1 BU2
2.6 Status -
interlocking time active
all reversing star-
ters and sliders
2.7 Status -
pause time active
Star-delta, Dahl-
ander, pole-chan-
ging switches
3.0 Status - runs in open direc-
tion
Depending on
the CF
3.1 Status - runs in closed
direction
3.2 Status - FC
3.3 Status - FO
3.4 Status - TC
3.5 Status - TO
3.6 Status -
cold starting (TPF)
BU1 BU2 M
3.7 Status - OPO BU2
4.0 Status - automatic mode
of operation
BU1 BU2
4.1 Status signals -
protection
Status - emergency start
executed
Current measu-
rement
M
4.2 Status -
cooling down time active
Current measu-
rement
M
4.3 Status - pause time active Current measu-
rement
Table B-4: Data record 92 - diagnostics
Data Formats and Data Records
SIMOCODE pro
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 B-7
4.4 Status signals -
miscellaneous
Status -
device test active
BU1 BU2
4.5 Status -
phase sequence 1-2-3
UM
4.6 Status -
phase sequence 3-2-1
UM
4.7 Reserved
5.0 Signals - protec-
tion
Signal -
overload operation
Current measu-
rement
5.1 Signal -
asymmetry
Current measu-
rement
5.2 Signal - overload Current measu-
rement
5.3 Signal - overload + phase
failure
Current measu-
rement
5.4 Signal -
internal earth fault
Current measu-
rement
5.5 Signal -
external earth fault
EM
5.6 Res. signal -
warning ext. EF
EM
5.7 Signal -
thermistor overload
Th
6.0 Signal - thermistor short
circuit
Th
6.1 Signal - thermistor wire
break
Th
6.2 Signal - TM warning T> TM
6.3 Signal - TM tripping T> TM
6.4 Signal - TM sensor error TM
6.5 Signal - TM
Out of range
TM
6.6 Reserved Current measu-
rement
7.0 Signals - level
monitoring
Signal - warning I>
7.1 Signal - warning I< Current measu-
rement
7.2 Signal -
warning P>
UM
7.3 Signal -
warning P<
UM
7.4 Signal -
warning cos<
UM
7.5 Signal -
warning U<
UM
7.6 Signal -
warning 0/4-20mA>
AM
Byte.Bit Specification Info DP
Diagn.*
Table B-4: Data record 92 - diagnostics (cont.)
Data Formats and Data Records
SIMOCODE pro
B-8 GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
7.7 Signal -
warning 0/4-20 mA<
AM
8.0 Signal -
tripping I>
Current measu-
rement
8.1 Signal -
tripping I<
8.2 Signal -
tripping P>
UM
8.3 Signal -
tripping P<
UM
8.4 Signal -
tripping cos<
UM
8.5 Signal -
tripping U<
UM
8.6 Signal -
tripping 0/4-20 mA>
AM
8.7 Signal -
tripping 0/4-20 mA<
AM
9.0 Signal - blocking Current measu-
rement
9.1 Reserved
9.3 Signal - not start permitted BU1 BU2
9.4 Signal - number of starts > BU1 BU2
9.5 Signal -
another start permitted
BU1 BU2
9.6 Signal - motor operating
hours >
BU1 BU2
9.7 Signal -
stopped time >
BU1 BU2
10.0 Signal - limit value 1 BU2
10.1 Signal - limit value 2 BU2
10.2 Signal - limit value 3 BU2
10.3 Signal - limit value 4 BU2
10.4 Signals - miscella-
neous
Signal - external fault 1 BU1 BU2
10.5 Signal - external fault 2 BU1 BU2
10.6 Signal - external fault 3 BU1 BU2
10.7 Signal - external fault 4 BU1 BU2
11.0 Signal - external fault 5 BU2
11.1 Signal - external fault 6 BU2
11.2 Reserved
11.3 Reserved
11.4 Signal -
analog module wire break
AM
11.5 Reserved
Byte.Bit Specification Info DP
Diagn.*
Table B-4: Data record 92 - diagnostics (cont.)
Data Formats and Data Records
SIMOCODE pro
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 B-9
12.0 Signals -
timestamp func-
tion
Signal - timestamp func-
tion active+ok
BU2
12.1 Reserved
12.4 Signals -
system interface
Signals - configured opera-
tor panel is missing
BU1 BU2
12.5 Signal - module not sup-
ported
BU1 BU2
12.6 Reserved
13.0 Signals - memory
module
Signal - memory module
read in
BU1 BU2
13.1 Signal - memory module
programmed
BU1 BU2
13.2 Signal - memory module
deleted
BU1 BU2
13.3 Reserved
13.7 Signals - addres-
sing plug
Signal - addressing plug
read in
BU1 BU2
14.0 Signals - parame-
terization
Signal - start-up parameter
block active
BU1 BU2 M
14.1 Signal -
parameter change not per-
mitted in the current ope-
rating state
BU1 BU2 M
14.2 Signal -
device does not support
the required functions
BU1 BU2 M
14.3 Signal -
parameter faulty
BU1 BU2 M
14.4 Signal -
wrong password
BU1 BU2 M
14.5 Signal -
password protection
active
BU1 BU2
14.6 Signal -
basic factory default set-
tings
BU1 BU2
14.7 Signal -
parameterization active
BU1 BU2
15.0 Signal - prm error number
(bytes) **
BU1 BU2
16.0 Reserved
17.0 Warnings - pro-
tection
Warning -
overload operation
Current measu-
rement
W
17.1 Warning -
asymmetry
Current measu-
rement
W
17.2 Warning - overload Current measu-
rement
W
Byte.Bit Specification Info DP
Diagn.*
Table B-4: Data record 92 - diagnostics (cont.)
Data Formats and Data Records
SIMOCODE pro
B-10 GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
17.3 Warning - overload +
phase failure
Current measu-
rement
W
17.4 Warning -
internal earth fault
Current measu-
rement
W
17.5 Warning -
external earth fault
EM W
17.6 Reserved
17.7 Warning -
thermistor overload
Th W
18.0 Warning - thermistor short
circuit
Th W
18.1 Warning - thermistor wire
break
Th W
18.2 Warning -
TM warning T>
TM W
18.3 Reserved
18.4 Warning -
TM sensor error
TM W
18.5 Warning -
TM out of range
TM W
18.6 Reserved
19.0 Warnings -
level monitoring
Warning -
Warning I>
Current measu-
rement
W
19.1 Warning -
Warning I<
Current measu-
rement
W
19.2 Warning -
Warning P>
UM W
19.3 Warning -
Warning P<
UM W
19.4 Warning -
warning cos<
UM W
19.5 Warning -
Warning U<
UM W
19.6 Warning -
warning 0/4-20 mA>
AM W
19.7 Warning -
warning 0/4-20 mA<
AM W
20.0 Warning -
blocking
Current measu-
rement
W
20.1 Reserved
20.4 Warning -
number of starts >
BU1 BU2 W
20.5 Warning -
another start permitted
BU1 BU2 W
20.6 Warning - motor operating
hours >
BU1 BU2 W
20.7 Signal -
stopped time >
BU1 BU2 W
Byte.Bit Specification Info DP
Diagn.*
Table B-4: Data record 92 - diagnostics (cont.)
Data Formats and Data Records
SIMOCODE pro
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 B-11
21.0 Warnings - mis-
cellaneous
Warning - ext. fault 1 BU1 BU2 W
21.1 Warning - ext. fault 2 BU1 BU2 W
21.2 Warning - ext. fault 3 BU1 BU2 W
21.3 Warning - ext. fault 4 BU1 BU2 W
21.4 Warning - ext. fault 5 BU2 W
21.5 Warning - ext. fault 6 BU2 W
21.6 Reserved
21.7 Reserved
22.0 Warning - analog module
wire break
BU2 W
22.1 Reserved
23.0 Faults - general Fault - HW fault basic unit BU1 BU2 F9
23.1 Fault - module fault BU1 BU2 F9
23.2 Fault - temp components
(e.g. memory module)
BU1 BU2 F9
23.3 Fault - configuration fault BU1 BU2 F16
23.4 Fault -
parameterization
BU1 BU2 F16
23.5 Fault - bus BU1 BU2
23.6 Fault - PLC/DCS BU1 BU2
23.7 Reserved
24.0 Faults - control-
ling
Fault - runtime ON Current measu-
rement
FAU
24.1 Fault -
runtime OFF
Current measu-
rement
FAU
24.2 Fault - F ON Current measu-
rement
FAU
24.3 Fault - F OFF FAU
24.4 Fault -
blocked slider
CF = slider FAU
24.5 Fault - double 0 CF = slider FAU
24.6 Fault - double 1 CF = slider FAU
24.7 Fault - end position CF = slider FAU
25.0 Fault - antivalence CF = slider FAU
25.1 Fault - cold starting (TPF)
error
BU1 BU2 FAU
25.2 Fault - UVO error BU2 FAU
25.3 Fault - OPO error BU2 FAU
25.4 Reserved
26.0 Reserved
26.1 Faults - protec-
tion
Fault - asymmetry Current measu-
rement
FAU
26.2 Fault - overload Current measu-
rement
FAU
26.3 Fault - overload + phase
failure
Current measu-
rement
FAU
Byte.Bit Specification Info DP
Diagn.*
Table B-4: Data record 92 - diagnostics (cont.)
Data Formats and Data Records
SIMOCODE pro
B-12 GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
26.4 Fault -
internal earth fault
Current measu-
rement
FAU
26.5 Fault -
external earth fault
EM FAU
26.6 Reserved
26.7 Fault -
thermistor overload
Th FAU
27.0 Fault - thermistor short cir-
cuit
Th FAU
27.1 Fault - thermistor wire
break
Th FAU
27.2 Reserved
27.3 Fault - TM
tripping T>
TM FAU
27.4 Fault - TM
sensor fault
TM FAU
27.5 Fault - TM
out of range
TM FAU
27.6 Reserved
28.0 Faults -
level monitoring
Fault - tripping I> Current measu-
rement
FAU
28.1 Fault - tripping I< Current measu-
rement
FAU
28.2 Fault -
tripping P>
UM FAU
28.3 Fault -
tripping P<
UM FAU
28.4 Fault -
tripping cos<
UM FAU
28.5 Fault -
tripping U<
UM FAU
28.6 Fault -
tripping 0/4-20 mA>
AM FAU
28.7 Fault -
tripping 0/4-20 mA<
AM FAU
29.0 Fault - blocking Current measu-
rement
FAU
29.1 Reserved
29.4 Fault - number of starts > BU1 BU2 FAU
29.5 Reserved
Byte.Bit Specification Info DP
Diagn.*
Table B-4: Data record 92 - diagnostics (cont.)
Data Formats and Data Records
SIMOCODE pro
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 B-13
*)
The DP-Diagn. column contains the bits which are additionally available in the dia-
gnostics about
PROFIBUS DP:
F: Fault
S: Signal
W: Warning
F9, F16: Error types
**)
Signal - prm error number (bytes): If a parameterization is not possible, then the number
of the parameter group which caused the error is transmitted here.
You will find the parameter groups in the data records 130 to 133.
30.0 Faults - miscella-
neous
Fault - fault 1 BU1 BU2 FAU
30.1 Fault - fault 2 BU1 BU2 FAU
30.2 Fault - fault 3 BU1 BU2 FAU
30.3 Fault - fault 4 BU1 BU2 FAU
30.4 Fault - fault 5 BU2 FAU
30.5 Fault - ext. fault 6 BU2 FAU
30.6 Reserved
30.7 Reserved
31.0 Fault -
analog module wire break
AM FAU
31.1 Fault -
test shutdown
BU1 BU2 FAU
31.2 Reserved
Byte.Bit Specification Info DP
Diagn.*
Table B-4: Data record 92 - diagnostics (cont.)
Example parameter group
Byte.Bit description
(Prm group)
0.0 coordination
4.0 device configuration
(see above) (12)
12.0 Bit parameter (16)
15.6 Ext. fault 3 -
effectiveness
parameter group 12
parameter group 16
. . .
. . .
.

.

.
Data Formats and Data Records
SIMOCODE pro
B-14 GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
B.5 Data record 94 - measured values
1) S7 format: 0/4mA = 0
20mA = 27648
2) Representaion heating up the motor model:
Value always refers to symmetrical tripping level,
Representation in 2% steps in
Bits 6..0 (range 0 to 254%),
Bit 7 shows asymmetry (fixed level 50%).
3) Representation in Kelvin.
Byte.Bit Specification Type Range Unit Info
0.0 Reserved Byte[4]
4.0 Heating up of the
motor model
Byte 0 .. 255 See
2)
Current measurement
5.0 Phase asymmetry Byte 0 .. 100 1% Current measurement
6.0 Cos Byte 0 .. 100 1% UM
7.0 Reserved Byte[5]
12.0 Max. current I
max
Word 0 .. 65535 1% / I
e
Current measurement
14.0 Current I
L1
Word 0 .. 65535 1% / I
e
Current measurement
16.0 Current I
L2
Word 0 .. 65535 1% / I
e
Current measurement
18.0 Current I
L3
Word 0 .. 65535 1% / I
e
Current measurement
20.0 Last tripping cur-
rent
Word 0 .. 65535 1% / I
e
Current measurement
22.0 Time to trip Word 0 .. 65535 100 ms Current measurement
24.0 Recovery time Word 0 .. 65535 100 ms Current measurement
26.0 Voltage U
L1
Word 0 .. 65535 1 V UM
28.0 Voltage U
L2
Word 0 .. 65535 1 V UM
30.0 Voltage U
L3
Word 0 .. 65535 1 V UM
32.0 AM - Output Word 0 .. 27648 siehe
1)
AM
34.0 AM - Input 1 Word 0 .. 27648 AM
36.0 AM - Input2 Word 0 .. 27648 AM
38.0 Reserved Word
40.0 TM - Temperature Word 0 .. 65535 1 K see
3)
TM
42.0 TM - Temperature
1
Word 0 .. 65535 1 K see
3)
TM
44.0 TM - Temperature
2
Word 0 .. 65535 1 K see
3)
TM
46.0 TM - Temperature
3
Word 0 .. 65535 1 K see
3)
TM
48.0 Reserved Byte[4]
52.0 Real power D-word 0 ..
0xFFFFFFFF
1 W UM
56.0 Apparent power D-word 0 ..
0xFFFFFFFF
1 VA UM
60.0 Reserved Byte[14]
Table B-5: Data record 94 - measured values
Data Formats and Data Records
SIMOCODE pro
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 B-15
B.6 Data record 95 - Service/statistics data
Writing the service/statistics data
Writing is only possible if the password protection is not active.
Additional abbreviations
r/w: value can be written/ changed
r: value can only be read
Byte.Bit Specification Type Range Unit Info
0.0 Reserved Byte[4] 0
4.0 Permitted starts - actual
value
Byte 0 .. 255 r/w BU1
BU2
5.0 Reserved Byte
8.0 Number of parameteriza-
tions
Word 0 .. 65535 r BU1
BU2
10.0 Number of
overload trippings
Word 0 .. 65535 r/w BU1
BU2
12.0 Internal number
overload trippings
Word 0 .. 65535 r BU1
BU2
14.0 Stopped time Word 0 .. 65535 1 h r/w BU1
BU2
16.0 Timer 1 - actual value Word 0 .. 65535 r BU1
BU2
18.0 Timer 2 - actual value Word 0 .. 65535 r BU1
BU2
20.0 Timer 3 - actual value Word 0 .. 65535 r BU2
22.0 Timer 4 - actual value Word 0 .. 65535 r BU2
24.0 Timer 1 - actual value Word 0 .. 65535 r BU1
BU2
26.0 Timer 2 - actual value Word 0 .. 65535 r BU1
BU2
28.0 Timer 3 - actual value Word 0 .. 65535 r BU2
30.0 Timer 4 - actual value Word 0 .. 65535 r BU2
32.0 Reserved Byte
40.0 Motor operating hours D-word 0 ..
0xFFFFFFFF
1 s r/w BU1
BU2
44.0 Int. motor operating
hours
D-word 0 ..
0xFFFFFFFF
1 s r BU1
BU2
48.0 Device operating hours D-word 0 ..
0xFFFFFFFF
1 s r BU1
BU2
52.0 Number of starts D-word 0 ..
0xFFFFFFFF
r/w BU1
BU2
56.0 Internal number of starts
right
D-word 0 ..
0xFFFFFFFF
r BU1
BU2
60.0 Internal number of starts
left
D-word 0 ..
0xFFFFFFFF
r BU1
BU2
64.0 Reserved Byte[12]
Table B-6: Data record 95 - diagnostics - statistics data
Data Formats and Data Records
SIMOCODE pro
B-16 GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
B.7 Data record 130 - base device parameter 1
Device configuration
Table B-7: Device configuration
Byte.Bit Device configuration Type Range Note Info
0.0 Device class Byte 5, 9 5 = BU1
9 = BU2
BU1 BU2
BU2
1.0 Thermistor (Th) Bit 0, 1 1 = active; thermistor in the BU BU1 BU2
1.1 Reserved Bit[7]
2.0 Operator panel (OP) Bit 0, 1 BU1 BU2
2.1 Analog module (AM) Bit 0, 1 BU2
2.2 Temperature module (TM) Bit 0, 1 BU2
2.3 Earth-fault modules (EM) Bit 0, 1 BU2
2.4 Digital module 1 (DM1) Bit[2] 0 .. 2 0 = no digital module
1 = monostable
2 = bistable
BU2
2.6 Digital module 2 (DM2) Bit[2] 0 .. 2 BU2
3.0 Reserved Bit[8]
4.0 Current measurement
module (IM)
Bit[7] 0 .. 5 0 = no current measurement
1 = 0.3 .. 3 A
2 = 2.4 .. 25 A
3 = 10 .. 100 A
4 = 20 .. 200 A
5 = 63 .. 630 A
BU1 BU2
4.7 Voltage measurement (UM) Bit 0, 1 BU2
5.0 Reserved
6.0 Control function (CF) 0x00
0x10
0x11
0x12
0x20
0x21
0x30
0x31
0x40
0x41
0x50
0x60
0x61
0x62
0x63
0x64
0x70
0x71
0x00 = overload
0x10 = direct starter
0x11 = reversing starter
0x12 =linked switchgear
0x20 = star-delta starter
0x21 = star-delta starter with
reversal of the direction of
rotation
0x30 = Dahlander
0x31 = Dahlander with reversal
of the direction of rotation
0x40 = pole-changing switch
0x41 = pole-changing switch with
reversal of the direction of
rotation
0x50 = valve
0x60 =slider 1
0x61 =slider 2
0x62 =slider 3
0x63 =slider 4
0x64 =slider 5
0x70 =soft starter
0x71 =soft reversing starter
BU1 BU2
BU1 BU2
BU1 BU2
BU1 BU2
BU2
BU2
BU2
BU2
BU2
BU2
BU2
BU2
BU2
BU2
BU2
BU2
BU2
BU2
7.0 Reserved Bit[8]
Data Formats and Data Records
SIMOCODE pro
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 B-17
Base device parameter 1
Byte.Bit Specification Type Range Unit De-
fault
Note Info
0.0 Coordination Byte[4]
4.0 Device configuration
(see above) (12)
Byte[8] BU1 BU2
12.0 Bit parameter (16)
12.0 No configuration fault due to
OP
Bit 0, 1 0 BU1 BU2
12.1 Start-up parameter block
active
Bit 0, 1 0 BU1 BU2
12.2 Test/reset buttons blocked Bit 0, 1 0 BU1 BU2
12.3 Bus and PLC/DCS - reset Bit 0, 1 0 0 = manual,
1 = automatic
BU1 BU2
12.4 Reserved Bit 0
12.5 Reserved Bit 0
12.6 Reserved Bit 0
12.7 Reserved Bit 0
13.0 Diagnostics for
process signals
Bit 0, 1 0 BU1 BU2
13.1 Diagnostics for
process warnings
Bit 0, 1 1 BU1 BU2
13.2 Diagnostics for
process faults
Bit 0, 1 1 BU1 BU2
13.3 Diagnostics for
device faults
Bit 0, 1 1 BU1 BU2
13.4 Reserved Bit 0
13.5 Reserved Bit 0
13.6 Bus monitoring Bit 0, 1 1 BU1 BU2
13.7 Monitoring PLC/DCS Bit 0, 1 1 BU1 BU2
14.0 Overload protection - type of
load
Bit 0, 1 0 0 = 3-phase
1 = 1-phase
14.1 Overload protection - reset Bit 0, 1 0 0 = manual,
1 = automatic
14.2 Reserved Bit 0
14.3 Save switching command Bit 0, 1 0
14.4 Non-maintained command
mode
Bit 0, 1 0 CF<>0x00
14.5 Cold starting level (TPF) Bit 0, 1 0 0 = NO contact,
1 = NC contact
BU1 BU2
14.6 Load type Bit 0, 1 0 0 = motor,
1 = ohmic load
BU1 BU2
14.7 Reserved Bit 0
15.0 External fault 1 - type Bit 0, 1 0
0 = NO contact,
1 = NC contact
BU1 BU2
15.1 External fault 2 - type Bit 0, 1 0 BU1 BU2
15.2 External fault 3 - type Bit 0, 1 0 BU1 BU2
15.3 External fault 4 - type Bit 0, 1 0 BU1 BU2
Table B-8: Data record 130 - base device parameter 1
Data Formats and Data Records
SIMOCODE pro
B-18 GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
15.4 External fault 1 -
effectiveness
Bit 0, 1 0 0 = always,
1 = only motor ON
BU1 BU2
15.5 External fault 2 -
effectiveness
Bit 0, 1 0 BU1 BU2
15.6 External fault 3 -
effectiveness
Bit 0, 1 0 BU1 BU2
15.7 External fault 4 -
effectiveness
Bit 0, 1 0 BU1 BU2
16.0 Bit[2] parameters (20)
16.0 Thermistor - overload
response
Bit[2] 1, 2, 3 3 0 = deactivated
1 = signal
2 = warn
3 = switch off
Th
16.2 Thermistor - response to sen-
sor error
Bit[2] 0, 1, 2,
3
2 Th
16.4 Internal earth fault - response Bit[2] 0, 1, 2,
3
0
16.6 Motor protection - overload
response
Bit[2] 0, 1, 2,
3
3
17.0 Motor protection - overload
response
Bit[2] 0, 1, 2 2
17.2 Asymmetry protection -
response
Bit[2] 0, 1, 2,
3
2
17.4 Tripping response I> Bit[2] 0, 1, 3 0
17.6 Warning response I> Bit[2] 0, 1, 2 0
18.0 Tripping response I< Bit[2] 0, 1, 3 0
18.2 Warning response I< Bit[2] 0, 1, 2 0
18.4 Blocking protection - response Bit[2] 0, 1, 2,
3
0
18.6 Reserved Bit[2] 0
19.0 Monitoring the number of
starts - response to overshoo-
ting
Bit[2] 0, 1, 2,
3
0 BU1 BU2
19.2 Monitoring the number of
starts - response to pre-
warning
Bit[2] 0, 1, 2 0 BU1 BU2
19.4 Monitoring operating
hours - response
Bit[2] 0, 1, 2 0 BU1 BU2
19.6 Monitoring stopped time -
response
Bit[2] 0, 1, 2 0 BU1 BU2
20.0 Ext. fault 1 - response Bit[2] 1, 2, 3 1 BU1 BU2
20.2 Ext. fault 2 - response Bit[2] 1, 2, 3 1 BU1 BU2
Byte.Bit Specification Type Range Unit De-
fault
Note Info
Table B-8: Data record 130 - base device parameter 1 (cont.)
Data Formats and Data Records
SIMOCODE pro
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 B-19
20.4 Ext. fault 3 - response Bit[2] 1, 2, 3 1 BU1 BU2
20.6 Ext. fault 4 - response Bit[2] 1, 2, 3 1 BU1 BU2
21.0 Reserved Bit[2] 0
21.2 Basic unit - debounce time
inputs
Bit[2] 0 .. 3 10 ms 1 Offset 6 ms BU1 BU2
21.4 Timer 1 - type Bit[2] 0, 1, 2,
3
0 0 = with closing
delay,
1 = closing delay
with memory,
2 = with OFF delay,
3 = with fleeting clo-
sing
BU1 BU2
21.6 Timer 2 - type Bit[2] 0, 1, 2,
3
0 BU1 BU2
22.0 Signal conditioning 1 - type Bit[2] 0, 1, 2,
3
0
0 = non-inverting
1 = inverting
2 = rising edge with
memory
3 = falling edge with
memory
BU1 BU2
22.2 Signal conditioning 2 - type Bit[2] 0, 1, 2,
3
0 BU1 BU2
22.4 Non-volatile
element 1 - type
Bit[2] 0, 1, 2,
3
0 BU1 BU2
22.6 Non-volatile
element 2 - type
Bit[2] 0, 1, 2,
3
0 BU1 BU2
23.0 Reserved Bit[2] 0 BU1 BU2
23.2 Reserved Bit[2] 0 BU1 BU2
23.4 Reserved Bit[2] 0 BU1 BU2
23.6 Reserved Bit[2] 0 BU1 BU2
24.0 Bit[4] parameter (24) BU1 BU2
24.0 External fault 1 -
reset also by
Bit[4] 0 ...
1111B
1111B Bit[0] = panel reset,
Bit[1] = automatic
reset,
Bit[2] = remote reset,
Bit[3] = OFF com-
mand reset
BU1 BU2
24.4 External fault 2 -
reset also by
Bit[4] 0 ...
1111B
1111B BU1 BU2
25.0 External fault 3 -
reset also by
Bit[4] 0 ...
1111B
1111B BU1 BU2
25.4 External fault 4 -
reset also by
Bit[4] 0 ...
1111B
1111B BU1 BU2
26.0 Limit monitor - hysteresis for
limit monitoring
Bit[4] 0 .. 15 1% 5 BU1 BU2
26.4 Reserved Bit[4] 0
27.0 Reserved Bit[4] 0
27.4 Reserved Bit[4] 0
28.0 Byte parameters (28)
28.0 Interner earth fault - delay Byte 0 .. 255 100 ms 5
29.0 Overload protection - class Byte 5, 10 ..
35, 40
10 BU1 BU2
30.0 Motor protection - delay
with overload operation
Byte 0 .. 255 100 ms 5
31.0 Asymmetry protection -
level
Byte 0 .. 100 1% 40
32.0 Asymmetry protection -
delay
Byte 0 .. 255 100 ms 5
Byte.Bit Specification Type Range Unit De-
fault
Note Info
Table B-8: Data record 130 - base device parameter 1 (cont.)
Data Formats and Data Records
SIMOCODE pro
B-20 GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
33.0 Interlocking time Byte 0 .. 255 1 s 0
34.0 F time Byte 0 .. 255 100 ms 5 0 = deactivated
35.0 Tripping level I> Byte 0 .. 255 4% / I
e
0
36.0 Warning level I> Byte 0 .. 255 4% / I
e
0
37.0 Tripping level I< Byte 0 .. 255 4% / I
e
0
38.0 Warning level I< Byte 0 .. 255 4% / I
e
0
39.0 Blocking level Byte 0 .. 255 4% / I
e
0
40.0 Tripping delay I> Byte 0 .. 255 100 ms 5
41.0 Warning delay I> Byte 0 .. 255 100 ms 5
42.0 Tripping delay I< Byte 0 .. 255 100 ms 5
43.0 Warning delay I< Byte 0 .. 255 100 ms 5
44.0 Blocking delay Byte 0 .. 255 100 ms 5
45.0 Monitoring the number of
starts - permitted starts
Byte 1 .. 255 0 BU1 BU2
46.0 Reserved Byte 0
47.0 Reserved Byte 0
48.0 Truth table 1 3I/1O - type Byte 0 ..
111111
11B
0 BU1 BU2
49.0 Truth table 2 3I/1O - type Byte 0 ..
111111
11B
0 BU1 BU2
50.0 Truth table 3 3I/1O - type Byte 0 ..
111111
11B
0 BU1 BU2
51.0 Reserved Byte 0
52.0 Wort parameters (32)
52.0 Motor protection - cooling
down time
Word 0 ..
65535
100 ms 3000
54.0 Motor protection - pause time Word 0 ..
65535
100 ms 0 0 = deactivated
56.0 Run time Word 0 ..
65535
100 ms 10 0 = deactivated
58.0 Monitoring the number of
starts - start time frame
Word 0 ..
65535
1 s 0 BU1 BU2
60.0 Monitoring the number of
starts - interlocking time
Word 0 ..
65535
1 s 0 BU1 BU2
62.0 Stopped time level > Word 0 ..
65535
1 h 0 BU1 BU2
64.0 Timer 1 - limit value Word 0 ..
65535
100 ms 0 BU1 BU2
66.0 Timer 2 - limit value Word 0 ..
65535
100 ms 0 BU1 BU2
68.0 Counter 1 - limit value Word 0 ..
65535
0 BU1 BU2
70.0 Counter 2 - limit value Word 0 ..
65535
0 BU1 BU2
Byte.Bit Specification Type Range Unit De-
fault
Note Info
Table B-8: Data record 130 - base device parameter 1 (cont.)
Data Formats and Data Records
SIMOCODE pro
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 B-21
Grayed fields: parameters can be changed while running.
72.0 Reserved Word 0
74.0 Reserved Word 0
76.0 Part - D-word parameters
(36)
76.0 Operator enables Bit[32] 0 ..
1..1B
0..0B
80.0 Overload protection -
set current Ie1
D-word 0 ..
82000
10 mA 30
84.0 Motor operating hours level > D-word 0 ..
0xFFFFF
FFF
1s 0 BU1 BU2
88.0 Reserved D-word 0
Byte.Bit Specification Type Range Unit De-
fault
Note Info
Table B-8: Data record 130 - base device parameter 1 (cont.)
Data Formats and Data Records
SIMOCODE pro
B-22 GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
B.8 Data record 131 - base device parameter 2 (plug )
Byte.Bit Specification Type Range De-
fault
Note Info
0.0 Coordination Byte[4]
4.0 Byte parameters (40)
4.0 BU - output 1 Byte 0 .. 255 0 BU1 BU2
5.0 BU - output 2 Byte 0 .. 255 0 BU1 BU2
6.0 BU - output 3 Byte 0 .. 255 0 BU1 BU2
7.0 Reserved Byte 0
8.0 OP - LED green 1 Byte 0 .. 255 0 OP
9.0 OP - LED green 2 Byte 0 .. 255 0 OP
10.0 OP - LED green 3 Byte 0 .. 255 0 OP
11.0 OP - LED green 4 Byte 0 .. 255 0 OP
12.0 OP - LED yellow 1 Byte 0 .. 255 0 OP
13.0 OP - LED yellow 2 Byte 0 .. 255 0 OP
14.0 OP - LED yellow 3 Byte 0 .. 255 0 OP
15.0 Reserved Byte 0
16.0 Cyclic signaling - bit 0.0 Byte 0 .. 255 105 Default: status -
ON <
BU1 BU2
17.0 Cyclic signaling - bit 0.1 Byte 0 .. 255 106 Default: status -
OFF
BU1 BU2
18.0 Cyclic signaling - bit 0.2 Byte 0 .. 255 107 Default: status -
ON >
BU1 BU2
19.0 Cyclic signaling - bit 0.3 Byte 0 .. 255 128 Default: signal -
overload operation
BU1 BU2
20.0 Cyclic signaling - bit 0.4 Byte 0 .. 255 110 Default: status -
interlocking time
active
BU1 BU2
21.0 Cyclic signaling - bit 0.5 Byte 0 .. 255 120 Default: status -
automatic mode of
operation
BU1 BU2
22.0 Cyclic signaling - bit 0.6 Byte 0 .. 255 96 Default: status -
general fault
BU1 BU2
23.0 Cyclic signaling - bit 0.7 Byte 0 .. 255 97 Default: status -
general warning
BU1 BU2
24.0 Cyclic signaling - bit 1.0 Byte 0 .. 255 0 BU1 BU2
25.0 Cyclic signaling - bit 1.1 Byte 0 .. 255 0 BU1 BU2
26.0 Cyclic signaling - bit 1.2 Byte 0 .. 255 0 BU1 BU2
27.0 Cyclic signaling - bit 1.3 Byte 0 .. 255 0 BU1 BU2
28.0 Cyclic signaling - bit 1.4 Byte 0 .. 255 0 BU1 BU2
29.0 Cyclic signaling - bit 1.5 Byte 0 .. 255 0 BU1 BU2
30.0 Cyclic signaling - bit 1.6 Byte 0 .. 255 0 BU1 BU2
31.0 Cyclic signaling - bit 1.7 Byte 0 .. 255 0 BU1 BU2
32.0 Acyclic signaling - bit 0.0 Byte 0 .. 255 0 BU1 BU2
33.0 Acyclic signaling - bit 0.1 Byte 0 .. 255 0 BU1 BU2
Table B-9: Data record 131 - base device parameter 2
Data Formats and Data Records
SIMOCODE pro
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 B-23
34.0 Acyclic signaling - bit 0.2 Byte 0 .. 255 0 BU1 BU2
35.0 Acyclic signaling - bit 0.3 Byte 0 .. 255 0 BU1 BU2
36.0 Acyclic signaling - bit 0.4 Byte 0 .. 255 0 BU1 BU2
37.0 Acyclic signaling - bit 0.5 Byte 0 .. 255 0 BU1 BU2
38.0 Acyclic signaling - bit 0.6 Byte 0 .. 255 0 BU1 BU2
39.0 Acyclic signaling - bit 0.7 Byte 0 .. 255 0 BU1 BU2
40.0 Acyclic signaling - bit 1.0 Byte 0 .. 255 0 BU1 BU2
41.0 Acyclic signaling - bit 1.1 Byte 0 .. 255 0 BU1 BU2
42.0 Acyclic signaling - bit 1.2 Byte 0 .. 255 0 BU1 BU2
43.0 Acyclic signaling - bit 1.3 Byte 0 .. 255 0 BU1 BU2
44.0 Acyclic signaling - bit 1.4 Byte 0 .. 255 0 BU1 BU2
45.0 Acyclic signaling - bit 1.5 Byte 0 .. 255 0 BU1 BU2
46.0 Acyclic signaling - bit 1.6 Byte 0 .. 255 0 BU1 BU2
47.0 Acyclic signaling - bit 1.7 Byte 0 .. 255 0 BU1 BU2
48.0 Monitoring PLC/ DCS input Byte 0 .. 255 0 BU1 BU2
49.0 Motor protection - emergency start Byte 0 .. 255 60 Default: Cyclic con-
trolling -
bit 0.4
50.0 Reserved Byte 0
51.0 Reserved Byte 0
52.0 Mode selector S1 Byte 0 .. 255 61 Default: cyclic con-
trolling -
bit 0.5
BU1 BU2
53.0 Mode selector S2 Byte 0 .. 255 2 Default: fixed level
value 1
BU1 BU2
54.0 Control station - local control [LC] ON < Byte 0 .. 255 0
55.0 Control station - local control [LC] OFF Byte 0 .. 255 0
56.0 Control station - local control [LC] ON > Byte 0 .. 255 0
57.0 Control station - PLC/DCS [DP] ON < Byte 0 .. 255 40 Default: cyclic con-
trolling -
bit 0.0
58.0 Control station - PLC/DCS [DP] OFF Byte 0 .. 255 41 Default: cyclic con-
trolling -
bit 0.1
59.0 Control station - PLC/DCS [DP] ON > Byte 0 .. 255 42 Default: cyclic con-
trolling -
bit 0.2
60.0 Control station - PC[DPV1] ON < Byte 0 .. 255 0
61.0 Control station - PC[DPV1] OFF Byte 0 .. 255 0
62.0 Control station - PC[DPV1] ON > Byte 0 .. 255 0
63.0 Control station - operator panel [OP]
ON <
Byte 0 .. 255 0
64.0 Control station - operator panel [OP]
OFF
Byte 0 .. 255 0
65.0 Control station - operator panel [OP]
ON >
Byte 0 .. 255 0
Byte.Bit Specification Type Range De-
fault
Note Info
Table B-9: Data record 131 - base device parameter 2 (cont.)
Data Formats and Data Records
SIMOCODE pro
B-24 GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
66.0 Control function - ON < Byte 0 .. 255 73 Default: general
control station ON
<
67.0 Control function - OFF Byte 0 .. 255 74 Default: general
control station OFF
68.0 Control function - ON > Byte 0 .. 255 75 Default: general
control station ON
>
69.0 Control function - Feedback ON Byte 0 .. 255 101 Default: status -
motor current flo-
wing
BU1 BU2
70.0 External fault 1 - input Byte 0 .. 255 0 BU1 BU2
71.0 External fault 2 - input Byte 0 .. 255 0 BU1 BU2
72.0 External fault 3 - input Byte 0 .. 255 0 BU1 BU2
73.0 External fault 4 - input Byte 0 .. 255 0 BU1 BU2
74.0 External fault 1 - reset Byte 0 .. 255 0 BU1 BU2
75.0 External fault 2 - reset Byte 0 .. 255 0 BU1 BU2
76.0 External fault 3 - reset Byte 0 .. 255 0 BU1 BU2
77.0 External fault 4 - reset Byte 0 .. 255 0 BU1 BU2
78.0 Cold starting (TPF) Byte 0 .. 255 0 BU1 BU2
79.0 Test 1 - input Byte 0 .. 255 59 Default: cyclic con-
trolling -
bit 0.3
BU1 BU2
80.0 Test 2 - input Byte 0 .. 255 0 BU1 BU2
81.0 Reset 1 - input Byte 0 .. 255 62 Default: cyclic con-
trolling -
bit 0.6
BU1 BU2
82.0 Reset 2 - input Byte 0 .. 255 0 BU1 BU2
83.0 Reset 3 - input Byte 0 .. 255 0 BU1 BU2
84.0 Reserved Byte 0
85.0 Reserved Byte 0
86.0 Reserved Byte 0
87.0 Reserved Byte 0
88.0 Truth table 1
3I/1O - input 1
Byte 0 .. 255 0 BU1 BU2
89.0 Truth table 1
3I/1O - input 2
Byte 0 .. 255 0 BU1 BU2
90.0 Truth table 1
3I/1O - input 3
Byte 0 .. 255 0 BU1 BU2
91.0 Truth table 2
3I/1O - input 1
Byte 0 .. 255 0 BU1 BU2
92.0 Truth table 2
3I/1O - input 2
Byte 0 .. 255 0 BU1 BU2
93.0 Truth table 2
3I/1O - input 3
Byte 0 .. 255 0 BU1 BU2
94.0 Truth table 3
3I/1O - input 1
Byte 0 .. 255 0 BU1 BU2
Byte.Bit Specification Type Range De-
fault
Note Info
Table B-9: Data record 131 - base device parameter 2 (cont.)
Data Formats and Data Records
SIMOCODE pro
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 B-25
95.0 Truth table 3
3I/1O - input 2
Byte 0 .. 255 0 BU1 BU2
96.0 Truth table 3
3I/1O - input 3
Byte 0 .. 255 0 BU1 BU2
97.0 Reserved Byte 0
98.0 Timer 1 - input Byte 0 .. 255 0 BU1 BU2
99.0 Timer 1 - reset Byte 0 .. 255 0 BU1 BU2
100.0 Timer 2 - input Byte 0 .. 255 0 BU1 BU2
101.0 Timer 2 - reset Byte 0 .. 255 0 BU1 BU2
102.0 Counter 1 - input + Byte 0 .. 255 0 BU1 BU2
103.0 Counter 1 - input - Byte 0 .. 255 0 BU1 BU2
104.0 Counter 1 - reset Byte 0 .. 255 0 BU1 BU2
105.0 Counter 2 - input + Byte 0 .. 255 0 BU1 BU2
106.0 Counter 2 - input - Byte 0 .. 255 0 BU1 BU2
107.0 Counter 2 - reset Byte 0 .. 255 0 BU1 BU2
108.0 Signal conditioning 1 - input Byte 0 .. 255 0 BU1 BU2
109.0 Signal conditioning 1 - reset Byte 0 .. 255 0 BU1 BU2
110.0 Signal conditioning 2 - input Byte 0 .. 255 0 BU1 BU2
111.0 Signal conditioning 2 - reset Byte 0 .. 255 0 BU1 BU2
112.0 Non-volatile
element 1 - input
Byte 0 .. 255 0 BU1 BU2
113.0 Non-volatile
element 1 - reset
Byte 0 .. 255 0 BU1 BU2
114.0 Non-volatile
element 2 - input
Byte 0 .. 255 0 BU1 BU2
115.0 Non-volatile
element 2 - reset
Byte 0 .. 255 0 BU1 BU2
116.0 Flashing 1 - input Byte 0 .. 255 0 BU1 BU2
117.0 Flashing 2 - input Byte 0 .. 255 0 BU1 BU2
118.0 Flashing 3 - input Byte 0 .. 255 0 BU1 BU2
119.0 Flickering 1 - input Byte 0 .. 255 0 BU1 BU2
120.0 Flickering 2 - input Byte 0 .. 255 0 BU1 BU2
121.0 Flickering 3 - input Byte 0 .. 255 0 BU1 BU2
122.0 Analog parameters (44)
122.0 PLC/DCS analog input Byte 0 .. 255 16 Default: max. cur-
rent I_max
BU1 BU2
123.0 Reserved Byte 0
Byte.Bit Specification Type Range De-
fault
Note Info
Table B-9: Data record 131 - base device parameter 2 (cont.)
Data Formats and Data Records
SIMOCODE pro
B-26 GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
B.9 Data record DS132 - extended device parameter 1
Byte.Bit Specification Type Range Unit De-
fault
Note Info
0.0 Coordination Byte[4]
4.0 Part - bit parameters (17)
4.0 3UF50 compatibility mode Bit 0, 1 0 BU2
4.1 3UF50 mode of operation Bit 0, 1 0 0 = DPV0,
1 = DPV1
BU2
4.2 Reserved Bit 0
4.3 Reserved Bit 0
4.4 Reserved Bit 0
4.5 Reserved Bit 0
4.6 Reserved Bit 0
4.7 Reserved Bit 0
5.0 Reserved Bit 0
5.1 Reserved Bit 0
5.2 Reserved Bit 0
5.3 Reserved Bit 0
5.4 Analog module - measuring
range input
Bit 0, 1 0 0 = 0..20 mA
1 = 4-20 mA
AM
5.5 Analog module - measuring
range output
Bit 0, 1 0 AM
5.6 Reserved Bit 0
5.7 Reserved Bit 0
6.0 Limit value 1 Overshooting/
undershooting
Bit 0, 1 0 0 =< (overshooting)
1 =< (undershoo-
ting)
BU2
6.1 Limit value 2 Overshooting/
undershooting
Bit 0, 1 0 BU2
6.2 Limit value 3 Overshooting/
undershooting
Bit 0, 1 0 BU2
6.3 Limit value 4 Overshooting/
undershooting
Bit 0, 1 0 BU2
6.4 Reserved Bit 0
6.5 OPO level Bit 0, 1 0 0 = NO contact,
1 = NC contact
BU2
6.6 Slider response for OPO Bit 0, 1 0 0 = closed,
1 = open
BU2
6.7 Reserved Bit 0
7.0 External fault 5 - type Bit 0, 1 0 0 = NO contact,
1 = NC contact
BU2
7.1 External fault 6 - type Bit 0, 1 0 BU2
7.2 Reserved Bit 0
7.3 Reserved Bit 0
7.4 Monitoring external fault 5 Bit 0, 1 0 0 = always
1 = only motor ON
BU2
7.5 Monitoring external fault 6 Bit 0, 1 0 BU2
Table B-10: Data record DS132 - extended device parameter 1
Data Formats and Data Records
SIMOCODE pro
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 B-27
7.6 Reserved Bit 0
7.7 Reserved Bit 0
8.0 Reserved Bit 0
8.1 Reserved Bit 0
8.2 Reserved Bit 0
8.3 Reserved Bit 0
8.4 Timestamping active Bit 0, 1 0 BU2
8.5 Reserved Bit 0
8.6 Reserved Bit 0
8.7 Reserved Bit 0
9.0 Reserved Bit 0
9.1 Reserved Bit 0
9.2 Reserved Bit 0
9.3 Reserved Bit 0
9.4 Reserved Bit 0
9.5 Reserved Bit 0
9.6 Reserved Bit 0
9.7 Reserved Bit 0
10.0 Bit[2] parameters
10.0 3UF50 base type Bit[2] 0, 1, 2 0 BU2
10.2 Reserved Bit[2] 0
10.4 Reserved Bit[2] 0
10.6 UVO mode of operation Bit[2] 0, 1 0 0 = deactivated,
1 = activated
BU2
11.0 Monitoring tripping U< Bit[2] 1, 2 1 1 = on+ (always,
not TPF)
2 = run (Motor ON,
not TPF)
UM
11.2 Monitoring warning U< Bit[2] 1, 2 1 UM
11.4 Reserved Bit[2] 0
11.6 Reserved Bit[2] 0
12.0 Monitoring
Tripping 0/4-20 mA>
Bit[2] 0, 1, 2,
3
0 0 = on (always)
1 = on+ (always, not
TPF)
2 = run (motor ON,
not TPF)
3 = run+ (motor ON,
not TPF,
start hiding)
AM
Byte.Bit Specification Type Range Unit De-
fault
Note Info
Table B-10: Data record DS132 - extended device parameter 1 (cont.)
Data Formats and Data Records
SIMOCODE pro
B-28 GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
12.2 Monitoring
warning 0/4-20 mA>
Bit[2] 0, 1, 2,
3
0 AM
12.4 Monitoring
tripping 0/4-20 mA<
Bit[2] 0, 1, 2,
3
0 AM
12.6 Monitoring
warning 0/4-20 mA<
Bit[2] 0, 1, 2,
3
0 AM
13.0 Monitoring limit value 1 Bit[2] 0, 1, 2,
3
0 BU2
13.2 Monitoring limit value 2 Bit[2] 0, 1, 2,
3
0 BU2
13.4 Monitoring limit value 3 Bit[2] 0, 1, 2,
3
0 BU2
13.6 Monitoring limit value 4 Bit[2] 0, 1, 2,
3
0 BU2
14.0 Reserved Bit[2] 0
14.2 Reserved Bit[2] 0
14.4 Reserved Bit[2] 0
14.6 Reserved Bit[2] 0
15.0 DM - debounce time inputs Bit[2] 0 .. 3 10 ms 1 Offset 6ms DM1
DM2
15.2 AM - response with a wire
break
Bit[2] 1, 2, 3 2
0 = deactivated
1 = signal
2 = warn
3 = switch off
AM
15.4 EM - response to an external
earth fault
Bit[2] 1, 3 1 EM
15.6 Reserved Bit[2] 0, 1, 2 0 EM
16.0 Reserved Bit[2] 0
16.2 Reserved Bit[2] 0
16.4 Reserved Bit[2] 0
16.6 Reserved Bit[2] 0
17.0 TM - tripping response T> Bit[2] 1, 3 3
0 = deactivated
1 = signal
2 = warn
3 = switch off
TM
17.2 TM - warning response T> Bit[2] 0, 1, 2 2 TM
17.4 TM - response to a sensor
error/ out of range
Bit[2] 0, 1, 2,
3
2 TM
17.6 TM - active sensor Bit[2] 0, 1, 2 2 0: 1 sensor
1: 2 sensor
3: 3 sensor
TM
Byte.Bit Specification Type Range Unit De-
fault
Note Info
Table B-10: Data record DS132 - extended device parameter 1 (cont.)
Data Formats and Data Records
SIMOCODE pro
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 B-29
18.0 Tripping response P> Bit[2] 0, 1, 3 0
0 = deactivated
1 = signal
2 = warn
3 = switch off
UM
18.2 Warning response P> Bit[2] 0, 1, 2 0 UM
18.4 Tripping response P< Bit[2] 0, 1, 3 0 UM
18.6 Warning response P< Bit[2] 0, 1, 2 0 UM
19.0 Tripping response cos< Bit[2] 0, 1, 3 0 UM
19.2 Warning response cos< Bit[2] 0, 1, 2 0 UM
19.4 Tripping response U< Bit[2] 0, 1, 3 0 UM
19.6 Warning response U< Bit[2] 0, 1, 2 0 UM
20.0 Tripping response 0/4-20 mA> Bit[2] 0, 1, 3 0 AM
20.2 Warning response 0/4-20
mA>
Bit[2] 0, 1, 2 0 AM
20.4 Tripping response 0/4-20 mA< Bit[2] 0, 1, 3 0 AM
20.6 Warning response 0/4-20
mA<
Bit[2] 0, 1, 2 0 AM
21.0 Reserved Bit[2] 0
21.2 Reserved Bit[2] 0
21.4 Reserved Bit[2] 0
21.6 Reserved Bit[2] 0
22.0 Ext. fault 5 - response Bit[2] 1, 2, 3 1 0 = deactivated
1 = signal
2 = warn
3 = switch off
BU2
22.2 Ext. fault 6 - response Bit[2] 1, 2, 3 1 BU2
22.4 Reserved Bit[2] 0
22.6 Reserved Bit[2] 0
23.0 Trace - trigger edge Bit[2] 0,1 0 0 = positive, 1 = negative BU2
23.2 Reserved Bit[2] 0
23.4 Reserved Bit[2] 0
23.6 Reserved Bit[2] 0
24.0 Reserved Bit[2] 0
24.2 Reserved Bit[2] 0
24.4 Reserved Bit[2] 0
24.6 Reserved Bit[2] 0
25.0 Timer 3 type Bit[2] 0, 1, 2,
3
0 0 = with closing
delay, 1 = closing
delay with memory,
2 = with OFF delay, 3
= with fleeting clo-
sing
BU2
25.2 Timer 4 - type Bit[2] 0, 1, 2,
3
0 BU2
25.4 Signal conditioning 3 - type Bit[2] 0, 1, 2,
3
0
0 = non-inverting
1 = inverting
2 = rising edge with
memory
3 = falling edge with
memory
BU2
25.6 Signal conditioning 4 - type Bit[2] 0, 1, 2,
3
0 BU2
26.0 Non-volatile
element 3 - type
Bit[2] 0, 1, 2,
3
0 BU2
26.2 Non-volatile
element 4 - type
Bit[2] 0, 1, 2,
3
0 BU2
Byte.Bit Specification Type Range Unit De-
fault
Note Info
Table B-10: Data record DS132 - extended device parameter 1 (cont.)
Data Formats and Data Records
SIMOCODE pro
B-30 GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
26.4 Reserved Bit[2] 0
26.6 Reserved Bit[2] 0
27.0 Reserved Bit[2] 0
27.2 Reserved Bit[2] 0
27.4 Reserved Bit[2] 0
27.6 Reserved Bit[2] 0
28.0 Bit[4] parameters (25)
28.0 TM - sensor type Bit[3]
+Bit
000B
...
100B
000B 000B = PT100,
001B = PT1000,
010B = KTY83,
011B = KTY84,
100B = NTC
TM
28.4 Reserved Bit[4] 0
29.0 External fault 5 -
Reset also by
Bit[4] 0 ..
1111B
0101 Bit[0] = panel reset,
Bit[1] = automatic
reset,
Bit[2] = remote reset,
Bit[3] = OFF com-
mand reset
BU2
29.4 External fault 6 -
reset also by
Bit[4] 0 ..
1111B
1111B BU2
30.0 Reserved Bit[4] 0
30.4 Reserved Bit[4] 0
31.0 Reserved Bit[4] 0
31.4 Reserved Bit[4] 0
32.0 Truth table 7 2I/1O - type Bit[4] 0 ..
1111B
0 BU2
32.4 Truth table 8 2I/1O - type Bit[4] 0 ..
1111B
0 BU2
33.0 Reserved Bit[4] 0
33.4 Reserved Bit[4] 0
34.0 Hysteresis P - cos phi - U Bit[4] 0...15 0 1% UM
34.4 Hysteresis 0/4-20 mA Bit[4] 0...15 0 1% AM
35.0 Hysteresis free limit values Bit[4] 0...15 0 1% BU2
35.4 Reserved Bit[4] 0
36.0 Byte parameters (29)
36.0 Reserved Byte 0
37.0 EM - delay Byte 0 .. 255 100 ms 5 EM
38.0 Level tripping cos< Byte 0 .. 100 1% 0 UM
39.0 Warning level cos< Byte 0 .. 100 1% 0 UM
40.0 Tripping level U< Byte 0 .. 255 8 V 0 UM
41.0 Warning level U< Byte 0 .. 255 8 V 0 UM
42.0 Tripping level
0/4-20 mA>
Byte 0 .. 255 *128 0 AM
43.0 Warning level
0/4-20 mA>
Byte 0 .. 255 *128 0 AM
Byte.Bit Specification Type Range Unit De-
fault
Note Info
Table B-10: Data record DS132 - extended device parameter 1 (cont.)
Data Formats and Data Records
SIMOCODE pro
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 B-31
44.0 Tripping level
0/4-20 mA<
Byte 0 .. 255 *128 0 AM
45.0 Warning level
0/4-20 mA<
Byte 0 .. 255 *128 0 AM
46.0 Tripping delay P> Byte 0 .. 255 100 ms 5 UM
47.0 Warning delay P> Byte 0 .. 255 100 ms 5 UM
48.0 Tripping delay P< Byte 0 .. 255 100 ms 5 UM
49.0 Warning delay P< Byte 0 .. 255 100 ms 5 UM
50.0 Tripping level cos< Byte 0 .. 255 100 ms 5 UM
51.0 Warning delay cos< Byte 0 .. 255 100 ms 5 UM
52.0 Tripping delay U< Byte 0 .. 255 100 ms 5 UM
53.0 Warning delay U< Byte 0 .. 255 100 ms 5 UM
54.0 Tripping
delay 0/4-20 mA>
Byte 0 .. 255 100 ms 5 AM
55.0 Warning delay 0/4-20 mA> Byte 0 .. 255 100 ms 5 AM
56.0 Tripping
delay 0/4-20 mA<
Byte 0 .. 255 100 ms 5 AM
57.0 Warning delay 0/4-20 mA< Byte 0 .. 255 100 ms 5 AM
58.0 Delay limit value 1 Byte 0 .. 255 100 ms 5 BU2
59.0 Delay limit value 2 Byte 0 .. 255 100 ms 5 BU2
60.0 Delay limit value 3 Byte 0 .. 255 100 ms 5 BU2
61.0 Delay limit value 4 Byte 0 .. 255 100 ms 5 BU2
62.0 TM - hysteresis Byte 0 .. 255 1K 5 TM
63.0 Maximum time for star opera-
tion
Byte 0 .. 255 1s 20 CF = star-delta star-
ter
64.0 UVO time Byte 0 .. 255 100 ms 0 BU2
65.0 Staggering time Byte 0 .. 255 1s 0 BU2
66.0 Trace-Pretrigger Byte 0 .. 20 5 % 0 BU2
67.0 Reserved Byte 0
68.0 Reserved Byte 0
69.0 Reserved Byte 0
70.0 Truth table 4 3I/1O - type Byte 0 ..
111111
11B
0 BU2
71.0 Truth table 5 3I/1O - type Byte 0 ..
111111
11B
0 BU2
72.0 Truth table 6 3I/1O - type Byte 0 ..
111111
11B
0 BU2
73.0 Reserved Byte 0
74.0 Reserved Byte 0
75.0 Reserved Byte 0
76.0 Word parameters (33)
Byte.Bit Specification Type Range Unit De-
fault
Note Info
Table B-10: Data record DS132 - extended device parameter 1 (cont.)
Data Formats and Data Records
SIMOCODE pro
B-32 GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
76.0 Analog module - start value
output
Word 0 ..
65535
0 Value for 0/4 mA AM
78.0 Analog module - end value
output
Word 0 ..
65535
27648 Value for 20 mA AM
80.0 TM - Tripping level T> Word 0 ..
65535
1 K 0 TM
82.0 TM - Warning response T> Word 0 ..
65535
1 K 0 TM
84.0 Limit monitor 1 - limit value Word 0 ..
65535
0 BU2
86.0 Limit monitor 2 - limit value Word 0 ..
65535
0 BU2
88.0 Limit monitor 3 - limit value Word 0 ..
65535
0 BU2
90.0 Limit monitor 4 - limit value Word 0 ..
65535
0 BU2
92.0 Timer 3 - limit value Word 0 ..
65535
100 ms 0 BU2
94.0 Timer 4 - limit value Word 0 ..
65535
100 ms 0 BU2
96.0 Counter 3 - limit value Word 0 ..
65535
0 BU2
98.0 Counter 4 - limit value Word 0 ..
65535
0 BU2
100.0 Pause time Word 0 ..
65535
10 ms 0
102.0 Reserved Word 0 ..
65535
1 ms 100 BU2
104.0 Reserved Word 0
106.0 Reserved Word 0
Byte.Bit Specification Type Range Unit De-
fault
Note Info
Table B-10: Data record DS132 - extended device parameter 1 (cont.)
Data Formats and Data Records
SIMOCODE pro
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 B-33
Grayed fields: parameters can be changed while running.
108.0 Part - D-word parameters
(37)
108.0 Overload protection -
set current I
e2
D-word 0 ..
82000
10 mA 0
112.0 Tripping level P> D-word 0 ..
0xFFFF
FFFF
1 W 0 UM
116.0 Warning level P> D-word 0 ..
0xFFFF
FFFF
1 W 0 UM
120.0 Tripping level P< D-word 0 ..
0xFFFF
FFFF
1 W 0 UM
124.0 Warning level P< D-word 0 ..
0xFFFF
FFFF
1 W 0 UM
128.0 Truth table 9
5I/2O type - output 1
Bit [32] 0 ..
1..1B
0 BU2
132.0 Truth table 9
5I/2O type - output 2
Bit [32] 0 ..
1..1B
0 BU2
136.0 Reserved D-word 0
140.0 Reserved D-word 0
Byte.Bit Specification Type Range Unit De-
fault
Note Info
Table B-10: Data record DS132 - extended device parameter 1 (cont.)
Data Formats and Data Records
SIMOCODE pro
B-34 GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
B.10 Data record 133 - extended device parameter 2
(plug )
Byte.Bit Specification Type Range De-
fault
Note Info
0.0 Coordination Byte[4]
4.0 Byte parameter (41)
4.0 DM1 - output 1 Byte 0 .. 255 0 DM1
5.0 DM1 - output 2 Byte 0 .. 255 0 DM1
6.0 DM2 - output 1 Byte 0 .. 255 0 DM2
7.0 DM2 - output 2 Byte 0 .. 255 0 DM2
8.0 Reserved Byte 0
9.0 Reserved Byte 0
10.0 Reserved Byte 0
11.0 Reserved Byte 0
12.0 Timestamping - input 1 Byte 0 .. 255 0 BU2
13.0 Timestamping - input 2 Byte 0 .. 255 0 BU2
14.0 Timestamping - input 3 Byte 0 .. 255 0 BU2
15.0 Timestamping - input 4 Byte 0 .. 255 0 BU2
16.0 Timestamping - input 5 Byte 0 .. 255 0 BU2
17.0 Timestamping - input 6 Byte 0 .. 255 0 BU2
18.0 Timestamping - input 7 Byte 0 .. 255 0 BU2
19.0 Timestamping - input 8 Byte 0 .. 255 0 BU2
20.0 Reserved Byte 0
21.0 Reserved Byte 0
22.0 Control station - local control [LC] ON<< Byte 0 .. 255 0
23.0 Control station - local control [LC] ON>> Byte 0 .. 255 0
24.0 Control station - PLC/DCS [DP] ON<< Byte 0 .. 255 0
25.0 Control station - PLC/DCS [DP] ON>> Byte 0 .. 255 0
26.0 Control station - PC[DPV1] ON<< Byte 0 .. 255 0
27.0 Control station - PC[DPV1] ON>> Byte 0 .. 255 0
28.0 Control station - operator panel [OP]
ON>>
Byte 0 .. 255 0
29.0 Control station - operator panel [OP]<>/
<<>>
Byte 0 .. 255 0
30.0 Control function - ON<< Byte 0 .. 255 0
31.0 Control function - ON>> Byte 0 .. 255 0
32.0 Auxiliary control input - FC Byte 0 .. 255 0
33.0 Auxiliary control input - FO Byte 0 .. 255 0
34.0 Auxiliary control input - TC Byte 0 .. 255 0
35.0 Auxiliary control input - TO Byte 0 .. 255 0
36.0 External fault 5 - input Byte 0 .. 255 0 BU2
37.0 External fault 6 - input Byte 0 .. 255 0 BU2
38.0 Reserved Byte 0
Table B-11: Data record 133 - extended device parameter
Data Formats and Data Records
SIMOCODE pro
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 B-35
39.0 Reserved Byte 0
40.0 External fault 5 - reset Byte 0 .. 255 0 BU2
41.0 External fault 6 - reset Byte 0 .. 255 0 BU2
42.0 Reserved Byte 0
43.0 Reserved Byte 0
44.0 UVO error Byte 0 .. 255 0 BU2
45.0 OPO error Byte 0 .. 255 0 BU2
46.0 Truth table 4 3I/1O -
input 1
Byte 0 .. 255 0 BU2
47.0 Truth table 4 3I/1O -
input 2
Byte 0 .. 255 0 BU2
48.0 Truth table 4 3I/1O -
input 3
Byte 0 .. 255 0 BU2
49.0 Truth table 5 3I/1O -
input 1
Byte 0 .. 255 0 BU2
50.0 Truth table 5 3I/1O -
input 2
Byte 0 .. 255 0 BU2
51.0 Truth table 5 3I/1O -
input 3
Byte 0 .. 255 0 BU2
52.0 Truth table 6 3I/1O -
input 1
Byte 0 .. 255 0 BU2
53.0 Truth table 6 3I/1O -
input 2
Byte 0 .. 255 0 BU2
54.0 Truth table 6 3I/1O -
input 3
Byte 0 .. 255 0 BU2
55.0 Truth table 7 2I/1O -
input 1
Byte 0 .. 255 0 BU2
56.0 Truth table 7 2I/1O -
input 2
Byte 0 .. 255 0 BU2
57.0 Truth table 8 2I/1O -
input 1
Byte 0 .. 255 0 BU2
58.0 Truth table 8 2I/1O -
input 2
Byte 0 .. 255 0 BU2
59.0 Truth table 9 5I/2O -
input 1
Byte 0 .. 255 0 BU2
60.0 Truth table 9 5I/2O -
input 2
Byte 0 .. 255 0 BU2
61.0 Truth table 9 5I/2O -
input 3
Byte 0 .. 255 0 BU2
62.0 Truth table 9 5I/2O -
input 4
Byte 0 .. 255 0 BU2
63.0 Truth table 9 5I/2O -
input 5
Byte 0 .. 255 0 BU2
64.0 Timer 3 - input Byte 0 .. 255 0 BU2
65.0 Timer 3 - reset Byte 0 .. 255 0 BU2
66.0 Timer 4 - input Byte 0 .. 255 0 BU2
67.0 Timer 4 - reset Byte 0 .. 255 0 BU2
Byte.Bit Specification Type Range De-
fault
Note Info
Table B-11: Data record 133 - extended device parameter (cont.)
Data Formats and Data Records
SIMOCODE pro
B-36 GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
68.0 Counter 3 - input + Byte 0 .. 255 0 BU2
69.0 Counter 3 - input - Byte 0 .. 255 0 BU2
70.0 Counter 3 - reset Byte 0 .. 255 0 BU2
71.0 Counter 4 - input + Byte 0 .. 255 0 BU2
72.0 Timer 4 - input Byte 0 .. 255 0 BU2
73.0 Counter 4 - reset Byte 0 .. 255 0 BU2
74.0 Signal conditioner 3 -
input
Byte 0 .. 255 0 BU2
75.0 Signal conditioner 3 -
reset
Byte 0 .. 255 0 BU2
76.0 Signal conditioner 4 -
input
Byte 0 .. 255 0 BU2
77.0 Signal conditioning 4 - reset Byte 0 .. 255 0 BU2
78.0 Non-volatile
element 3 - input
Byte 0 .. 255 0 BU2
79.0 Non-volatile
element 3 - reset
Byte 0 .. 255 0 BU2
80.0 Non-volatile
element 4 - input
Byte 0 .. 255 0 BU2
81.0 Non-volatile
element 4 - reset
Byte 0 .. 255 0 BU2
82.0 Reserved Byte 0
83.0 Reserved Byte 0
84.0 Reserved Byte 0
85.0 Reserved Byte 0
86.0 Reserved Byte 0
87.0 Reserved Byte 0
88.0 Analog parameters (45)
88.0 Analog module - output Byte 0 .. 255 0 AM
89.0 Analog input limit value 1 Byte 0 .. 255 0 BU2
90.0 Analog input limit value 2 Byte 0 .. 255 0 BU2
91.0 Analog input limit value 3 Byte 0 .. 255 0 BU2
92.0 Analog input limit value 4 Byte 0 .. 255 0 BU2
93.0 Reserved Byte 0
94.0 Trace - analog input Byte 0...255 0 BU2
95.0 PLC/DCS analog input 2 Byte 0...255 0 BU2
96.0 PLC/DCS analog input 3 Byte 0...255 0 BU2
97.0 PLC/DCS analog input 4 Byte 0...255 0 BU2
98.0 Reserved Byte 0
99.0 Reserved Byte 0
Byte.Bit Specification Type Range De-
fault
Note Info
Table B-11: Data record 133 - extended device parameter (cont.)
Data Formats and Data Records
SIMOCODE pro
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 B-37
B.11 Data record 139 - labeling
The diagnostics
External fault 1 to 6 (signals, warnings and faults)
Limit value 1 to 4 (signals),
TM warning T>/ tripping T> (signals, warnings and faults)
Warning/ tripping 0/4-20 mA<> (signals, warnings and faults)
can be parameterized to have various meanings e.g. fill level >, stock hot
etc. To simplify the diagnostics, these texts can be saved in the device.
These can be created, read out and displayed with SIMOCODE ES, for
example. The texts have no functionality.
Byte.Bit Specification Type Information
0.0 Reserved Byte[4]
4.0 Reserved Byte[6]
10.0 Labeling - external fault 1 Byte[10] BU1 BU2
20.0 Labeling - external fault 2 Byte[10] BU1 BU2
30.0 Labeling - external fault 3 Byte[10] BU1 BU2
40.0 Labeling - external fault 4 Byte[10] BU1 BU2
50.0 Labeling - external fault 5 Byte[10] BU2
60.0 Labeling - external fault 6 Byte[10] BU2
70.0 Reserved Byte[10]
80.0 Reserved Byte[10]
90.0 Labeling limit value 1 Byte[10] BU2
100.0 Labeling limit value 2 Byte[10] BU2
110.0 Labeling limit value 3 Byte[10] BU2
120.0 Labeling limit value 4 Byte[10] BU2
130.0 Labeling TM warning T> Byte[10] BU2
140.0 Labeling TM tripping T> Byte[10] BU2
150.0 Labeling warning 0/4-20 mA> Byte[10] BU2
160.0 Labeling warning 0/4-20 mA< Byte[10] BU2
170.0 Labeling tripping 0/4-20 mA> Byte[10] BU2
180.0 Labeling tripping 0/4-20 mA< Byte[10] BU2
190.0 Reserved Byte[10]
Table B-12: Data record 139 - labeling
Data Formats and Data Records
SIMOCODE pro
B-38 GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
B.12 Data record 160 - communication parameters
Attention
Only the address is relevant for writing. The baud rate is recognized automa-
tically. The current baud rate is read.
B.13 Data record 165 - comment
Byte Specification Info
0.0 Coordination
BU1
BU2
4.0 Station address
5.0 Baud rate
6.0 to 11.0 Reserved
Table B-13: Data record 160 - communication parameters
Byte.Bit Specification Type Info
0.0 Coordination Byte[4]
BU1
BU2
4.0 System designation Byte[32]
36.0 Location identification Byte[22]
58.0 Date Byte[16]
74.0 Reserved Byte[38]
112.0 Comment Byte[54]
Table B-14: Data record 165 - comment
Data Formats and Data Records
SIMOCODE pro
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 B-39
B.14 Data record 202 - Acyclic controlling
Description
The acylic control data can be used for any functions. The control data is
available as device-internal outputs (sockets).
Byte.Bit Specification Type Info
0.0 Coordination Byte[4]
BU1
BU2
4.0 Acyclic controlling - bit 0.0 Bit
4.1 Acyclic controlling - bit 0.1 Bit
4.2 Acyclic controlling - bit 0.2 Bit
4.3 Acyclic controlling - bit 0.3 Bit
4.4 Acyclic controlling - bit 0.4 Bit
4.5 Acyclic controlling - bit 0.5 Bit
4.6 Acyclic controlling - bit 0.6 Bit
4.7 Acyclic controlling - bit 0.7 Bit
5.0 Acyclic controlling - bit 1.0 Bit
5.1 Acyclic controlling - bit 1.1 Bit
5.2 Acyclic controlling - bit 1.2 Bit
5.3 Acyclic controlling - bit 1.3 Bit
5.4 Acyclic controlling - bit 1.4 Bit
5.5 Acyclic controlling - bit 1.5 Bit
5.6 Acyclic controlling - bit 1.6 Bit
5.7 Acyclic controlling - bit 1.7 Bit
6.0 Acyclic controlling - analog value Word
Table B-15: Data record 202 - Acyclic controlling
Data Formats and Data Records
SIMOCODE pro
B-40 GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
B.15 Data record 203 - Acyclic signaling
Description
Any data can be transmitted via the acyclic signaling data. The control data
is available as device-internal inputs (plugs).
Byte.Bit Specification Type Info
0.0 Acyclic signaling - bit 0.0 Bit
BU1
BU2
0.1 Acyclic signaling - bit 0.1 Bit
0.2 Acyclic signaling - bit 0.2 Bit
0.3 Acyclic signaling - bit 0.3 Bit
0.4 Acyclic signaling - bit 0.4 Bit
0.5 Acyclic signaling - bit 0.5 Bit
0.6 Acyclic signaling - bit 0.6 Bit
0.7 Acyclic signaling - bit 0.7 Bit
1.0 Acyclic signaling - bit 1.0 Bit
1.1 Acyclic signaling - bit 1.1 Bit
1.2 Acyclic signaling - bit 1.2 Bit
1.3 Acyclic signaling - bit 1.3 Bit
1.4 Acyclic signaling - bit 1.4 Bit
1.5 Acyclic signaling - bit 1.5 Bit
1.6 Acyclic signaling - bit 1.6 Bit
1.7 Acyclic signaling - bit 1.7 Bit
Table B-16: Data record 203 - Acyclic signaling
Data Formats and Data Records
SIMOCODE pro
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 B-41
B.16 Data record 224 - password protection
Description
Password protection on
If the data record is received with this control flag, the password protection is
activated and the password is accepted. If, at the time of receiving, pass-
word protection on and the password are not the same, the signal signal -
password false is set and no change is carried out.
Password protection off
If the data record is received with this control flag, the password protection
is deactivated. If the password is false, the signal signal - password false is
set and no change is carried out.
Byte.Bit Specification Type Info
0.0 Reserved Byte[4]
BU1
BU2
4 Control flag:0 = password protection off
1 = password protection on
Bit
4.1 Reserved Bit[31]
8.0 Password Byte[8]
16.0 Reserved Byte[8]
Table B-17: Data record 224 - password protection
Data Formats and Data Records
SIMOCODE pro
B-42 GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
SIMOCODE pro
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 C-1
Dimension Drawings C
In this chapter
This chapter contains the technical dimension drawings of the
SIMOCODE pro system components.
Target groups
This chapter is addressed to the following target groups:
configurators
technicians.
Necessary knowledge
You need the following knowledge:
good knowledge about configuring switchgear.
Dimension Drawings
SIMOCODE pro
C-2 GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
C.1 3UF70 basic unit
C.1.1 SIMOCODE pro C 3UF7 000 basic unit
C.1.2 SIMOCODE pro V 3UF7 010 basic unit
86
5 36
8
01
0
6
1
2
5
4
45
8
01
0
6
1
2
5
45
115
5 65
4
Dimension Drawings
SIMOCODE pro
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 C-3
C.2 3UF710 current measurement module
C.2.1 Current measurement module (push-through converter)
3UF7 100, 0.3 A to 3 A,
3UF7 101, 2.4 A up to 25 A
45 40 5
8
4
3
8
T1 T3
8
T2
Dimension Drawings
SIMOCODE pro
C-4 GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
C.2.2 Current measurement module (push-through converter)
3UF7 102, 10 A to 100 A
55 67
9
4
6
5
14
5
T1
T2
T3
Dimension Drawings
SIMOCODE pro
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 C-5
C.2.3 Current measurement module (push-through converter)
3UF7 103, 20 A to 200 A
120
95
7
9
9
5
5 140
7
8
25
7
Dimension Drawings
SIMOCODE pro
C-6 GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
C.2.4 Current measurement module (rail connection)
3UF7 103, 20 A to 200 A
120
95
37 17
9
7
9
9
5
1
1
9
7 47
140
5
8
4
Dimension Drawings
SIMOCODE pro
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 C-7
C.2.5 Current measurement module (rail connection)
3UF7 104, 63 A to 630 A
145
5
7
25 50
11
9
8
5
1
2
2
1
4
7
125
6
148
60.5
6
0
.
5
6
Dimension Drawings
SIMOCODE pro
C-8 GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
C.3 3UF7 200 operator panel
2
9
8 29 7
96
3
6
Dimension Drawings
SIMOCODE pro
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 C-9
C.4 3UF7 3 digital module
115 5 4
1
0
6
8
9
2
22.5
Dimension Drawings
SIMOCODE pro
C-10 GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
C.5 Accessories
C.5.1 Door adapter
3
8
.
2
45.5
1
7
.
4
SIMOCODE pro
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 D-1
Technical Data D
In this chapter
This chapter contains the technical data about SIMOCODE pro.
Target groups
This chapter is addressed to the following target groups:
configurators
Necessary knowledge
You need the following knowledge:
good knowledge about configuring switchgear
good knowledge about SIMOCODE pro.
Technical Data
SIMOCODE pro
D-2 GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
D.1 Common technical data
Permiss. envir. temperature
In operation -25 ... +60 C
during storage and transport -40 ... +80 C
Site height above sea level
< 2000 m
< 3000 m max. +50 C (no safe isolation)
< 4000 m max. +40 C (no safe isolation)
Degree of protection (according
to 60529)
all components (except current
measurement module, rail connec-
tion, operator panel and door adap-
ter)
IP20
Current measurement module with
rail connection
IP00
Operator panel (front) and door
adapter (front) with cover
IP54
Shock resistance (sine pulse) 15 g/11 ms
Installation location Arbitrary
Frequencies 50/60 Hz 5%
EMC stability
according to IEC 60947-1
corresponds to degree of severity 3
Conducted interference-signal injec-
tion, burst according to IEC 61000-
4-4
2 kV (power ports) over-voltage limitter
is required for inductive loads.
1 kV (signal ports)
Conducted interference signal injec-
tion, burst according to IEC 61000-
4-5
2 kV (line to earth)
1 kV (line to earth)
Electrostatic discharging,
ESD according to IEC 61000-4-2
8 kV (air discharge)
6 kV (contact discharge)
Field-related interference signal
according to IEC 61000-4-3
10 V/m
EMC emitted interference
according to IEC 60947-1
correponds to degree of severity A
This is a Class A product. This product can
cause radio interference if used in a dome-
stic environment. The user must provide
suitable countermeasures if required.
Conducted and emitted
interference
DIN EN 55011/DIN EN 55022 (CISPR11/CISPR22)
Safe isolation
according to IEC 60947-1
All circuits in SIMOCODE pro are isolated from each other
according to IEC 60947-1, i.e. dimensioned with double cree-
page distance and air gap.
Follow the information contained in Test report no. 2668
Technical Data
SIMOCODE pro
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 D-3
D.2 Basic units
Mounting Snap-on mounting onto 35 mm standard rails or
Screw attachment using additional push-in lugs
Display
Red/green DEVICE LED Green: Ready for operation
Red: Function test was negative, device is locked
Off: No control supply voltage
Green BUS LED Continuous light:Communication with PLC/DCS
Flashing: Baud rate recognized/communication with PC/pro-
gramming device
Red GEN. FAULT LED Continuous light/flashing: Feeder fault, e.g. overload tripping
Test/reset button Resetting the device after tripping
Function test (system self-test)
Operation of memory module, addressing plug
System interfaces
Front Connecting an operator panel or expansion module. In addition,
the memory module, addressing plug or a PC cable for parame-
terization can be connected to the system interface
Underside: Connecting a current measurement module
PROFIBUS DP interface
Interface design
Connection
RS485
9-pole SUB-D socket (12 MBit)
Terminals (1.5 MBit) connection cross section like control circuit
Connecting a PROFIBUC DP cable using the cable connection
or the 9-pole SUB-D socket
Rated control voltage Us (accor-
ding to DIN EN 61131-2)
110 - 240 V AC/DC, 50/60 Hz 24 V DC
Operating range 0.85 to 1.1 x Us 0.8 to 1.2 x Us
Power consumption
Basic unit 1 (3UF7000) 7 VA 5 W
Basic unit 2 (3UF7010)
(including two expansion modules
connected to basic unit 2)
10 VA 7 W
Rated isolation voltage Ui 300 V (for degree of pollution 3)
Rated surge voltage strength
Uimp
4 kV
Technical Data
SIMOCODE pro
D-4 GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
Relay outputs:
Number 3 monostable relay outputs
Auxiliary contacts of the 3 relay
outputs
The isolated NO contacts, of which 2 relay outputs have a com-
mon root and one is separate, can be freely assigned to control
functions (e.g. network, star or delta contactor or signaling of
an operating state). (NC contact response can be parameteri-
zed via internal signal conditioning).
Predefined short-circuit protection
for auxiliary contacts (relay out-
puts)
Fast fuse link, operating class gL/gG 6 A, 10 A
(IEC 60947-5-1)
1.6 A, C-characteristic circuit breaker
(IEC 60947-5-1)
6 A, C-characteristic (I
k
< 500 A) circuit breaker
Rated uninterrupted current 6 A
Rated switching capacity AC-15 6 A / 24 V AC
6 A / 120 V AC
3 A / 230 V AC
DC-13 2 A / 24 V DC
0.55 A / 60 V DC
0.25 A / 125 V DC
Inputs (binary) The 4 inputs with a common root, that are supplied via the
device electronics (24 V DC), for measuring process signals
(e.g. local control, key-operated switch, end position switch,
...), can be freely assigned to the control functions.
24 V DC
Cable lengths
Input characteristic curve
300 m
Type 1 according to
EN 61131-2
Thermistor motor protection
(binary PTC)
Total cold resistance < 1.5 kOhm
Response value 3.4 to 3.8 kOhm
Return value 1.5 to 1.65 kOhm
Cable lengths Cross-section: 2.5 mm
2
1.5 mm
2
0.5 mm
2
Lengths:2x250 m
2x150 m
2x50 m
Connection cross-sections
Tightening torque 0.8 to 1.2 Nm
solid 1 x (0.5 to 4.0); 2 x (0.5 to 2.5) mm
2
stranded, with end sleeves 1 x (0.5 to 2.5); 2 x (0.5 to 1.5) mm
2
AWG cable 2 x 20 to 14
Technical Data
SIMOCODE pro
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 D-5
D.3 Current measurement modules
Mounting
Set current Ie = 0.3 to 3 A;
2.4 to 25 A; 10 to 100 A (3UF7100,
3UF7101, 3UF7102)
Snap-on mounting onto 35 mm standard rails or screw attach-
ment via additional plug-in lugs
Set current Ie = 20 to 200 A
(3UF7103)
Snap-on mounting onto 35 mm standard rails, screw attach-
ment onto mounting plates or directly to the contactor
Set current Ie = 63 to 630 A
(3UF7104)
Screw attachment onto the mounting plate or directly onto the
contactor
System interfaces For connection to a basic unit
Set current Ie 3UF7100; 3UF7101; 3UF7102 3UF7103; 3UF7104
0.3 to 3 A; 2.4 to 25 A;
10 to 100 A
20 to 200 A; 63 to 630 A
Rated isolation voltage Ui (for
degree of pollution 3)
690 V 1000 V
Rated surge voltage strength
Uimp
6 kV 8 kV
Measurement frequency 50/60 Hz
Type of current three-phase current
Short-circuit Additional short-circuit protection in main circuit
required
1)
Accuracy of the current measure-
ment
(in the range 1x the minimum setting current Iu to 8x the maxi-
mum set current Io) +/- 3 %
Push-through opening Diameter
Set current 0.3 to 3 A;
2.4 to 25 A:
7.5 mm
Set current 10 to 100 A; 14.0 mm
Set current 20 to 200 A; 25.0 mm
Rail connection
2
)
Set current Ie 20 to 200 A 63 to 630 A
Connection screw M8x20 M10x30
Tightening torque 10 to 14 Nm 14 to 24 Nm
solid with cable lug 16 to 95 mm
2 3
) 50 to 240 mm
2 4
)
multiple wire with cable lug 25 to 120 mm
2 3
) 70 to 240 mm
2 4
)
AWG cable 6 to 3/0 kcmil 1/0 to 500 kcmil
1) More informationen under http://www.siemens.de/simocode and section D.6 Short-circuit protection with
fuses for motor feeders for short-circuit currents up to 50 kA and 690 V on page D-8.
2) Screw connection is possible with a suitable box terminal 3RT19.
3) The 3RT19 56-4EA1 terminal cover is required to maintain the phase separation when connecting cable lugs to
cables with a cross-section larger than 95 mm
2
, according to DIN 46235.
4) The 3RT19 66-4EA1 terminal cover is required to maintain the phase separation when connecting cable lugs to
cables with a cross-section larger than 240 mm
2
, according to DIN 46234, and to cables larger than 185 mm
2

according to DIN 46235.
Technical Data
SIMOCODE pro
D-6 GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
D.4 Expansion modules (digital modules)
Mounting Snap-on mounting onto 35 mm standard rail or
screw attachment via additional plug-in lugs
Display
Green READY LED Continuous light:Ready for operation
Flashing: No connection to basic unit
System interfaces For connecting a basic unit or expansion module
Rated isolation current Ui 300 V (for degree of pollution 3)
Rated surge voltage strength
Uimp
4 kV
Relay outputs:
Number 2 mono or bistable relay outputs (depending on type)
Auxiliary contacts of the
2 relay outputs
The isolated NO contacts of all relay outputs with a common
root can be freely assigned to control functions (e.g. network,
star or delta contactor or signaling of an operating state).
(NC contact response can be parameterized via internal signal
conditioning).
Predefined short-circuit protec-
tion for auxiliary contacts (relay
outputs)
Fast fuse link, operating class gL/gG 6 A, 10 A (IEC 60947-5-1)
1.6 A, C-characteristic (IEC 60947-5-1) circuit breaker
6 A, C-characteristic (I
k
< 500 A) circuit breaker
Rated uninterrupted current 6 A
Rated switching capacity
AC-15 6 A / 24 V AC
6 A / 120 V AC
3 A / 230 V AC
DC-13 2 A / 24 V DC
0.55 A / 60 V DC
0.25 A / 125 V DC
Inputs (binary) The 4 externally powered inputs (DC 24 V or 110-240 V AC/
DC), have inputs with a common root dependant on their
type. They are used for measuring process signals (e.g. local
control, key-operated switches, end position switches, ...)
and can be freely assigned to the control functions.
24 V DC
Cable lengths
Input characteristic curve
300 m
Type 2 according to EN 61131-2
110 V up to 240 V AC/DC
Cable lengths
Input characteristic curve
200 m (cable capacitance 300 nF/km)

Technical Data
SIMOCODE pro
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 D-7
D.5 Operator panel
Connection cross-sections
Tightening torque 0.8 to 1.2 Nm
solid 1 x (0.5 to 4.0); 2 x (0.5 to 2.5) mm
2
stranded, with end sleeves 1 x (0.5 to 2.5); 2 x (0.5 to 1.5) mm
2
AWG cable 2 x 20 to 14
Mounting Installing in a switching-cabinet door and/or in a front panel,
with system interface covering IP 54
Display
Red/green DEVICE LED Green: Ready for operation
Green, flashing:No connection to basic unit
Red: Function test was negative, device is locked
Off: No control supply voltage
Green BUS LED Continuous light: Communication with PLC/DCS
Flashing: Baud rate recognized / communication with
PC/programming device
Red GEN. FAULT LED Continuous light/flashing: Feeder fault,
e.g. overload tripping
3 yellow LEDs / 4 green LEDs Can be freely assigned to any status signal
Buttons
Test/reset Resetting the device after tripping
Function test (system self-test)
Operation of memory module, addressing plug
Operation buttons For controlling the motor feeder, freely assignable
System interfaces
Front For connecting a memory module, an addressing plug or a PC
cable for parameterization
Rear side Connection to the basic unit or an expansion module
Technical Data
SIMOCODE pro
D-8 GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
D.6 Short-circuit protection with fuses for motor feeders for
short-circuit currents up to 50 kA and 690 V
S
t
a
t
u
s
:

0
5
/
0
1
/
2
0
6
9
0
V
S
h
o
r
t
-
c
i
r
c
u
i
t

p
r
o
t
e
c
t
i
o
n

w
i
t
h

f
u
s
e
s

f
o
r

m
o
t
o
r

f
e
e
d
e
r
s
.

F
a
s
t

f
u
s
e

lin
k
s

3
)
d
e
s
i
g
n
e
d

f
o
r

s
h
o
r
t
-
c
i
r
c
u
i
t

c
u
r
r
e
n
t
s

u
p

t
o

5
0

k
A

a
n
d

6
9
0

V
N
H
T
y
p
e

3
N
A
f
o
r

3
U
F
7
D
IA
Z
E
D
T
y
p
e

5
S
B
N
E
O
Z
E
D
T
y
p
e

5
S
E
O
v
e
r
l
o
a
d

r
e
l
a
y
C
o
n
t
a
c
t
o
r
C
L
A
S
S
O
p
e
r
a
t
in
g

c
la
s
s

S
e
t
t
i
n
g

r
a
n
g
e
5

u
.
1
0
1
5
2
0
2
5
3
0
3
5
4
0
g
L
(
g
G
)
(
T
y
p
e
)
R
a
t
e
d

o
p
e
r
a
t
in
g

c
u
r
r
e
n
t

I
e
/
A
C
-
3

in

A

f
o
r
T
e
s
t

c
u
r
r
e
n
t

"
r
"
4
0
0
V
/
5
0
0
V
/
6
9
0
V
4
0
0
V
/
5
0
0
V
/
6
9
0
V
4
0
0
V
/
5
0
0
V
/
6
9
0
V
4
0
0
V
/
5
0
0
V
/
6
9
0
V
4
0
0
V
/
5
0
0
V
/
6
9
0
V
4
0
0
V
/
5
0
0
V
/
6
9
0
V
4
0
0
V
/
5
0
0
V
/
6
9
0
V
1
2
0
.
3

-

3
.
0
A
3
R
T
1
0
1
5
3
,
0
/
3
,
0
/
3
,
0
3
,
0
/
3
,
0
/
3
,
0
3
,
0
/
3
,
0
/
3
,
0
3
,
0
/
3
,
0
/
3
,
0
3
,
0
/
3
,
0
/
3
,
0
3
,
0
/
3
,
0
/
3
,
0
3
,
0
/
3
,
0
/
3
,
0
3
5
2
0
3
R
T
1
0
1
6
3
,
0
/
3
,
0
/
3
,
0
3
,
0
/
3
,
0
/
3
,
0
3
,
0
/
3
,
0
/
3
,
0
3
,
0
/
3
,
0
/
3
,
0
3
,
0
/
3
,
0
/
3
,
0
3
,
0
/
3
,
0
/
3
,
0
3
,
0
/
3
,
0
/
3
,
0
3
5
2
0
2
.
4

-

2
5
A
3
R
T
1
0
1
5
7
,
0
/
5
,
0
/
4
,
0
7
,
0
/
5
,
0
/
4
,
0
7
,
0
/
5
,
0
/
4
,
0
7
,
0
/
5
,
0
/
4
,
0
7
,
0
/
5
,
0
/
4
,
0
7
,
0
/
5
,
0
/
4
,
0
7
,
0
/
5
,
0
/
4
,
0
3
5
2
0
3
R
T
1
0
1
6
9
,
0
/
6
,
5
5
,
2
9
,
0
/
6
,
5
5
,
2
9
,
0
/
6
,
5
5
,
2
9
,
0
/
6
,
5
5
,
2
9
,
0
/
6
,
5
5
,
2
9
,
0
/
6
,
5
/
5
,
2
8
,
5
/
6
,
5
5
,
2
3
5
2
0
3
R
T
1
0
1
7
1
2
,
0
/
9
,
0
/
6
,
3
1
1
,
0
/
9
,
0
/
6
,
3
1
0
,
0
/
9
,
0
/
6
,
3
9
,
5
/
9
,
0
/
6
,
3
9
,
0
/
9
,
0
/
6
,
3
9
,
0
/
9
,
0
/
6
,
3
8
,
5
/
8
,
5
/
6
,
3
3
5
2
0
3
R
T
1
0
2
3
9
,
0
/
6
,
5
/
5
,
2
9
,
0
/
6
,
5
/
5
,
2
9
,
0
/
6
,
5
/
5
,
2
6
3
2
5
3
R
T
1
0
2
4
1
2
,
0
/
1
2
,
0
/
9
,
0
1
2
,
0
/
1
2
,
0
/
9
,
0
1
2
,
0
/
1
2
,
0
/
9
,
0
1
2
,
0
/
1
2
,
0
/
9
,
0
1
2
,
0
/
1
2
,
0
/
9
,
0
1
2
,
0
/
1
2
,
0
/
9
,
0
1
2
,
0
/
1
2
,
0
/
9
,
0
6
3
2
5
3
R
T
1
0
2
5
1
7
,
0
/
1
7
,
0
/
1
3
,
0
1
7
,
0
/
1
7
,
0
/
1
3
,
0
1
6
,
0
/
1
6
,
0
/
1
3
,
0
1
5
,
0
/
1
5
,
0
/
1
3
,
0
1
4
,
0
/
1
4
,
0
/
1
3
,
0
1
3
,
0
/
1
3
,
0
/
1
3
,
0
1
2
,
0
/
1
2
,
0
/
1
2
,
0
6
3
2
5
3
R
T
1
0
2
6
2
5
,
0
/
1
8
,
0
/
1
3
,
0
1
8
,
0
/
1
8
,
0
/
1
3
,
0
1
6
,
0
/
1
6
,
0
/
1
3
,
0
1
5
,
0
/
1
5
,
0
/
1
3
,
0
1
4
,
0
/
1
4
,
0
/
1
3
,
0
1
3
,
0
/
1
3
,
0
/
1
3
,
0
1
2
,
0
/
1
2
,
0
/
1
2
,
0
1
0
0
3
5
3
R
T
1
0
3
4
2
5
,
0
/
2
5
,
0
/
2
0
,
0
2
5
,
0
/
2
5
,
0
/
2
0
,
0
2
2
,
3
/
2
2
,
3
/
2
0
,
0
2
0
,
3
/
2
0
,
3
/
2
0
,
3
1
9
,
1
/
1
9
,
1
/
1
9
,
1
1
7
,
6
/
1
7
,
6
/
1
7
,
6
1
6
,
1
/
1
6
,
1
/
1
6
,
1
1
2
5
6
3
3
R
T
1
0
3
5
2
5
,
0
/
2
5
,
0
/
2
4
,
0
2
5
,
0
/
2
5
,
0
/
2
4
,
0
2
5
,
0
/
2
5
,
0
/
2
4
,
0
2
5
,
0
/
2
5
,
0
/
2
4
,
0
2
5
,
0
/
2
5
,
0
/
2
4
,
0
2
5
,
0
/
2
5
,
0
/
2
4
,
0
2
3
,
5
/
2
3
,
5
/
2
3
,
5
1
2
5
6
3
1
0
-
1
0
0
A
3
R
T
1
0
3
4
3
2
,
0
/
3
2
,
0
/
2
0
,
0
2
5
,
5
/
2
5
,
5
/
2
0
,
0
2
2
,
3
/
2
2
,
3
/
2
0
,
0
2
0
,
3
/
2
0
,
3
/
2
0
,
0
1
9
,
1
/
1
9
,
1
/
1
9
,
1
1
7
,
6
/
1
7
,
6
/
1
7
,
6
1
6
,
1
/
1
6
,
1
/
1
6
,
1
1
2
5
6
3
3
R
T
1
0
3
5
4
0
,
0
/
4
0
,
0
/
2
4
,
0
3
3
,
0
/
3
3
,
0
/
2
4
,
0
2
9
,
4
/
2
9
,
4
/
2
4
,
0
2
8
,
0
/
2
8
,
0
/
2
4
,
0
2
6
,
5
/
2
6
,
5
/
2
4
,
0
2
5
,
0
/
2
5
,
0
/
2
4
,
0
2
3
,
5
/
2
3
,
5
/
2
3
,
5
1
2
5
6
3
3
R
T
1
0
3
6
5
0
,
0
/
5
0
,
0
/
2
4
,
0
3
8
,
5
/
3
8
,
5
/
2
4
,
0
3
2
,
7
/
3
2
,
7
/
2
4
,
0
2
9
,
4
/
2
9
,
4
/
2
4
,
0
2
6
,
5
/
2
6
,
5
/
2
4
,
0
2
5
,
0
/
2
5
,
0
/
2
4
,
0
2
3
,
5
/
2
3
,
5
/
2
3
,
5
1
6
0
8
0
3
R
T
1
0
4
4
6
5
,
0
/
6
5
,
0
/
4
7
,
0
5
6
,
0
/
5
6
,
0
/
4
7
,
0
4
9
,
0
/
4
9
,
0
/
4
7
,
0
4
5
,
0
/
4
5
,
0
/
4
5
,
0
4
1
,
7
/
4
1
,
7
/
4
1
,
7
3
8
,
2
/
3
8
,
2
/
3
8
,
2
3
4
,
5
/
3
4
,
5
/
3
4
,
5
2
0
0
1
2
5
3
R
T
1
0
4
5
8
0
,
0
/
8
0
,
0
/
5
8
,
0
6
1
,
0
/
6
1
,
0
/
5
8
,
0
5
3
,
0
/
5
3
,
0
/
5
3
,
0
4
7
,
0
/
4
7
,
0
/
4
7
,
0
4
5
,
0
/
4
5
,
0
/
4
5
,
0
4
3
,
0
/
4
3
,
0
/
4
3
,
0
4
0
,
0
/
4
0
,
0
/
4
0
,
0
2
0
0
1
6
0
3
R
T
1
0
4
6
9
5
,
0
/
9
5
,
0
/
5
8
,
0
6
9
,
0
/
6
9
,
0
/
5
8
,
0
5
9
,
0
/
5
9
,
0
/
5
8
,
0
5
3
,
0
/
5
3
,
0
/
5
3
,
0
5
0
,
0
/
5
0
,
0
/
5
0
,
0
4
7
,
0
/
4
7
,
0
/
4
7
,
0
4
4
,
0
/
4
4
,
0
/
4
4
,
0
2
0
0
1
6
0
3
R
T
1
0
5
4
1
0
0
,
0
/
1
0
0
,
0
/
1
0
0
,
0
9
3
,
2
/
9
3
,
2
/
9
3
,
2
8
1
,
7
/
8
1
,
7
/
8
1
,
7
7
4
,
8
/
7
4
,
8
/
7
4
,
8
6
9
,
0
/
6
9
,
0
/
6
9
,
0
6
3
,
0
/
6
3
,
0
/
6
3
,
0
5
7
,
0
/
5
7
,
0
/
5
7
,
0
3
5
5
3
1
5
3
R
T
1
0
5
5
1
0
0
,
0
/
1
0
0
,
0
/
1
0
0
,
0
1
0
0
,
0
/
1
0
0
,
0
/
1
0
0
,
0
9
7
,
5
/
9
7
,
5
/
9
7
,
5
9
0
,
0
/
9
0
,
0
/
9
0
,
0
8
2
,
0
/
8
2
,
0
/
8
2
,
0
7
4
,
0
/
7
4
,
0
/
7
4
,
0
3
5
5
3
1
5
2
0
-
2
0
0
A
3
R
T
1
0
5
4
1
1
5
,
0
/
1
1
5
,
0
/
1
1
5
,
0
9
3
,
2
/
9
3
,
2
/
9
3
,
2
8
1
,
7
/
8
1
,
7
/
8
1
,
7
7
4
,
8
/
7
4
,
8
/
7
4
,
8
6
9
,
0
/
6
9
,
0
/
6
9
,
0
6
4
,
0
/
6
4
,
0
/
6
4
,
0
3
5
5
3
1
5
3
R
T
1
0
5
5
1
5
0
/
1
5
0
/
1
5
0
1
2
2
/
1
2
2
/
1
2
2
1
0
7
/
1
0
7
/
1
0
7
9
8
/
9
8
/
9
8
9
0
/
9
0
/
9
0
8
2
/
8
2
/
8
2
7
4
/
7
4
/
7
4
3
5
5
3
1
5
3
R
T
1
0
5
6
1
8
5
/
1
8
5
/
1
7
0
1
5
0
/
1
5
0
/
1
5
0
1
3
1
/
1
3
1
/
1
3
1
1
2
0
/
1
2
0
/
1
2
0
1
1
1
/
1
1
1
/
1
1
1
1
0
2
/
1
0
2
/
1
0
2
9
3
/
9
3
/
9
3
3
5
5
3
1
5
6
3
-
6
3
0
A
3
R
T
1
0
6
4
2
2
5
/
2
2
5
/
2
2
5
1
8
2
/
1
8
2
/
1
8
2
1
6
0
/
1
6
0
/
1
6
0
1
4
6
/
1
4
6
/
1
4
6
1
3
5
/
1
3
5
/
1
3
5
1
2
6
/
1
2
6
/
1
2
6
5
0
0
4
0
0
3
R
T
1
0
6
5
2
6
5
/
2
6
5
/
2
6
5
2
1
5
/
2
1
5
/
2
1
5
1
8
8
/
1
8
8
/
1
8
8
1
7
2
/
1
7
2
/
1
7
2
1
5
9
/
1
5
9
/
1
5
9
1
4
6
/
1
4
6
/
1
4
6
1
3
3
/
1
3
3
/
1
3
3
5
0
0
4
0
0
3
R
T
1
0
6
6
3
0
0
/
3
0
0
/
2
8
0
2
4
3
/
2
4
3
/
2
4
3
2
1
3
/
2
1
3
/
2
1
3
1
9
5
/
1
9
5
/
1
9
5
1
8
0
/
1
8
0
/
1
8
0
1
6
5
/
1
6
5
/
1
6
5
1
5
0
/
1
5
0
/
1
5
0
5
0
0
4
0
0
3
R
T
1
0
7
5
4
0
0
/
4
0
0
/
4
0
0
3
2
4
/
3
2
4
/
3
2
4
2
8
4
/
2
8
4
/
2
8
4
2
6
0
/
2
6
0
/
2
6
0
2
4
0
/
2
4
0
/
2
4
0
2
2
0
/
2
2
0
/
2
2
0
2
0
0
/
2
0
0
/
2
0
0
6
3
0
4
0
0
3
R
T
1
0
7
6
5
0
0
/
5
0
0
/
4
5
0
4
0
5
/
4
0
5
/
4
0
5
3
5
5
/
3
5
5
/
3
5
5
3
2
5
/
3
2
5
/
3
2
5
3
0
0
/
3
0
0
/
3
0
0
2
7
5
/
2
7
5
/
2
7
5
2
5
0
/
2
5
0
/
2
5
0
6
3
0
5
0
0
3
R
T
1
2
6
4
2
2
5
/
2
2
5
/
2
2
5
2
2
5
/
2
2
5
/
2
2
5
2
2
5
/
2
2
5
/
2
2
5
1
9
4
/
1
9
4
/
1
9
4
1
7
3
/
1
7
3
/
1
7
3
1
5
2
/
1
5
2
/
1
5
2
1
3
1
/
1
3
1
/
1
3
1
5
0
0
5
0
0
3
R
T
1
2
6
5
2
6
5
/
2
6
5
/
2
6
5
2
6
5
/
2
6
5
/
2
6
5
2
6
5
/
2
6
5
/
2
6
5
2
2
8
/
2
2
8
/
2
2
8
2
0
4
/
2
0
4
/
2
0
4
1
8
0
/
1
8
0
/
1
8
0
1
5
6
/
1
5
6
/
1
5
6
5
0
0
5
0
0
3
R
T
1
2
6
6
3
0
0
/
3
0
0
/
3
0
0
3
0
0
/
3
0
0
/
3
0
0
3
0
0
/
3
0
0
/
3
0
0
2
5
8
/
2
5
8
/
2
5
8
2
3
1
/
2
3
1
/
2
3
1
2
0
4
/
2
0
4
/
2
0
4
1
7
7
/
1
7
7
/
1
7
7
5
0
0
5
0
0
3
R
T
1
2
7
5
4
0
0
/
4
0
0
/
4
0
0
4
0
0
/
4
0
0
/
4
0
0
4
0
0
/
4
0
0
/
4
0
0
3
4
4
/
3
4
4
/
3
4
4
3
1
6
/
3
1
6
/
3
1
6
8
0
0
8
0
0
3
R
T
1
2
7
6
5
0
0
/
5
0
0
/
5
0
0
5
0
0
/
5
0
0
/
5
0
0
5
0
0
/
5
0
0
/
5
0
0
4
3
0
/
4
3
0
/
4
3
0
3
8
5
/
3
8
5
/
3
8
5
3
4
0
/
3
4
0
/
3
4
0
3
1
6
/
3
1
6
/
3
1
6
8
0
0
8
0
0
3
T
F
6
8

2
)

6
3
0
/
6
3
0
/
6
3
0
5
0
2
/
5
0
2
/
5
0
2
4
4
0
/
4
4
0
/
4
4
0
4
0
8
/
4
0
8
/
4
0
8
3
7
6
/
3
7
6
/
3
7
6
3
4
4
/
3
4
4
/
3
4
4
3
1
7
/
3
1
7
/
3
1
7
8
0
0
5
0
0
4
)
3
T
F
6
9

2
)

6
3
0
/
6
3
0
/
6
3
0
6
3
0
/
6
3
0
/
6
3
0
5
7
2
/
5
7
2
/
5
7
2
5
3
1
/
5
3
1
/
5
3
1
5
0
0
/
5
0
0
/
5
0
0
4
6
9
/
4
6
9
/
4
6
9
4
3
8
/
4
3
8
/
4
3
8
8
0
0
6
3
0
4
)
1
)

C
o
n
t
a
c
t
o
r

i
n
s
t
a
l
l
a
t
i
o
n

p
o
s
s
i
b
l
e

(
a
f
t
e
r

d
i
s
c
o
n
n
e
c
t
i
n
g

t
h
e

b
o
x

t
e
r
m
i
n
a
l

b
l
o
c
k
)
5
)

A
s
s
i
g
n
m
e
n
t

a
n
d

s
h
o
r
t
-
c
i
r
c
u
i
t

u
n
i
t
s

a
c
c
o
r
d
i
n
g

t
o

I
E
C
6
0
9
4
7
-
4
-
1
.
2
)

N
o

c
o
n
t
a
c
t
o
r

i
n
s
t
a
l
l
a
t
i
o
n

p
o
s
s
i
b
l
e

T
y
p
e

o
f

a
s
s
i
g
n
m
e
n
t

"
1
"



:


S
c
o
n
t
a
c
t
o
r

o
r

s
t
a
r
t
e
r

m
u
s
t

n
o
t

d
a
m
a
g
e

p
e
o
p
le

o
r

t
h
e

p
la
n
t

if

a

s
h
o
r
t
-
c
ir
c
u
it

o
c
c
u
r
s
.

3
)

A
d
h
e
r
e

t
o

t
h
e

o
p
e
r
a
t
i
n
g

v
o
l
t
a
g
e








I
t

d
o
e
s

n
o
t

n
e
e
d

t
o

b
e

p
o
s
s
ib
le

t
o

c
o
n
t
in
u
e

o
p
e
r
a
t
in
g

w
it
h
o
u
t

r
e
p
a
ir
s

o
r

r
e
p
la
c
e
m
e
n
t

p
a
r
t
s
.
4
)

E
n
s
u
r
e

t
h
a
t

t
h
e

s
a
f
e
t
y

s
e
p
a
r
a
t
io
n

b
e
t
w
e
e
n

t
h
e

m
a
x
im
u
m

A
C
-
3

o
p
e
r
a
t
in
g
c
u
r
r
e
n
t

a
n
d

t
h
e

r
a
t
e
d

f
u
s
e

c
u
r
r
e
n
t

is

s
u
f
f
ic
ie
n
t
ly

la
r
g
e
.
T
y
p
e

o
f

a
s
s
i
g
n
m
e
n
t


"
2
"



:


C
o
n
t
a
c
t
o
r

o
r

s
t
a
r
t
e
r

m
u
s
t

n
o
t

d
a
m
a
g
e

p
e
o
p
le

o
r

t
h
e

p
la
n
t

if

a

s
h
o
r
t
-
c
ir
c
u
it

o
c
c
u
r
s
.








a
n
d

m
u
s
t

b
e

r
e
a
d
y

f
o
r

f
u
r
t
h
e
r

u
s
e
.

T
h
e

d
a
n
g
e
r

o
f

c
o
n
t
a
c
t

w
e
ld
in
g

is

g
iv
e
n
.
T
y
p
e

o
f

a
s
s
ig
n
m
e
n
t

5
)
SIMOCODE pro
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 Index-1
Index
Numerics
9-pole SUB-D connection 11-16
A
Abbreviations and Specifications A-3, B-3
Accessories 1-18, 1-25
Active control stations A-2
Acyclic
writing 10-5
writing and reading of data records
10-10
Addressing plug 1-18, 1-20, 1-25, 2-11,
11-14, 12-4
Alarms 10-19
Analog input 1-24
Analog module 1-2, 1-17, 1-23, 1-24
Analog output 1-24
Asymmetry limit 3-9
Asymmetry monitoring 3-9
Asymmetry protection 3-1, 3-2, 3-3, 3-9
B
Basic device parameter 10-20
basic factory default settings 2-2, 12-2
Basic unit pin assignment 11-7
Basic units 1-10, 1-19
Blocking limit 3-10
Blocking protection 3-2, 3-3, 3-10
Bus termination module 11-17
Buttons D-7
Byte arrangements B-2
C
Cable cross-section 11-6
Cable lengths D-4
Channel-related diagnostics 10-18
Checklist for selecting the device
series 1-8
Circuit breaker 1-12, 1-19, 4-12, 4-22, 4-23
Class 1 master 10-2
Class 2 master 10-2
Class interval 3-10
Clockwise rotation 4-28
Color-coding on the connecting cable
11-13, 11-15
Comment 10-20
Commissioning 2-9, 12-1, 12-2, 12-3
Communication 1-13, 10-1
Communication parameters 10-20
Communication principle 10-4
Configuration with SIMOCODE pro V
11-11
Configuring
a Reversing Starter 2-1
SIMOCODE pro 10-6
the slave diagnostics 10-12
with a GSD file 10-6
with SIMATIC PDM 10-8
with the SIMOCODE ES software 10-8
Connecting cable 1-18, 1-25
Connecting plugs with sockets 1-28
Connecting SIMOCODE pro as a norm
slave with a GSD file 10-6
Connection cross-sections D-4
Contactor controls 2-7, A-2
Control commands 4-1, 4-25, 4-28, 4-32,
4-38, 4-41, 4-51
Control data from PROFIBUS DP 1-27
Control function 1-12, 4-1, 4-2, 4-10
Control programs 1-2
Control station
- local control 4-3
- operator panel 4-4
- PC 4-4
- PLC/DCS 4-3
Control stations 4-1
Cooling down time 1-14
Cooling time 3-7
Cos phi 1-22
Counter-clockwise rotation 4-28
Counters 1-15, 9-2, 9-8
Cover for IP54 1-20
Covering 11-14
Current limit 1-11, 3-10
Current measurement modules 1-16,
1-21, 11-9, D-5
Current measurement with current measu-
rement modules 11-9
Current transformer 3-4
SIMOCODE pro
Index-2 GWA 4NEB 631 6060-02
Index
Current/voltage measurement module
1-2, 1-16, 1-22
Cyclic
controlling 10-9
services 1-13
signaling 10-9
signaling data 2-12
data transfer 10-5
D
Dahlander 1-12, 4-12, 4-32 to 4-34
Dahlander circuit 4-33
Dahlander
with reversal of the direction of
rotation 4-12, 4-35, 4-36, 4-37, 4-43,
4-50
Data Formats and Data Records B-1
Data record 130 - base device
parameter 1 B-16
Data record 131 - base device
parameter 2 B-22
Data record 133 - extended device
parameter 2 B-34
Data record 139 - labeling B-37
Data record 160 - communication
parameters B-38
Data record 165 - comment B-38
Data record 202 - Acyclic controlling B-39
Data record 203 - Acyclic signaling B-40
Data record 224 - password protection
B-41
Data record 67 B-4
Data record 67 - process image of the
outputs B-4
Data record 69 - process image of the
inputs B-5
Data record 92 - device diagnostics B-6
Data record 94 - measured values B-14
Data record 95 - Service/statistics
data B-15
Data record DS132 - extended device para-
meter 1 B-26
Data records - overview 10-20, B-1
Data records (acyclic data) 10-10
Degree of protection
(according to 60529) D-2
Delay pre-warning 3-8
Detachable terminals 11-2
for basic units and expansion
modules 11-6
Device diagnostics 10-20
Device series 1-2
Diagnostic alarm 10-19
Diagnostic data 1-14
Diagnostics with STEP 7 10-11
Digital module pin assignment 11-8
Digital modules 1-17, 1-23
Dimension Drawings C-1
Direct starter 1-4, 1-5, 1-12, 4-12, 4-17
Display D-3, D-6, D-7
Display and statistics data 10-20
Door adapter 1-18, 1-25
DP master 10-2
DPV1 slave 10-2
E
Earth-fault detection 1-2
Earth-fault module 1-11, 1-17, 1-23, 1-24
Earth-fault monitoring 1-10, 1-17, 1-24
EEx e applications 3-6, 3-12
EMC emitted interference according to
IEC 60947-1 D-2
EMC stability according to
IEC 60947-1 D-2
Emergency start 1-13
Enabled control command 4-31, 4-45,
4-55
Enables 4-1, 4-8
End position 4-45
Error types 10-18
Execution time 4-14, 4-40, 4-45, 4-52
Expansion modules 1-23, D-6
Extended device parameter 10-20
F
Fault feedback 4-14
Feedback ON 4-13, 4-14, 4-41
Feedback time 4-14, 4-40, 4-52
Fill level 1-6
Fixing lugs for screw attachments 11-2
Flashing 1-15, 9-2, 9-19
Flickering 1-15, 9-2, 9-20
Free acyclic
control data 10-20
signaling data 10-20
Function blocks 1-27
G
GSD (device data) 10-2
GSD file 1-26, 10-6, 10-7
I
Identification-related diagnostics 10-16
Independent operation 1-3
Input characteristic curve D-4
Inputs (binary) D-6
Installation guidelines for the
PROFIBUS D 11-17
Installation location D-2
Integrating the GSD file into the configura-
tion software 10-7
Integration in STEP7 10-8
Interfaces 11-1
SIMOCODE pro
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 Index-3
Index
Interlocking time 4-13, 4-14, 4-19
K
Key-operated switch operation 4-5
L
Labeling 10-20
Lamp controls A-2
Local control 2-8
Left - fast 4-35
Left - slow 4-35
Limit monitor 1-15, 9-2, 9-21, 9-23
Limit overshooting 9-21
Limit temperature 3-11
Limit undershooting 9-21
Linking function blocks 2-7
Load type 3-8, 4-13, 4-40, 4-52
Local 4-5, 4-6
Local control station 2-2, 2-3, 2-9
Locking the contactor 4-13
Logic Modules 1-15, 9-1
M
Making internal assignments 4-51, 4-54
Manual operation 4-5
Manufacturer's identification 10-15
Master PROFIBUS address 10-15
Measured values 10-20
Measurement frequency D-5
Measurement module D-3
Memory module 1-18, 1-20, 1-25, 11-14
Mode selectors 4-5, 4-6
Modes of operation 4-1, 4-6
Monitoring 1-10
Monitoring
active power 1-11
analog signals 1-11
PLC/DCS 1-13
temperature 1-17
the power factor (cos phi) 1-11
Motor control functions 1-19
Motor feeder 1-4, 1-5, 2-3
Motor operating hours 1-14
Motor power/cos phi 1-14
Motor protection functions 3-2
Motor stop times 1-14
Motor switching state 1-14
Motor temperature 1-10, 1-14
Mounting 11-1, D-3, D-5, D-6, D-7
mounting lugs 11-2, 11-3, 11-4
Mounting
the basic units and expansion
modules 11-3
the current measurement
modules 11-4
the operator panel 11-5
Mounting, Wiring and Interfaces 11-1
N
Network contactor, clockwise rotation
4-28
Non-maintained command mode 4-13,
4-40, 4-45, 4-52
Non-volatile elements 1-15, 9-2, 9-16
NOR function 9-15, 9-18
Norm diagnostics 10-5, 10-9
Notes on parameterizing 12-2
Number
of motor starts 1-14
of overload trippings 1-14
of start-ups 1-12
O
Object Manager OM SIMOCODE pro
1-18, 1-26, 10-2, 10-8
OM SIMOCODE ES Professional 10-10
ON control command 4-45
Operating data 1-14
Operating hours 1-12
Operating range D-3
Operational protection off (OPO) 1-13
Operator enable of the individual control
stations 4-7
Operator panel 1-16, 1-20, 11-14, D-7
Overload 3-6
Overload protection 1-10, 3-1, 3-2 to 3-4,
3-10
Overload relay 1-12, 4-12, 4-16
Overview of system components 1-16
P
Parameter block 10-8
Parameter dependences in the GSD 10-7
Parameterization 2-7
parameterization software 1-26
Parameterization starting 10-5
Password protection 10-20
Pause time 3-7
PC cable 1-18, 1-25, 11-14
PCS 7 library SIMOCODE pro 1-26
Phase asymmetry 1-10, 1-14, 3-9
Phase currents 1-14
Phase cycle 1-14, 1-22
Phase failure 1-10
Phase voltages 1-14
Pin assignment 11-7, 11-8
Pin cross-section 11-9
PLC/DCS 4-5
Plugs (analog) 1-27
Plugs (digital) 1-27
Pole-changing switches 1-12, 1-19, 4-12,
4-38, 4-39
with reversal of the direction of
rotation 4-12, 4-41, 4-42
SIMOCODE pro
Index-4 GWA 4NEB 631 6060-02
Index
Power consumption D-3
Power failure monitoring (UVO) 1-13
Preventive maintenance 12-6
Pre-warning 3-8
Process alarm 10-19
Process and diagnostic alarm 10-5, 10-9
Process image (cyclic data) 10-10
Process image
of the inputs 10-20
of the outputs 10-20
Process monitoring 1-11
PROFIBUS DP 1-13, 1-18, 2-2, 4-51, 4-53,
10-2
PROFIBUS DP
interface 1-13, D-3
on a 9-pole SUB-D socket 11-16
PROFIBUS DPV1 10-2
PTC 3-11
Pump 1-11
Push-through opening 11-9, D-5
Push-through system 1-16, 11-9
R
Rail connection 11-9, D-5
Rail mounting 11-4
Rated
control voltage D-3
isolation current D-6
isolation voltage D-3, D-5
surge voltage strength D-3, D-5, D-6
switching capacity D-6
uninterrupted current D-6
Reading data 10-3
Reading out
statistic data 12-6
the diagnostics 10-11
the statistics data 12-6
Relay outputs D-4, D-6
Remote operation 4-5
Remote/automatic 4-5
Replacing a basic unit 12-9
Replacing expansion units 12-9
Reset 1-13, 3-8
Responses 3-3
Reversing Starter 1-12, 2-2, 4-8, 4-12,
4-19, 4-20
Right - fast 4-35
Right - slow 4-35
S
Save switching command 4-13
Saving parameters
from a SIMOCODE ES file to a
basic unit 12-8
from the basic unit in a
SIMOCODE ES file 12-7
from the basic unit in the memory
module 12-7
from the memory module in the basic
unit 12-8
Screw attachment 11-2 to 11-4
Screw terminals 1-27
Sensor circuit error 3-12
Sensor measuring circuits 1-11
Sensors 1-17, 1-24
Sequence
for connecting the system interface
11-13, 11-15
for PROFIBUS DP connection 11-16
Service data 1-14
Servicing 12-1
Set current D-5
Setting the PROFIBUS DP address 2-10,
2-11
Setting the PROFIBUS DP address
via SIMOCODE ES 2-11
Setting the PROFIBUS DP address
via the addressing plug 2-11
Shock resistance (sine pulse) D-2
Short-circuit protection D-4
Signal conditioner 1-15, 9-2, 9-13
Signaling data to PROFIBUS DP 1-27
SIMARIS manager 10-2
SIMATIC PDM 4-4, 10-8
SIMATIC PDM (PCS7) 10-2
SIMATIC S7 1-26, 10-7
SIMATIC S7-400 10-8
SIMOCODE ES 1-18, 1-26, 2-2, 2-11, 4-1,
4-4, 8-18, 10-2, 10-5, 10-8, 12-2, 12-4,
12-7, B-37
SIMOCODE pro parameterization 1-25
SIMOCODE pro S7 slave 10-3
Slave modes of operation 10-5
Slide control 1-19, 4-49
Slider 1-12, 4-12, 4-46, 4-48
Snap-on mounting 11-3
Socket assignment table
- analog A-11
- digital A-4
Sockets (analog) 1-27
Sockets (digital) 1-27
Soft reversing starter 4-12, 4-53, 4-54
Soft starter 1-12, 4-12, 4-51, 4-52
Soft starter control, 1-19
Standard function modules 1-13
Star contactor 4-28
Star-delta circuit 1-10
Star-delta connection 4-29
Star-delta starter 4-12, 4-26
with reversal of the direction of
rotation 4-12, 4-28, 4-30
Star-delta starters 1-12, 1-19, 4-25
SIMOCODE pro
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 Index-5
Index
Starting up parameter data 10-10
Start-up parameterization 10-8, 10-10
Start-up time 3-4
Station status 1 10-13
Station status 2 10-14
Station status 3 10-14
Statistics data 12-6
Status messages 10-5, 10-9, 10-17
Status signals/messages A-2
STEP 7 user program 10-11
Stop time 1-12
Strip length 11-6
Summation current transformer 1-2, 1-11,
1-17, 1-24
Switch off time 3-4
Switching from star to delta 4-25, 4-28
Switching interval 4-13, 4-14, 4-26, 4-29,
4-32, 4-36, 4-38, 4-40
Switching
the direction of rotation 4-19, 4-28,
4-35, 4-41, 4-53
the direction of travel 4-47
the speed 4-32, 4-35, 4-38, 4-41
System interface 1-16, 11-13
System interface cover 1-18, 1-25, 11-12
System interfaces 11-10, 11-14, D-3, D-5,
D-6, D-7
T
T module 3-11
Tables A-1
Technical Data D-1
Telegram description 10-9
Temperature module 1-2, 1-11, 1-17, 1-23,
1-24
Temperature monitoring 1-11, 1-24, 3-11,
3-12
Temperature sensors 1-2
Test position feedback (TPF) 1-13
Test/reset button D-3
Thermistor protection 3-1, 3-2, 3-12, D-4
Thermistor sensors 1-10, 3-11
Tightening torques 11-6
Time stamping in the fault memory 8-18
Time synchronization 1-13
Time to trip 1-14
Timer 1-15, 9-2, 9-10
Timestamping 1-13, 8-18
Torque 4-49
Transferring the parameters to the basic
device 2-9
Transmitting data 10-4
Tripping class 3-4, 3-5
Tripping time 3-5
Truth table for 2I/1O 9-6
Truth table for 3I/1O 9-3
Truth table for 5I/2O 9-7
Truth tables 1-15, 9-2
Types of sensors 3-11
Types of signal 9-17
Types of signals 9-14
U
Unit replacement 1-25
V
Valve 1-12, 4-12, 4-44, 4-45
Valve control 1-19
Variants for slide control 4-49
Voltage monitoring 1-11
W
Warnings 1-13, 1-14
Watchdog 1-13
Win SIMOCODE DP Converter 1-26
Win SIMOCODE DP parameter files 1-26
Wiring 11-1, 11-6
the detachable terminals 11-7, 11-8
Writing data 10-3
SIMOCODE pro
Index-6 GWA 4NEB 631 6060-02
Index
SIMOCODE pro
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
To
SIEMENS AG
A&D CD MM3
92220 Amberg, Germany
Fax: ++49 9621/ 80-3337
SIMOCODE pro Manual
Did you notice an error while reading this manual?
If so, please let us know using this form.
We are grateful for your comments and suggestions.
Sender (please complete)
Name
Comany / department
Address
Telephone
Fax:
SIMOCODE pro
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
Siemens Aktiengesellschaft
Automation and Drives
Low Voltage Controls and Distribution
Postfach 4848
D-90327 Nrnberg
www. s i e me n s.com/simocode
Order No.: 3UF7970-0AA00-0
SIMOCODE pro
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 E-1
Safety and Commissioning
Information for
Potentially Explosive Areas E
In this chapter
In this chapter you will find safety and commissioning information for
potentially explosive areas. It is imperative that you observe this information
when you have to protect motors in potentially explosive areas.
Target groups
This chapter is addressed to the following target groups:
planners and configurators
commissioners
maintenance and service personnel
Necessary knowledge
You need the following knowledge:
explosion protection
EN 60079-14/VDE 0165 for the installation of electrical apparatus in
potentially explosive/hazardous areas with gas
EN 50281-1-2 for the installation of electrical apparatus in potentially
explosive/hazardous areas with dust
VDE 0118 for the erection of electrical installations in underground mines
Safety and Commissioning Information for Potentially Explosive Areas
SIMOCODE pro
E-2 GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
E.1 General
Information and standards
The increased danger in potentially explosive areas makes the careful
observance of the following notes and standards necessary:
EN 60079-14/VDE 0165 for the installation of electrical apparatus in
potentially explosive/hazardous areas with gas
EN 50281-1-2 for the installation of electrical apparatus in potentially
explosive/hazardous areas with dust
VDE 0118 for the erection of electrical installations in underground mines
All 3UF7 devices are certified under Device Group I, Category M2
(mining) and Device Group II, Category 2 in the area GD (areas in which
explosive gas, steam, fog and air mixtures, as well as inflammable dust, are
present):
Warning
All work for connecting, commissioning and maintenance must be carried
out by qualified, responsible personnel. Unprofessional behavior can cause
serious damage to persons and goods.
BVS 04 ATEX F 003 II (2) GD
BVS 04 ATEX F 003 I (M2)
Safety and Commissioning Information for Potentially Explosive Areas
SIMOCODE pro
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 E-3
E.2 Setting up and commissioning
Attention
Follow the operating instructions (enclosed with the devices)
SIMOCODE pro
Basic device Order number 3ZX1012-0UF70-1AA1
Current measurement module Order number 3ZX1012-0UF71-1AA1
Current/voltage measurement Order number 3ZX1012-0UF77-1BA1
module
Digital module Order number 3ZX1012-0UF73-1AA1
E.2.1 Setting the rated current of the motor
Configure the 3UF7 to the rated current of the motor (according to the type
plate or design test certificate of the motor).
Attention
Note the release class/release characteristic curve of the 3UF7.
Select the release class so that the motor is also thermally protected even
with a blocked rotor.
Motors, cables and contactors must be designed for the selected release
class.
Attention
Set the response of the overload protection to Switch off!
Safety and Commissioning Information for Potentially Explosive Areas
SIMOCODE pro
E-4 GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
Example
Motor 500 V, 50/60 Hz, 110 kW, 156 A, temperature class T3, time T
E
= 11 s,
I
A
/I
e
= 5.5:
Fig. 5-1: Switch-off conditions of the EExe motor, selected: CLASS 10
I
A
/I
e
= 5.5
T
E
= 11 s
Safety and Commissioning Information for Potentially Explosive Areas
SIMOCODE pro
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 E-5
E.2.2 3UF70 with thermistor input
For the 3UF70 you can use a type A temperature sensor with a
characteristic curve according to IEC 60947-8 (DIN VDE 0660, part 303), DIN
44081 and DIN 44082.
Depending on the number of sensors, this results in the following release
and restart temperatures:
Fig. 5-2: Typical characteristic curve of a type A sensor (logarithmic scale)
Depending on the number of sensors, the following release and restart
temperatures result in relation to the NFT (nominal functioning temperature
of the sensor):
Table 5-1: Release and restart temperatures
The specified temperatures are limit values.
Attention
Set the response of the activated thermistor to Switch off!
Release temperature Restart temperature
3 sensors NFT + 4 K NFT - 7 K
6 sensors NFT - 5 K NFT - 20 K
Safety and Commissioning Information for Potentially Explosive Areas
SIMOCODE pro
E-6 GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
E.2.3 Wiring of the sensor circuit
Caution
Lay the measuring circuit cables as separate control cables.
The use of conductors of the motor feeder or other main current cables is
not permitted.
Shielded control cables must be used if extremely inductive or capacitive
interferences are to be expected due to parallel heavy current cables.
Maximum cable length of the sensor circuit cables:
Table 5-2: Maximum cable length of the sensor circuit cables
It is recommended to evaluate the short-circuit recognition.
If the short-circuit recognition of the sensor cable is not evaluated, the
sensor resistance must be measured with a suitable measuring device
during commissioning or after modifications/maintenance work has been
carried out (mounting, demounting the system). The sensor circuit must be
checked for short circuits when the resistances are < 50 Ohm.
E.2.4 Short-circuit protection according to IEC 60947-4-1 for type of
coordination 2
The short-circuit protection must be ensured by separate overcurrent
protection devices.
Caution
Note the respective maximum fuse protection of the contactor for type of
coordination 2 when combining with other contactors.
Cable
cross section
Cable lengths at the thermistor input
without short-circuit
recognition
with short-circuit recognition
1
)
2.5 mm
2
2x 2800 m 2x 250 m
1.5 mm
2
2x 1500 m 2x 150 m
0.5 mm
2
2x 500 m 2x 50 m
1) A short circuit in the sensor circuit is recognized up to this maximum cable length.
Safety and Commissioning Information for Potentially Explosive Areas
SIMOCODE pro
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 E-7
E.2.5 Cable protection
Caution
Avoid impermissable high surface temperatures of the cables by correctly
dimensioning the cross sections!
Select a sufficient cross section - especially with heavy starting CLASS 20
to CLASS 40!
E.2.6 Test
Carry out a test when commissioning and cyclically every 12 months at
the latest!
The test comprises a complete function test. All three test phases (see
below) must be carried out. These include hardware test, current
measurement in all phases used and switching off the motor contactors
(complete control chain with motor supply). The measured current values
must be checked!
Attention:
The test must be carried out by a professional who knows the specified
standards!
Test phases
Phase 1: hardware test/lamp test (0 to 2 s):
The hardware (e.g. the thermistor electronics) is tested, all LEDs and displays
are activated, as are the lamp controls. The contactor controls remain
unchanged.
Phase 2: hardware test results (2 to 5 s):
If there is an fault, the HW fault basic unit fault is triggered.
If there is no fault,
the GEN. FAULT LED flashes if no main current is flowing
the GEN. FAULT LED flickers if main current flows in all three phases
(special case: for 1-phase load in one phase).
Phase 3: relay test (> 5 s):
If a test is implemented with switch-off, the contactor controls are
deactivated.
Safety and Commissioning Information for Potentially Explosive Areas
SIMOCODE pro
E-8 GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
The following table shows the test phases carried out when the TEST/
RESET button is pressed for the respective period of time:
Test
phase
Status Without main current With main current
O.K. Fault *) O.K. Fault
Hardware test/lamp test
< 2s
DEVICE LED Green Green Green Green
GEN.FAULT
LED
Contactor control Unchanged Unchanged Unchanged Unchanged
Show QL*
Hardware test / lamp test result
2s - 5s
DEVICE LED Green Red Green Red
GEN.FAULT
LED
Contactor control Unchanged Deactivated Unchanged Deactivated
Relay test
> 5s
DEVICE LED Green Red Green Red
GEN.FAULT
LED
Contactor control Deactivated Deactivated Deactivated Deactivated
LED lit/activated LED flashing LED flickering LED off
*) Fault displayed after 2 s
Table 5-3: Statuses of the status LEDs/contactor controls during the test
Safety and Commissioning Information for Potentially Explosive Areas
SIMOCODE pro
GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02 E-9
E.2.7 Further safety information
Caution
Only the relay outputs of the 3UF70 basic unit or the 3UF730 monostable
digital module may be used for the protection function!
Warning
The 3UF7 is not suitable for set-up in potentially explosive areas.
The device may only be used in a switchgear cabinet which has at least the
IP 4x degree of protection.
When setting up in potentially explosive areas, the 3UF7 may not cause any
danger of fire. Corresponding measures must be taken (e.g. encapsulation).
Caution
SIMOCODE pro C - basic unit 1:
Short-term energy failures (voltage failures < approx. 50 ms) do not lead to
any failure of the protection system.
Long-term energy failures (voltage failures > approx. 50 ms) lead to
deactivation of the relay outputs.
SIMOCODE pro V - basic unit 2:
Short-term energy failures (voltage failures < approx. 200 ms) do not lead to
any failure of the protection system.
Long-term energy failures (voltage failures > approx. 200 ms) lead to
deactivation of the relay outputs.
If the 3UF7 is in the Automatic RESET mode of operation, the reset is
done automatically after the cooling down time has expired without
pressing the RESET button. It must be guaranteed here via an additional
ON button that the motor does not automatically start after tripping. If the
3UF7 is used in this case without additional thermistor protection, the
motor may only be switched on by professionals.
Warning
The Automatic RESET mode of operation may not be used in applications
in which an unexpected restart can lead to damage to persons or objects.
Attention:
The 3UF7 is not suitable for the load-side operation of frequency converters.
Safety and Commissioning Information for Potentially Explosive Areas
SIMOCODE pro
E-10 GWA 4NEB 631 6050-02
E.2.8 Ambient conditions
Range of the permitted ambient temperature:
Storage/transport: -40 C to +80 C
Operation: -25 C to +60 C
E.3 Maintenance and repair
The devices are maintenance-free.
Warning
Repairs on the device may only be carried out by the manufacturer.
E.4 Guarantee
The guarantee presumes the observance of this safety and commissioning
information of the operating instructions
SIMOCODE pro
Basic device Order number 3ZX1012-0UF70-1AA1
Current measurement module Order number 3ZX1012-0UF71-1AA1
Current/voltage measurement Order number 3ZX1012-0UF77-1BA1
module
Digital module Order number 3ZX1012-0UF73-1AA1
and the complete manual Order number 3UF7970-0AA0x-0

E.5 Further information
You can find further information on the 3UF7 in the LV10 Siemens catalog
Switchgear for Industry or on the Internet at
http://www.ad.siemens.de/csi/cd.

You might also like